2008 350z owner's manual

313
Foreword Welcome to the growing family of new NISSAN owners. This vehicle is delivered to you with confidence. It was produced using the latest techniques and strict quality control. This manual was prepared to help you under- stand the operation and maintenance of your vehicle so that you may enjoy many miles of driving pleasure. Please read through this manual before operating your vehicle. A separate Warranty Information Booklet explains details about the warranties cov- ering your vehicle. The NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide explains details about maintaining and servicing your ve- hicle. Additionally, a separate Customer Care/Lemon Law Booklet (U.S. only) will explain how to resolve any concerns you may have with your vehicle, as well as clarify your rights under your state’s lemon law. Your NISSAN dealer knows your vehicle best. When you require any service or have any questions, we will be glad to assist you with the extensive resources available to us. READ FIRST — THEN DRIVE SAFELY Before driving your vehicle please read your Owner’s Manual carefully. This will ensure familiarity with controls and main- tenance requirements, assisting you in the safe operation of your vehicle. WARNING IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMA- TION REMINDERS FOR SAFETY! Follow these important driving rules to help ensure a safe and comfortable trip for you and your passengers! NEVER drive under the influence of alcohol or drugs. ALWAYS observe posted speed limits and never drive too fast for condi- tions. ALWAYS give your full attention to driving and avoid using vehicle fea- tures or taking other actions that could distract you. ALWAYS use your seat belts. Refer to “Child safety” and “Child restraints” in the “Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” sec- tion for precautions regarding chil- dren. ALWAYS provide information about the proper use of vehicle safety fea- tures to all occupants of the vehicle. ALWAYS review this Owner’s Manual for important safety information. MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHICLE This vehicle should not be modified. Modi- fication could affect its performance, safety or durability, and may even violate governmental regulations. In addition, damage or performance problems result- ing from modification may not be covered under NISSAN warranties. WHEN READING THE MANUAL This manual includes information for all options available on this model. There- fore, you may find some information that does not apply to your vehicle. All information, specifications and illustrations in this manual are those in effect at the time of printing. NISSAN reserves the right to change specifications or design at any time without notice.

Upload: others

Post on 17-May-2022

3 views

Category:

Documents


0 download

TRANSCRIPT

Page 1: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Foreword

Welcome to the growing family of new NISSANowners. This vehicle is delivered to you withconfidence. It was produced using the latesttechniques and strict quality control.

This manual was prepared to help you under-stand the operation and maintenance of yourvehicle so that you may enjoy many miles ofdriving pleasure. Please read through thismanual before operating your vehicle.

A separate Warranty Information Bookletexplains details about the warranties cov-ering your vehicle. The NISSAN Serviceand Maintenance Guide explains detailsabout maintaining and servicing your ve-hicle. Additionally, a separate CustomerCare/Lemon Law Booklet (U.S. only) willexplain how to resolve any concerns youmay have with your vehicle, as well asclarify your rights under your state’s lemonlaw.

Your NISSAN dealer knows your vehicle best.When you require any service or have anyquestions, we will be glad to assist you with theextensive resources available to us.

READ FIRST — THEN DRIVESAFELYBefore driving your vehicle please readyour Owner’s Manual carefully. This willensure familiarity with controls and main-tenance requirements, assisting you in thesafe operation of your vehicle.

WARNING

IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMA-TIONREMINDERS FOR SAFETY!Follow these important driving rules tohelp ensure a safe and comfortable tripfor you and your passengers!

� NEVER drive under the influence ofalcohol or drugs.

� ALWAYS observe posted speed limitsand never drive too fast for condi-tions.

� ALWAYS give your full attention todriving and avoid using vehicle fea-tures or taking other actions thatcould distract you.

� ALWAYS use your seat belts. Refer to“Child safety” and “Child restraints”in the “Safety — Seats, seat belts andsupplemental restraint system” sec-tion for precautions regarding chil-dren.

� ALWAYS provide information aboutthe proper use of vehicle safety fea-

tures to all occupants of the vehicle.

� ALWAYS review this Owner’s Manualfor important safety information.

MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHICLEThis vehicle should not be modified. Modi-fication could affect its performance,safety or durability, and may even violategovernmental regulations. In addition,damage or performance problems result-ing from modification may not be coveredunder NISSAN warranties.

WHEN READING THE MANUALThis manual includes information for alloptions available on this model. There-fore, you may find some information thatdoes not apply to your vehicle.

All information, specifications and illustrations inthis manual are those in effect at the time ofprinting. NISSAN reserves the right to changespecifications or design at any time withoutnotice.

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 2: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

IMPORTANT INFORMATIONABOUT THIS MANUALYou will see various symbols in this manual.They are used in the following ways:

WARNING

This is used to indicate the presence of ahazard that could cause death or seriouspersonal injury. To avoid or reduce therisk, the procedures must be followedprecisely.

CAUTION

This is used to indicate the presence of ahazard that could cause minor or moder-ate personal injury or damage to yourvehicle. To avoid or reduce the risk, theprocedures must be followed carefully.

If you see this symbol, it means “Do not dothis” or “Do not let this happen”.

If you see a symbol similar to these in anillustration, it means the arrow points to the frontof the vehicle.

Arrows in an illustration that are similar to theseindicate movement or action.

Arrows in an illustration that are similar to thesecall attention to an item in the illustration.

SIC0697

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 3: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65WARNING

WARNING

Engine exhaust, some of its constituents,and certain vehicle components containor emit chemicals known to the State ofCalifornia to cause cancer and birthdefects or other reproductive harm. Inaddition, certain fluids contained in ve-hicles and certain products of compo-nent wear contain or emit chemicalsknown to the State of California to causecancer and birth defects or other repro-ductive harm.

CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATEADVISORYSome vehicle parts, such as lithium batter-ies, may contain perchlorate material. Thefollowing advisory is provided: “Perchlor-ate Material — special handling may apply,See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.”

BLUETOOTH is a trademarkowned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc.,U.S.A. and licenced to VisteonCorporation.

© 2007 NISSAN MOTOR CO., LTD.TOKYO, JAPAN

All rights reserved. No part of this Owner’s Manual may bereproduced or stored in a retrieval system, or transmittedin any form, or by any means, electronic, mechanical,photocopying, recording or otherwise, without the priorwritten permission of Nissan Motor Co., Ltd.

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 4: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

NISSAN CUSTOMER CAREPROGRAM

NISSAN CARES ...

Both NISSAN and your NISSAN dealer are dedicated to serving all your automotive needs. Your satisfaction with your vehicle and your NISSAN dealerare our primary concerns. Your NISSAN dealer is always available to assist you with all your automobile sales and service needs.

However, if there is something that yourNISSAN dealer cannot assist you with or youwould like to provide NISSAN directly withcomments or questions, please contact theNISSAN Consumer Affairs Department usingour toll-free number:

For U.S. customers1-800-NISSAN-1(1-800-647-7261)

For Canadian customers1-800-387-0122

The Consumer Affairs Department will ask forthe following information:— Your name, address, and telephonenumber

— Vehicle identification number (attached to thetop of the instrument panel on the driver’sside)

— Date of purchase— Current odometer reading— Your NISSAN dealer’s name— Your comments or questionsOR

You can write to NISSAN with the informationon the left at:

For U.S. customersNissan North America, Inc.Consumer Affairs DepartmentP.O. Box 685003Franklin, TN 37068-5003

For Canadian customersNissan Canada Inc.5290 Orbitor DriveMississauga, Ontario L4W 4Z5

We appreciate your interest in NISSAN and thank you for buying a quality NISSAN vehicle.

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 5: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Table ofContents

Illustrated table of contents

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplementalrestraint system

Instruments and controls

Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audiosystems

Starting and driving

In case of emergency

Appearance and care

Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Technical and consumer information

Index

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 6: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

0 Illustrated table of contents

Air bags, seat belts and child restraints .......................... 0-2Exterior front ........................................................................... 0-3Exterior rear ............................................................................ 0-4Coupe models .................................................................. 0-4Roadster models .............................................................. 0-5

Passenger compartment ...................................................... 0-6

Coupe models .................................................................. 0-6Roadster models .............................................................. 0-8

Instrument panel ................................................................. 0-10Meters and gauges ........................................................... 0-11Engine compartment ......................................................... 0-12

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 7: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Supplemental front-impact air bags(Page 1-28)

2. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supple-mental air bags* (P.1-28)

3. Seat belts (P.1-10)

4. Seats (P.1-2)— Child restraints (P.1-17)

5. Head restraints (P.1-9)— Front-seat Active Head Restraints(P.1-10)

6. Child restraint anchor point* (for top tetherstrap child restraint) (P.1-24)

7. Occupant classification sensor (pattern sen-sor)— Advanced air bag system (P.1-35)

8. Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemen-tal air bags* (P.1-28)

9. Seat belt pretensioner (P.1-41)

*: if so equipped

SSI0255

AIR BAGS, SEAT BELTS ANDCHILD RESTRAINTS

0-2 Illustrated table of contents

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 8: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Hood (P.3-8)

2. Windshield wiper and washer— Switch (P.2-21)— Wiper replacement (P.8-19)— Washer fluid (P.8-14)

3. Power windows (P.2-39)— Automatic adjusting function (P.2-40,P.8-15)

4. Recovery hook installation (P.6-12)License plate installation (P.9-12)

5. Headlight, park and turn signal lights— Switch (P.2-24)— Bulb (P.8-27)

6. Tires— Wheels and tires (P.8-30, P.9-8)— Flat tire (P.6-2)— Tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS)(P.2-13, P.5-3)

7. Outside mirrors (P.3-27)

8. Doors— Keys (P.3-2)— Door locks (P.3-3)— Keyfob (P.3-5)

SSI0289

EXTERIOR FRONT

Illustrated table of contents 0-3

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 9: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

COUPE MODELS1. Antenna (P.4-30)

2. Rear hatch release switch (P.3-9)

3. Rear window defroster (P.2-23)

4. High-mounted stop light (Bulb) (P.8-28)

5. Satellite radio antenna* (P.4-13)

6. Rear window wiper and washer— Switch (P.2-22)— Washer fluid (P.8-14)

7. License plate lights (Bulb) (P.8-28)

8. Rear hatch release (secondary) (P.3-12)

9. Luggage compartment light (P.2-42, P.8-28)

10. Back-up, Turn signal light (Bulb) (P.8-28)

11. Side marker, Stop/Tail light (Bulb) (P.8-28)

12. Fuel— Fuel-filler door (P.3-23)— Fuel recommendation (P.9-3)

*: if so equipped

SSI0152

EXTERIOR REAR

0-4 Illustrated table of contents

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 10: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

ROADSTER MODELS1. Antenna (P.4-30)

2. Trunk lid release switch (P.3-10)

3. Trunk light (P.2-42, P.8-28)

4. High-mounted stop light (Bulb) (P.8-28)

5. Rear window defroster (P.2-23)

6. Soft top (P.3-13)

7. Interior trunk lid release (P.3-11)

8. License plate lights (Bulb) (P.8-28)

9. Back-up, Turn signal light (Bulb) (P.8-28)

10. Side marker, Stop/Tail light (Bulb) (P.8-28)

11. Fuel— Fuel-filler door (P.3-23)— Fuel recommendation (P.9-3)

SSI0003

Illustrated table of contents 0-5

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 11: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

COUPE MODELS1. Coat hook (P.2-38)2. Seat belts (P.1-10)3. Seats— Manual seats adjustment (P.1-3)— Power seats adjustment (P.1-3)

4. Passenger seat— Tilt lever for passenger seat (seatback)(P.1-7)

5. Power window switch (P.2-39)/Power doorlock switch (P.3-4)

6. Outside mirror remote control switch(P.3-27)

7. Sun visor (P.3-25)8. Interior light (P.2-41)9. Sunglasses holder (P.2-32)10. Inside mirror (P.3-26)— Automatic anti-glare inside mirror*(P.3-26)

— HomeLink universal transceiver*(P.2-43)

11. Front passenger air bag status light(P.1-36)/Microphone (Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System*) (P.4-31)

12. Rear parcel box (P.2-37)13. Rear parcel box or Navigation system*114. Rear floor box (P.2-35)15. Power outlet (P.2-31)16. Console box (P.2-35)17. Parking brake— Operation (P.5-15)SSI0256

PASSENGER COMPARTMENT

0-6 Illustrated table of contents

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 12: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

— Parking/Parking on hills (P.5-19)— Checking (P.8-21)

18. Selector lever or shift lever— Automatic transmission (P.5-10)— Manual transmission (P.5-13)

19. Cargo net (P.2-33)*: if so equipped*1: Refer to the separate Navigation SystemOwner’s Manual.

Illustrated table of contents 0-7

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 13: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

ROADSTER MODELS1. Seat belts (P.1-10)2. Seats— Power seats adjustment (P.1-4)— Ventilated net seats* (P.1-6)

3. Passenger seat— Power seatback tilt switch (P.1-7)— Cancel switch (P.1-8)

4. Power window switch (P.2-39)/Power doorlock switch (P.3-4)

5. Outside mirror remote control switch(P.3-27)

6. Soft top latch lever (P.3-16)7. Safety switch for soft top latch lever (P.3-16)8. Interior light (P.2-41)9. Front passenger air bag status light (P.1-36)10. Inside mirror (P.3-26)— Automatic anti-glare inside mirror*(P.3-26)

— HomeLink universal transceiver*(P.2-43)

11. Rear parcel box (P.2-37)12. Rear parcel box or Navigation system*113. Rear floor box (P.2-35)— Trunk lid cancel switch (P.3-11)— Secondary trunk lid release (P.3-12)

14. Power outlet (P.2-31)15. Console box (P.2-35)16. Parking brake— Operation (P.5-15)— Parking/Parking on hills (P.5-19)— Checking (P.8-21)

SSI0257

0-8 Illustrated table of contents

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 14: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

17. Selector lever or shift lever— Automatic transmission (P.5-10)— Manual transmission (P.5-13)

18. Cargo net (P.2-33)*: if so equipped*1: Refer to the separate Navigation SystemOwner’s Manual.

Illustrated table of contents 0-9

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 15: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Headlight/turn signal switch (P.2-24)2. Instrument brightness control switch(P.2-26)

3. Steering wheel switch for audio control*(P.4-29) or switch for Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System* (P.4-31)

4. Driver supplemental air bag (P.1-28)/Horn(P.2-27)

5. Meters/gauges (P.2-3)6. Cruise control main/set switch* (P.5-16)7. Trip computer mode/setting switch (P.2-8)8. Wiper/washer switch (P.2-21)

9. Center ventilator (P.4-8)10. Passenger supplemental air bag (P.1-28)11. Side ventilators (P.4-8)12. Soft top operating switch (for Roadstermodels) (P.3-13)

13. VDC (Vehicle dynamic control) OFF switch*(P.2-29) or TCS (Traction control system)OFF switch* (P.2-29)

14. Fuel-filler door opener switch (P.3-23)15. Hood lock release handle (P.3-8)16. Fuse box (P.8-23)17. Tilting steering wheel lock lever (P.3-25)18. Ignition switch (P.5-6)19. Navigation system display (P.4-2)*1 or In-strument pocket (P.2-32)

20. Audio system (P.4-12)/Clock (P.2-30)21. Rear window and outside mirror defrosterswitch (P.2-23)

22. Hazard warning flasher switch (P.2-27)23. Cup holder (P.2-33)24. Heated seat switch* (P.2-28)25. Heater/air conditioner control (P.4-9)26. Power outlet (P.2-31)*: if so equipped*1: Refer to the separate Navigation SystemOwner’s Manual.

SIC3266

INSTRUMENT PANEL

0-10 Illustrated table of contents

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 16: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Warning/Indicator lights (P.2-11)

2. Turn signal/hazard indicator lights (P.2-26)

3. Tachometer (P.2-5)

4. Speedometer (P.2-4)

5. Instrument brightness control switch(P.2-26)

6. Fuel gauge (P.2-6)

7. Engine coolant temperature gauge (P.2-5)

8. Automatic transmission position indicator(P.2-15, P.5-10) or Manual transmission up-shift indicator (P.2-10, P.5-14)

9. Reset knob for trip odometer (P.2-4)

10. Odometer (Total/Twin trip) (P.2-4)

11. Trip computer setting switch (P.2-8)

12. Trip computer mode switch (P.2-8)

13. Trip computer (P.2-8)

14. Engine oil pressure gauge (P.2-7)

15. Volt meter (P.2-8)

SIC3329Combination meter

SIC1948ATriple meter

METERS AND GAUGES

Illustrated table of contents 0-11

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 17: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Fuse/fusible link holder (P.8-21)

2. Battery (P.8-15)

3. Engine oil filler cap (P.8-9)

4. Brake fluid reservoir (P.8-13)

5. Clutch fluid reservoir (M/T models) (P.8-13)

6. Window washer fluid reservoir (P.8-14)

7. Power steering fluid reservoir (P.8-12)

8. Air cleaner (P.8-18)

9. Radiator filler cap (P.8-8)

10. Engine drive belts (P.8-17)

11. Engine coolant reservoir (P.8-8)

12. Engine oil dipstick (P.8-9)

Do not tamper with the strut tower baradjustment �A . The strut tower bar hasbeen adjusted to the most suitable posi-tion at the factory.

SDI2050

ENGINE COMPARTMENT

0-12 Illustrated table of contents

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 18: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supple-mental restraint system

Seats ........................................................................................ 1-2Front manual seat adjustment(for Coupe models) ........................................................ 1-3Front power seat adjustment(for Coupe models — if so equipped) ...................... 1-3Front power seat adjustment(for Roadster models) .................................................... 1-4Seat lifter (for driver’s seat) ......................................... 1-6Tilting and reclining passenger’s seat from driver’sseat ..................................................................................... 1-7Head restraint adjustment ............................................ 1-9Front-seat Active Head Restraints (except forventilated net seats)...................................................... 1-10

Seat belts ............................................................................. 1-10Precautions on seat belt usage ................................ 1-10Child safety .................................................................... 1-12Pregnant women .......................................................... 1-13Injured persons ............................................................. 1-14

Three-point type seat belt with retractor ............... 1-14Seat belt extenders ...................................................... 1-16Seat belt maintenance ................................................ 1-17

Child restraints ................................................................... 1-17Precautions on child restraints ................................. 1-17Child restraint installation on front passengerseat (Coupe models only) .......................................... 1-20Top tether strap child restraint(Coupe models only) ................................................... 1-24

Booster seats ....................................................................... 1-25Precautions on booster seats .................................... 1-25Booster seat installation on front passengerseat.................................................................................... 1-27

Supplemental restraint system ....................................... 1-28Precautions on supplemental restraint system ..... 1-28Supplemental air bag warning labels ...................... 1-42Supplemental air bag warning light ......................... 1-43

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 19: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

� Do not ride in a moving vehicle whenthe seatback is reclined. This can bedangerous. The shoulder belt will notbe against your body. In an accident,you could be thrown into it and re-ceive neck or other serious injuries.You could also slide under the lapbelt and receive serious internalinjuries.

� For the most effective protectionwhen the vehicle is in motion, theseat should be upright. Always sitwell back in the seat with both feeton the floor and adjust the seat prop-erly. See “Precautions on seat beltusage” later in this section.

� After adjustment, gently rock in theseat to make sure it is securelylocked.

� Do not leave children unattended in-

side the vehicle. They could unknow-ingly activate switches or controls.Unattended children could becomeinvolved in serious accidents.

� Do not adjust the driver’s seat whiledriving so full attention may be givento vehicle operation. The seat maymove suddenly and could cause lossof control of the vehicle.

SSS0133

SEATS

1-2 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 20: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

FRONT MANUAL SEATADJUSTMENT (for Coupe models)

�1 Forward and backwardPull the lever up while you slide the seat forwardor backward to the desired position. Release thelever to lock the seat in position.

When sliding the passenger’s seat backward,be careful not to crush items in the seatbackpocket against the rear floor box.

�2 RecliningTo recline the seatback, pull the lever up andlean back. To bring the seatback forward again,pull the lever and move your body forward. Theseatback will move forward.

The reclining feature allows adjustment of theseatback for occupants of different sizes foradded comfort and to help obtain proper seatbelt fit. See “Precautions on seat belt usage”later in this section. The seatback may also bereclined to allow occupants to rest when thevehicle is stopped and the transmission is in theP (Park) position or N (Neutral) position with theparking brake fully applied.

FRONT POWER SEATADJUSTMENT (for Coupe models —if so equipped)

Operating tips� The seat motor has an auto-reset overloadprotection circuit. If the motor stops duringoperation, wait 30 seconds, then reactivatethe switch.

� Do not operate the power support seatfor a long period of time when the engine isoff. This will discharge the battery.

SSS0394

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-3

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 21: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

�1 Forward and backwardMoving the sliding switch forward or backwardwill slide the seat forward or backward to thedesired position.

When sliding the passenger’s seat backward,be careful not to crush items in the seatbackpocket against the rear floor box.

�2 Reclining (for driver’s seat)Move the reclining switch backward until thedesired angle is obtained. To bring the seatbackforward, move the switch forward and move yourbody forward. The seatback will move forward.

�2 Reclining (for passenger’s seat)The passenger’s seat is equipped with a manuallever for reclining. See “Front manual seat ad-justment” earlier in this section.

The reclining feature allows adjustment of theseatback for occupants of different sizes foradded comfort and to help obtain proper seatbelt fit. See “Precautions on seat belt usage”later in this section. The seatback may also bereclined to allow occupants to rest when thevehicle is stopped and the transmission is in theP (Park) or N (Neutral) position with the parkingbrake fully applied.

FRONT POWER SEATADJUSTMENT (for Roadster models)

Operating tips� The seat motor has an auto-reset overloadprotection circuit. If the motor stops duringoperation, wait 30 seconds, then reactivatethe switch.

� Do not operate the power support seatfor a long period of time when the engine isoff. This will discharge the battery.

SPA1793

1-4 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 22: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

�1 Forward and backwardMoving the sliding switch forward or backwardwill slide the seat forward or backward to thedesired position.

When sliding the passenger’s seat backward,be careful not to crush items in the seatbackpocket against the rear floor box.

�2 RecliningMove the reclining switch backward until thedesired angle is obtained. To bring the seatbackforward, move the switch forward and move yourbody forward. The seatback will move forward.

The reclining feature allows adjustment of theseatback for occupants of different sizes foradded comfort and to help obtain proper seatbelt fit. See “Precautions on seat belt usage”later in this section. The seatback may also bereclined to allow occupants to rest when thevehicle is stopped and the transmission is in theP (Park) or N (Neutral) position with the parkingbrake fully applied.

Automatic passenger seatback tiltfunctionThe passenger seatback will automatically tiltforward and backward during the soft topopen/close operation. If you need to cancel this

function or when a child restraint is installed inthe passenger’s seat, push the seatback tiltcancel switch to the CANCEL position. For moreinformation about operation conditions, see“Soft top” in the “3. Pre-driving checks andadjustments” section. For the cancel switch, see“Tilting and reclining passenger’s seat from driv-er’s seat” later in this section.

SSS0472

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-5

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 23: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Ventilated net seats (if so equipped)

The ventilated net seats are designed for goodventilation while driving. Net cloth is used on thesurface of the seatback and the cushion asshown.

CAUTION

� The seat is made of netted materials.Be careful not to snag your jewelry,such as a ring, bracelet or watch, onthe seat.

� When using these seats, avoid wear-ing clothing with soft fabrics (wool,etc.). Clothing may be damaged as itrubs against the netted material.

SEAT LIFTER (for driver’s seat)

Type A (except for ventilated net seat)Turn either dial to adjust the angle and height ofthe seat cushion to the desired position.

SSS0272 SPA1715Type A

1-6 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 24: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Type B (for ventilated net seat)Turn the dial and adjust the angle of the seatcushion to the desired position.

TILTING AND RECLININGPASSENGER’S SEAT FROMDRIVER’S SEATThe passenger seatback can be adjusted fromthe driver’s seat to make it easier for the driver touse the rear parcel box or rear floor box, or tohelp the passenger get in the vehicle.

Coupe models (manual type)To tilt or recline the passenger seatback, pull upthe lever �A located on the back side of it, andmove the seatback forward or backward.

Roadster models (power type)

The power seatback tilt switch �B and theseatback tilt cancel switch�C are located on theback side of the passenger seatback as shown.

Tilting/reclining operation:

To tilt the passenger seatback forward, push thetop ( side) of the power seatback tiltswitch �B for more than 0.5 second. The seat-back will automatically tilt forward. To stop themovement, push the top or bottom of the switch.

To tilt or adjust the seatback backward, pushand hold the bottom ( side) of the power

SSS0202Type B

SSS0203Coupe models

SSS0273Roadster models — Type A

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-7

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 25: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

seatback tilt switch. While the switch is helddown, the seatback will move backward to theoriginal position that was last selected using thereclining switch (located on the seat cushion).Release the switch to stop the movement.

Operation conditions:

The power seatback tilt switch does not activateunder the following conditions.

� when the passenger seat sliding/recliningswitches on the seat cushion are being op-erated.

� when the seat tilt cancel switch is in theCANCEL position. (See “Seatback tilt cancel

switch” later in this section.)

� when the passenger seat belt is fastened.

� when the vehicle speed reaches 4 MPH (7km/h) and more.

The automatic tilting/reclining movement will bestopped:

� when any of the above 4 conditions occur.

� when the power seatback tilt switch (top orbottom) is pushed again.

� when the seatback is moved with the soft topopen/close operation.

When this interruption occurs, you cannot movethe seatback backward from the stopped posi-tion with the power seatback tilt switch. Use thereclining switch (on the seat cushion) to selectthe seatback position.

Seatback tilt cancel switch:

When the seatback tilt cancel switch �C ispushed to the CANCEL position, thetilting/reclining operation using the power seat-back tilt switch �B will be cancelled. Only thesliding/reclining switches (located on the seatcushion) are operational. Push the seatback tiltcancel switch to the AUTO position to reactivatethe power seatback tilt switch.

This cancel switch is linked with the automaticpassenger seatback tilt function of the soft topoperation. See “Soft top” in the “3. Pre-drivingchecks and adjustments” section.

SSS0274Roadster models — Type B

SSS0275

1-8 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 26: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CAUTION

When a child restraint is installed in thepassenger seat, be sure to turn the seat-back tilt cancel switch to the CANCELposition. Otherwise, the child restraintmay be damaged.

HEAD RESTRAINT ADJUSTMENTTo raise the head restraint, just pull it up. Tolower, push the lock knob�A and push the headrestraint down.

The ventilated net seats (if so equipped forRoadster models) have non-adjustable headrestraints.

Adjust the head restraints so the center is levelwith the center of your ears.

WARNING

Head restraints should be adjustedproperly as they may provide significantprotection against injury in an accident.Do not remove them. Check the adjust-ment after someone else uses the seat.

SSS0204 SSS0178A

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-9

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 27: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

FRONT-SEAT ACTIVE HEADRESTRAINTS (except for ventilatednet seats)

WARNING

� Always adjust the head restraintsproperly as specified in the previoussection. Failure to do so can reducethe effectiveness of the active headrestraint.

� Active Head Restraints are designed

to supplement other safety systems.Always wear seat belts. No systemcan prevent all injuries in any acci-dent.

� Do not attach anything to the headrestraint stalks. Doing so could im-pair Active Head Restraint function.

The Active Head Restraint moves forward utiliz-ing the force that the seatback receives from theoccupant in a rear-end collision. The movementof the head restraint helps support the occu-pant’s head by reducing its backward movementand helping absorb some of the forces that maylead to whiplash type injuries.

Active Head Restraints are effective for colli-sions at low to medium speeds in which it is saidthat whiplash injury occurs most.

Active Head Restraints operate only in certainrear-end collisions. After the collision, the headrestraints return to their original positions.

Properly adjust the Active Head Restraints asdescribed in the previous section.

PRECAUTIONS ON SEAT BELTUSAGEIf you are wearing your seat belt properly ad-justed and you are sitting upright and well backin your seat with both feet on the floor, yourchances of being injured or killed in an accidentand/or the severity of injury may be greatlyreduced. NISSAN strongly encourages you andall of your passengers to buckle up every timeyou drive, even if your seating position includes asupplemental air bag.

Most U.S. states and Canadian provincesor territories require that seat belts beworn at all times when a vehicle is beingdriven.

SSS0508

SEAT BELTS

1-10 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 28: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

� Every person who drives or rides inthis vehicle should use a seat belt atall times.

� The seat belt should be properly ad-justed to a snug fit. Failure to do somay reduce the effectiveness of theentire restraint system and increasethe chance or severity of injury in

an accident. Serious injury or deathcan occur if the seat belt is not wornproperly.

� Always route the shoulder belt overyour shoulder and across your chest.Never put the belt behind your back,under your arm or across your neck.The belt should be away from yourface and neck, but not falling off yourshoulder.

� Position the lap belt as low and snugas possible AROUND THE HIPS, NOTTHE WAIST. A lap belt worn too highcould increase the risk of internalinjuries in an accident.

� Be sure the seat belt tongue is se-curely fastened to the proper buckle.

� Do not wear the seat belt inside outor twisted. Doing so may reduce itseffectiveness.

� Do not allow more than one personto use the same seat belt.

� Never carry more people in the ve-hicle than there are seat belts. Thisvehicle has only two seating posi-tions. Never allow anyone to ride inthe luggage area.

� If the seat belt warning light glowscontinuously while the ignition isturned ON with all doors closed andall seat belts fastened, it may indi-cate a malfunction in the system.Have the system checked by aNISSAN dealer.

SSS0136

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-11

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 29: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� Once a seat belt pretensioner hasactivated, it cannot be reused andmust be replaced together with theretractor. See a NISSAN dealer.

� Removal and installation of the pre-tensioner system componentsshould be done by a NISSAN dealer.

� All seat belt assemblies, includingretractors and attaching hardware,should be inspected after any colli-sion by a NISSAN dealer. NISSANrecommends that all seat belt as-

semblies in use during a collision bereplaced unless the collision was mi-nor and the belts show no damageand continue to operate properly.Seat belt assemblies not in use dur-ing a collision should also be in-spected and replaced if either dam-age or improper operation is noted.

CHILD SAFETY

Children need adults to help protect them.They need to be properly restrained.

In addition to the general information in thismanual, child safety information is available frommany other sources, including doctors, teachers,government traffic safety offices, and communityorganizations. Every child is different, so be sureto learn the best way to transport your child.

There are three basic types of child restraintsystems:

� Rear facing child restraint (should not beinstalled in this vehicle)

� Front facing child restraint (should not beinstalled in the Roadster models)

� Booster seat

WARNING

� Never let an infant who requires theuse of a rear facing child restraintride in this vehicle. Do not attempt tohold a child in your lap or arms.

� Roadster models do not have an an-chor for a top tether strap required

SSS0134

1-12 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 30: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

for most front facing child restraints.Never let children who require theuse of a front facing child restraintride in Roadster models.

� Children need special protection. Thevehicle’s seat belts may not fit themproperly. The shoulder belt may cometoo close to the face or neck. The lapbelt may not fit over their small hipbones. In an accident, an improperlyfitting seat belt could cause seriousor fatal injury. Always use appropri-ate child restraints.

� Never let a child stand or kneel onany seat and do not allow a child inthe cargo areas while the vehicle ismoving. The child could be seriouslyinjured or killed in an accident orsudden stop.

Your vehicle is equipped with a supplementalfront impact air bag system for the front passen-ger. See “Supplemental restraint system” later inthis section. The passenger seat is not suitablefor use with a rear facing child restraint neededfor infants. Therefore, infants should not be

transported in this vehicle.

All US states and provinces of Canada requirethe use of approved child restraints for infantsand small children. (See “Child restraints” later inthis section.)

Also, there are other types of child restraintsavailable for larger children for additional protec-tion.

InfantsInfants up to at least 1 year old should be placedin a rear facing child restraint. Because a rearfacing child restraint is not suitable for use in thisvehicle, infants should not be transported in it.

Small childrenChildren that are over 1 year old and weigh atleast 20 lbs (9 kg) can be placed in a forwardfacing child restraint (except Roadster models).Refer to the manufacturer’s instructions for mini-mum and maximum weight and height recom-mendations. NISSAN recommends that smallchildren be placed in child restraints that complywith Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards orCanadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. Youshould choose a child restraint that fits yourvehicle and always follow the manufacturer’sinstructions for installation and use.

Larger childrenChildren who are too large for child restraintsystems should be seated and restrained by theseat belts which are provided. The seat belt maynot fit properly if the child is less than 4 ft 9 in(142.5 cm) tall and weighs between 40 lbs (18kg) and 80 lbs (36 kg). A booster seat should beused to obtain proper seat belt fit.

NISSAN recommends that a child be placed in acommercially available booster seat if the shoul-der belt in the child’s seating position fits closeto the face or neck or if the lap portion of the seatbelt goes across the abdomen. The booster seatshould raise the child so that the shoulder belt isproperly positioned across the top, middle por-tion of the shoulder and the lap belt is low on thehips. A booster seat can only be used in seatingpositions that have a three-point type seat belt.The booster seat should fit the vehicle seat andhave a label certifying that it complies withFederal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Ca-nadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. Oncethe child has grown so the shoulder belt is nolonger on or near the face and neck, use theshoulder belt without the booster seat.

PREGNANT WOMENNISSAN recommends that pregnant women useseat belts. The seat belt should be worn snug,and always position the lap belt as low as

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-13

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 31: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

possible around the hips, not the waist. Placethe shoulder belt over your shoulder and acrossyour chest. Never run the lap/shoulder belt overyour abdominal area. Contact your doctor forspecific recommendations.

INJURED PERSONS

NISSAN recommends that injured persons useseat belts, depending on the injury. Check withyour doctor for specific recommendations.

THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELTWITH RETRACTOR

WARNING

� Every person who drives or rides inthis vehicle should use a seat belt atall times.

� Do not ride in a moving vehicle whenthe seatback is reclined. This can bedangerous. The shoulder belt will notbe against your body. In an accident,you could be thrown into it and re-ceive neck or other serious injuries.You could also slide under the lap

belt and receive serious internal inju-ries.

� For the most effective protectionwhen the vehicle is in motion, theseat should be upright. Always sitwell back in the seat with both feeton the floor and adjust the seat beltproperly.

Fastening the seat belts

1. Adjust the seat. See “Seats” earlier in thissection.

2. Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractorand insert the tongue into the buckle until itclicks.

� The retractor is designed to lock duringa sudden stop or on impact. A slowpulling motion will permit the belt tomove, and allow you some freedom ofmovement in the seat.

� If the seat belt cannot be pulled from itsfully retracted position, firmly pull the

SSS0292A

1-14 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 32: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

belt and release it. Then smoothly pullthe belt out of the retractor.

3. Position the lap belt portion low and snugon the hips as shown.

4. Pull the shoulder belt portion toward theretractor to take up extra slack. Be sure theshoulder belt is routed over your shoulderand across your chest.

The front passenger seat belt has two modes ofoperation:

� Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)

� Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)

The Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) modeallows the seat belt to extend and retract to allowthe driver and passenger some freedom ofmovement in the seat. The ELR locks the seatbelt when the vehicle slows down rapidly orduring certain impacts.

The Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode(child restraint mode) locks the seat belt for childrestraint installation.

When the ALR mode is activated the seat beltcannot be extended again until the seat belttongue is detached from the buckle and fullyretracted. The seat belt returns to the ELR modeafter the seat belt fully retracts. For additionalinformation, see “Child restraints” later in thissection.

The ALR mode should be used only forchild restraint installation. During normalseat belt use by a passenger, the ALRmode should not be activated. If it is acti-vated it may cause uncomfortable seat belttension.

WARNING

When fastening the seat belts, be cer-tain that the seatbacks are completely

secured in the latched position. If theyare not completely secured, passengersmay be injured in an accident or suddenstop.

SSS0290A

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-15

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 33: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Unfastening the seat belts

To unfasten the belt, push the button on thebuckle. The seat belt will automatically retract.

Checking seat belt operation

Your seat belt retractors are designed to lockbelt movement using two separate methods:

� when the belt is pulled quickly from theretractor.

� when the vehicle slows down rapidly.

You can check their operation as follows:

� grasp the shoulder belt and pull quickly for-

ward. The retractor should lock and restrictfurther belt movement.

If the retractor does not lock during this check orif you have any questions about belt operation,see a NISSAN dealer.

Shoulder belt arm

The shoulder belt arm should be adjusted to theposition best for you. (See “Precautions on seatbelt usage” earlier in this section.)

To adjust, pull the shoulder belt arm. Pulling thearm forward will allow an easy access to the belt.

SEAT BELT EXTENDERSIf, because of body size or driving position, it isnot possible to properly fit the lap-shoulder beltand fasten it, an extender is available. The ex-tender adds approximately 8 in (200 mm) oflength and may be used for either the driver orpassenger seating position. See a NISSAN

SSS0326 SSS0588

1-16 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 34: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

dealer for assistance if the extender is required.

WARNING

� Only NISSAN seat belt extenders,made by the same company whichmade the original equipment seatbelts, should be used with NISSANseat belts.

� Persons who can use the standardseat belt should not use an extender.Such unnecessary use could result inserious personal injury in the eventof an accident.

� Never use seat belt extenders to in-stall child restraints. If the child re-straint is not secured properly, thechild could be seriously injured in acollision or a sudden stop.

SEAT BELT MAINTENANCE

� To clean the seat belt webbings, apply amild soap solution or any solution recom-mended for cleaning upholstery or carpets.Then brush the webbing, wipe it with a clothand allow it to dry in the shade. Do not allow

the seat belts to retract until they are com-pletely dry.

� If dirt builds up in the shoulder belt guide ofthe seat belt anchors, the seat belts mayretract slowly. Wipe the shoulder belt guidewith a clean, dry cloth.

� Periodically check to see that the seatbelt and the metal components such asbuckles, tongues, retractors, flexible wiresand anchors work properly. If loose parts,deterioration, cuts or other damage on thewebbing is found, the entire belt assemblyshould be replaced.

PRECAUTIONS ON CHILDRESTRAINTS

WARNING

� Children should always be placed inan appropriate child restraint whileriding in the vehicle. Failure to use achild restraint can result in seriousinjury or death.

� Children should never be carried onyour lap. It is not possible for even

SSS0099

CHILD RESTRAINTS

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-17

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 35: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

the strongest adult to resist theforces of a severe accident. The childcould be crushed between the adultand parts of the vehicle. Also, do notput the same seat belt around bothyour child and yourself.

� Even with the NISSAN Advanced AirBag System, never install a rear-facing child restraint in the front seat.An inflating supplemental air bagcould seriously injure or kill yourchild.

� Never let an infant who requires theuse of a rear facing child restraintride in this vehicle.

� Roadster models do not have an an-chor for a top tether strap requiredfor most front facing child restraints.

Never let children who require theuse of a front facing child restraintride in Roadster models.

� Improper use or improper installationof a child restraint can increase therisk or severity of injury for both thechild and other occupants of the ve-hicle and can lead to serious injury ordeath in an accident.

� Follow all of the child restraint manu-facturer’s instructions for installationand use. When purchasing a childrestraint, be sure to select one whichwill fit your child and vehicle. It maynot be possible to properly installsome types of child restraints in yourvehicle.

� If the child restraint is not anchoredproperly, the risk of a child beinginjured in a collision or a sudden stopgreatly increases.

� Child restraint anchor point is de-signed to withstand only those loadsimposed by correctly fitted child re-straint. Under no circumstances is it

SSS0100

1-18 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 36: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

to be used for adult seat belts orharnesses.

� Adjustable seatbacks should be po-sitioned to fit the child restraint, butas upright as possible.

� After attaching the child restraint,test it before you place the child in it.Push it from side to side while hold-ing the seat by the seat belt path. Tryto tug it forward and check to see ifthe belt holds the restraint in place.The child restraint should not movemore than 1 in (25 mm). If the re-straint is not secure, tighten the beltas necessary, or put the restraint inanother seating position and test itagain. You may need to try a differentchild restraint. Not all child restraintsfit in all types of vehicles.

� When your child restraint is not inuse, keep it secured with a seat beltto prevent it from being thrownaround in case of a sudden stop oraccident.

CAUTION

� For Roadster models, when installinga booster seat, be sure to turn off theautomatic passenger seatback tiltfunction with the seatback tilt cancelswitch (located on the back of thepassenger seatback). Otherwise, thebooster seat may be damaged. See“Tilting and reclining passenger’sseat from driver’s seat” earlier in thissection for detailed information.

� Remember that a child restraint leftin a closed vehicle can become veryhot. Check the seating surface andbuckles before placing your child inthe child restraint.

In general, child restraints are designed to beinstalled with the lap portion of a lap/shoulderseat belt.Several manufacturers offer child restraints forchildren of various sizes. When selecting anychild restraint, keep the following points in mind:

� Choose only a restraint with a label certifyingthat it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle

Safety Standard 213 or Canadian MotorVehicle Safety Standard 213.

� Check the child restraint in your vehicle to besure it is compatible with the vehicle’s seatand seat belt system.

� If the child restraint is compatible with yourvehicle, place your child in the child restraintand check the various adjustments to be surethe child restraint is compatible with yourchild. Choose a child restraint that is de-signed for your child’s height and weight.Always follow all recommended procedures.

The passenger seat is not suitable for use with arear facing child restraint for infants. Therefore,infants should not be transported in this vehicle.

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces orterritories require that infants and smallchildren be restrained in approved childrestraint at all times while the vehicle isbeing operated.

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-19

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 37: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATIONON FRONT PASSENGER SEAT(Coupe models only)

WARNING

� Even with the NISSAN Advanced AirBag System, never install a rear-facing child restraint in the front pas-senger seat. Front air bags inflatewith great force. A rear-facing childrestraint could be struck by the front

air bag in a crash and could seriouslyinjure or kill your child.

� If you must install a forward facingchild restraint in the front passengerseat, move the passenger seat to therearmost position. Also, be sure thefront passenger air bag status light isilluminated to indicate the passengerair bag is OFF. See “Front passengerair bag and status light” in this sec-tion for details.

� The three-point seat belt in your ve-hicle is equipped with an AutomaticLocking Retractor (ALR) which mustbe used when installing a child re-straint.

� Failure to use the ALR mode willresult in the child restraint not beingproperly secured. The restraint couldtip over or otherwise be unsecuredand cause injury to the child in asudden stop or collision.

SSS0261

1-20 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 38: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Front facing

If you must install a child restraint in the frontseat, follow these steps:

1. Position the child restraint on the front pas-senger seat. Move the seat to the rear-most position. Adjust the head restraint toits highest position (if so equipped). Alwaysfollow the restraint manufacturer’s instruc-tions.

The back of the child restraint should besecured against the vehicle seatback. If nec-essary, adjust or remove the head restraint toobtain the correct child restraint fit. See

“Head restraint adjustment” earlier in thissection. If the head restraint is removed, storeit in a secure place. Be sure to install thehead restraint when the child restraint isremoved. If the seating position does nothave an adjustable head restraint and it isinterfering with the proper child restraint fit,try a different child restraint.

2. Route the seat belt tongue through the childrestraint and insert it into the buckle until youhear and feel the latch engage. Be sure tofollow the child restraint manufacturer’s in-structions for belt routing.

SSS0640Front facing — step 1

SSS0360BFront facing — step 2

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-21

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 39: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

3. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fullyextended. At this time, the seat belt retractoris in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)mode (child restraint mode). It reverts toEmergency Locking Retractor (ELR) modewhen the seat belt is fully retracted.

4. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on theshoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.

5. Remove any additional slack from the seatbelt; press downward and rearward firmly inthe center of the child restraint with your kneeto compress the vehicle seat cushion andseatback while pulling up on the seat belt.

6. If the child restraint is equipped with a toptether strap, route the top tether strap andsecure the tether strap to the tether anchorpoint. See “Top tether strap child restraint” inthis section.

SSS0651Front facing — step 3

SSS0652Front facing — step 4

SSS0653Front facing — step 5

1-22 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 40: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

7. Before placing the child in the child restraint,hold the child restraint near the seat belt pathand use force to push the child restraint fromside to side, and tug it forward to make surethat it is securely held in place. It should notmove more than 1 in (25 mm). If it does movemore than 1 in (25 mm), pull again on theshoulder belt to further tighten the childrestraint. If you are unable to properly securethe restraint, try a different child restraint. Notall child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

8. Check that the retractor is in the ALR modeby trying to pull more seat belt out of theretractor. If you cannot pull any more belt

webbing out of the retractor, the retractor isin the ALR mode.

9. Check to make sure the child restraint isproperly secured prior to each use. If the seatbelt is not locked, repeat steps 2 through 7.

10. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.The front passenger air bag status light

should illuminate. If this light is notilluminated, see “Front passenger air bagand status light” in this section. Try a differ-ent child restraint. Have the systemchecked by a NISSAN dealer.

After the child restraint is removed and the seatbelt is fully retracted, the ALR mode (childrestraint mode) is canceled.

SSS0641Front facing — step 7

SSS0681Front facing — step 10

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-23

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 41: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

TOP TETHER STRAP CHILDRESTRAINT (Coupe models only)An anchor for a child restraint with a top tether isprovided in this vehicle.

If your child restraint has a top tether strap, itmust be secured to the provided anchor point.Secure the child restraint with the seat belt.Guide the top tether strap under the headrestraint as illustrated, and secure it to theanchor bracket. Tighten the strap according tomanufacturer instructions to remove any slack.

WARNING

� Child restraint anchor point is de-signed to withstand only those loadsimposed by correctly fitted child re-straints. Under no circumstance is itto be used for adult seat belts orharnesses.

� Do not allow cargo to contact the toptether strap when it is attached to thetop tether anchor. Properly securethe cargo so it does not contact thetop tether strap. Cargo that is notproperly secured or that contacts thetop tether strap may damage the toptether strap during a collision. Yourchild could be seriously injured orkilled in a collision if the child re-straint top tether strap is damaged.

Anchor point locationThe anchor point �A is located on the luggagearea floor.

A flap is provided in the carpet for easy accessand is marked with the label shown.

If you have any questions when installing atop tether strap child restraint on the pas-senger seat, consult a NISSAN dealer fordetails.

SSS0207 SPA1644

1-24 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 42: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

PRECAUTIONS ON BOOSTERSEATS

WARNING

� Children should always be placed inan appropriate child restraint whileriding in the vehicle. Failure to use achild restraint or booster seat canresult in serious injury or death.

� Children should never be carried onyour lap. It is not possible for even

the strongest adult to resist theforces of a severe accident. The childcould be crushed between the adultand parts of the vehicle. Also, do notput the same seat belt around bothyour child and yourself.

� A booster seat must only be installedin a seating position that has alap/shoulder belt. Failure to use athree-point type seat belt with abooster seat can result in a seriousinjury in sudden stop or collision.

� Improper use or improper installationof a booster seat can increase therisk or severity of injury for both thechild and other occupants of the ve-hicle and can lead to serious injury ordeath in an accident.

� Do not use towels, books, pillows orother items in place of a boosterseat. Items such as these may moveduring normal driving or a collisionand result in serious injury or death.Booster seats are designed to beused with a lap/shoulder belt.

Booster seats are designed to prop-erly route the lap and shoulder por-tions of the seat belt over the stron-gest portions of a child’s body toprovide the maximum protection dur-ing a collision.

� Follow all of the booster seat manu-facturer’s instructions for installationand use. When purchasing a boosterseat, be sure to select one which willfit your child and vehicle. It may notbe possible to properly install sometypes of booster seats in your ve-hicle.

� If the booster seat and seat belt arenot used properly, the risk of a childbeing injured in a collision or a sud-den stop greatly increases.

� Adjustable seatbacks should be po-sitioned to fit the booster seat, but asupright as possible.

� After placing the child in the boosterseat and fastening the seat belt,make sure the shoulder portion of

SSS0099

BOOSTER SEATS

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-25

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 43: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

the belt is away from the child’s faceand neck and the lap portion of thebelt does not cross the abdomen.

� Do not put the shoulder belt behindthe child or under the child’s arm. Ifyou must install a booster seat in thefront seat, see “Booster seat instal-lation on front passenger seat” laterin this section.

� When your booster seat is not in use,keep it secured with a seat belt toprevent it from being thrown aroundin case of a sudden stop or accident.

CAUTION

� For Roadster models, when installinga booster seat, be sure to turn off theautomatic passenger seatback tiltfunction with the seatback tilt cancelswitch (located on the back of thepassenger seatback). Otherwise, thebooster seat may be damaged. See“Tilting and reclining passenger’s

seat from driver’s seat” earlier in thissection for detailed information.

� Remember that a booster seat left ina closed vehicle can become very hot.Check the seating surface and buck-les before placing your child in thebooster seat.

Booster seats of various sizes are offered byseveral manufacturers. When selecting anybooster seat, keep the following points in mind:

� Choose only a booster seat with a labelcertifying that it complies with Federal MotorVehicle Safety Standard 213 or CanadianMotor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.

LRS0455

1-26 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 44: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� Check the booster seat in your vehicle to besure it is compatible with the vehicle’s seatand seat belt system.

� Make sure the child’s head will be properlysupported by the booster seat or vehicleseat. The seatback must be at or above thecenter of the child’s ears. For example, if alow back booster seat �1 is chosen, thevehicle seatback must be at or above thecenter of the child’s ears. If the seatback islower than the center of the child’s ears, ahigh back booster seat �2 should be used.

� If the booster seat is compatible with yourvehicle, place your child in the booster seatand check the various adjustments to be surethe booster seat is compatible with yourchild. Always follow all recommended proce-dures.

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces orterritories require that infants and smallchildren be restrained in an approved childrestraint at all times while the vehicle isbeing operated.

BOOSTER SEAT INSTALLATIONON FRONT PASSENGER SEAT

CAUTION

Do not use the lap/shoulder belt Auto-matic Locking Retractor mode when us-ing a booster seat with the seat belts.

Follow these steps to install a booster seat in thefront passenger seat:

If you must install a booster seat in thefront passenger seat, move the passengerseat to the rearmost position.

1. Turn the seatback tilt cancel switch to theCANCEL position. (Roadster models only)

2. Position the booster seat on the seat. Onlyplace it in a front facing direction. Alwaysfollow the booster seat manufacturer’s in-structions.

SSS0363 LRS0454

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-27

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 45: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

3. The booster seat should be positioned on thevehicle seat so that it is stable. If necessary,adjust or remove the head restraint to obtainthe correct booster seat fit. See “Head re-straint adjustment” earlier in this section. Ifthe head restraint is removed, store it in asecure place. Be sure to install the headrestraint when the booster seat is removed. Ifthe seating position does not have an adjust-able head restraint and it is interfering withthe proper booster seat fit, try a differentbooster seat.

4. Position the lap portion of the seat belt lowand snug on the child’s hips. Be sure tofollow the booster seat manufacturer’s in-

structions for adjusting the belt routing.

5. Pull the shoulder belt portion of the seat belttoward the retractor to take up extra slack. Besure the shoulder belt is positioned acrossthe top, middle portion of the child’s shoul-der. Be sure to follow the booster seat manu-facturer’s instructions for adjusting the beltrouting.

6. Follow the warnings, cautions and instruc-tions for properly fastening a seat belt shownin the “Three-point type seat belt with retrac-tor” earlier in this section.

7. If the booster seat is installed in the frontpassenger seat, turn the ignition switch to theON position. The front passenger air bagstatus light may or may not illuminatedepending on the size of the child and thetype of booster seat used. See “Front pas-senger air bag and status light” later in thissection.

PRECAUTIONS ONSUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINTSYSTEM

This Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) sec-tion contains important information concerningthe following systems:

� Driver and passenger supplemental front-impact air bag (NISSAN Advanced Air BagSystem)

� Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemen-tal air bag (if so equipped)

� Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supple-mental air bag (if so equipped for Coupemodels)

� Seat belt pretensioner

Supplemental front-impact air bag system:NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System can helpcushion the impact force to the head and chestof the driver and front passenger in certainfrontal collisions.Front seat-mounted side-impact supple-mental air bag system (if so equipped): Thissystem can help cushion the impact force to thechest area of the driver and front passenger incertain side impact collisions. The side air bagsare designed to inflate on the side where thevehicle is impacted.

LRS0454

SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINTSYSTEM

1-28 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 46: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supple-mental air bag system (if so equipped forCoupe models): This system can help cushionthe impact force to the head of occupants incertain side impact collisions. The curtain airbags are designed to inflate on the side wherethe vehicle is impacted.

The supplemental restraint system is designedto supplement the crash protection providedby the driver and passenger seat belts and isnot a substitute for them. Seat belts shouldalways be correctly worn and the occupantseated a suitable distance away from the steer-ing wheel, instrument panel, door finishers andside roof rails. (See “Seat belts” earlier in thissection for instructions and precautions on seatbelt usage.)

The supplemental air bags operate onlywhen the ignition switch is in the ON orSTART position.

After turning the ignition key to the ONposition, the supplemental air bag warninglight illuminates. The supplemental air bagwarning light will turn off after about 7seconds if the systems are operational.

WARNING

� The front air bags ordinarily will notinflate in the event of a side impact,rear impact, rollover, or lower sever-ity frontal collision. Always wear yourseat belts to help reduce the risk orseverity of injury in various kinds ofaccidents.

� The front passenger air bag will notinflate if the passenger air bag status

light is lit or if the front passengerseat is unoccupied. See “Front pas-senger air bag and status light” laterin this section.

� The seat belts and the front air bagsare most effective when you are sit-ting well back and upright in the seatwith both feet on the floor. The frontair bags inflate with great force. Evenwith the NISSAN Advanced Air BagSystem, if you are unrestrained, lean-ing forward, sitting sideways or out

SSS0131

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-29

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 47: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

of position in any way, you are atgreater risk of injury or death in acrash. You may also receive seriousor fatal injuries from the front air bagif you are up against it when it in-flates. Always sit back against theseatback and as far away as practicalfrom the steering wheel or instru-ment panel. Always use the seatbelts.

� The driver and front passenger seatbelt buckles are equipped with sen-sors that detect if the seat belts arefastened. The Advanced Air Bag Sys-tem monitors the severity of a colli-sion and seat belt usage then inflatesthe air bags. Failure to properly wearseat belts can increase the risk orseverity of injury in an accident.

� The front passenger seat is equippedwith an occupant classification sen-sor (pattern sensor) that turns thefront passenger air bag OFF undersome conditions. This sensor is onlyused in this seat. Failure to be prop-

erly seated and wearing the seat beltcan increase the risk or severity ofinjury in an accident. See “Front pas-senger air bag and status light” laterin this section.

� Keep hands on the outside of thesteering wheel. Placing them insidethe steering wheel rim could increasethe risk that they are injured whenthe front air bag inflates.

1-30 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 48: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

SSS0132 SSS0016

SSS0006

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-31

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 49: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

� Never let an infant who requires theuse of a rear facing child restraintride in this vehicle. Do not attempt tohold a child in your lap or arms. Someexamples of dangerous riding posi-tions are shown in the previous illus-trations.

� Roadster models do not have an an-chor for a top tether strap required

SSS0007

SSS0008

SSS0009

SSS0099

SSS0100

1-32 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 50: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

for most front facing child restraints.Never let children who require theuse of a front facing child restraintride in Roadster models.

� Children may be severely injured orkilled when the front air bags, side airbags or curtain air bags inflate if theyare not properly restrained.

� Even with the NISSAN Advanced AirBag System, never install a rear-facing child restraint in the front seat.An inflating front air bag could seri-ously injure or kill your child. See“Child restraints” earlier in this sec-tion for details. WARNING

Front seat-mounted side-impactsupplemental air bags and roof-mounted curtain side-impact supple-mental air bags (if so equipped):

� The side air bags and curtain air bagsordinarily will not inflate in the eventof a frontal impact, rear impact, roll-over or lower severity side collision.Always wear your seat belts to helpreduce the risk or severity of injury

in various kinds of accidents.

� The seat belts, side air bags andcurtain air bags are most effectivewhen you are sitting well back andupright in the seat. The side air bagsand curtain air bags inflate with greatforce. Do not allow anyone to placetheir hand, leg or face near the sideair bag on the side of the seatback ofthe front seat or near the side roofrails. Do not allow anyone sitting inthe front seat to extend their handout of the window or lean against the

SSS0101 SSS0159

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-33

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 51: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

door. Some examples of dangerousriding positions are shown in the pre-vious illustrations.

� Do not use seat covers on the frontseatbacks. They may interfere withside air bag inflation.

1. Crash zone sensor

2. Supplemental front-impact air bag modules

3. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact supple-mental air bags (if so equipped for Coupemodels)

4. Occupant classification sensor (pattern sen-sor)

5. Occupant classification system control unit

6. Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemen-tal air bag modules (if so equipped)

SSS0162

SSS0680

1-34 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 52: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

7. Air bag Control Unit (ACU)

8. Satellite sensors

9. Seat belt pretensioners

NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System

This vehicle is equipped with the NISSAN Ad-vanced Air Bag System for the driver and frontpassenger seats. This system is designed tomeet certification requirements under U.S. regu-lations. It is also permitted in Canada. However,all of the information, cautions and warn-ings in this manual still apply and must befollowed.

The driver supplemental front-impact air bag islocated in the center of the steering wheel. Thepassenger supplemental front-impact air bag ismounted in the instrument panel. The front airbags are designed to inflate in higher severityfrontal collisions, although they may inflate if theforces in another type of collision are similar tothose of a higher severity frontal impact. Theymay not inflate in certain frontal collisions. Ve-hicle damage (or lack of it) is not always anindication of proper air bag system operation.

The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System has dualstage air bag inflators. It also monitors informa-tion from the crash zone sensor, the Air bagControl Unit (ACU), seat belt buckle sensorsand the occupant classification sensor (pattern

sensor). Inflator operation is based on the sever-ity of a collision and seat belt usage for thedriver. For the front passenger, the occupantclassification sensor is also monitored. Based oninformation from the sensors, only one front airbag may inflate in a crash, depending on thecrash severity and whether the front occupantsare belted or unbelted. Additionally, the frontpassenger air bag may be automatically turnedOFF under some conditions, depending on theinformation provided by the occupant classifica-tion sensor. If the front passenger air bag is OFF,the passenger air bag status light will be illumi-nated (if the seat is unoccupied, the light will notbe illuminated, but the air bag will be off.). See“Front passenger air bag and status light” later inthis section for further details. One front air baginflating does not indicate improper performanceof the system.

If you have any questions about your air bagsystem, contact NISSAN or a NISSAN dealer. Ifyou are considering modifications of your vehicledue to a disability, you may also contactNISSAN. Contact information is contained in thefront of this Owner’s Manual.

When a front air bag inflates, a fairly loud noisemay be heard, followed by release of smoke.This smoke is not harmful and does not indicatea fire. Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it

may cause irritation and choking. Those with ahistory of a breathing condition should get freshair promptly.

Front air bags, along with the use of seat belts,help to cushion the impact force on the head andchest of the front occupants. They can help savelives and reduce serious injuries. However, aninflating front air bag may cause facial abrasionsor other injuries. Front air bags do not providerestraint to the lower body.

Even with NISSAN advanced air bags, seat beltsshould be correctly worn and the driver andpassenger seated upright as far as practicalaway from the steering wheel or instrumentpanel. The front air bags inflate quickly in orderto help protect the front occupants. Because ofthis, the force of the front air bag inflating canincrease the risk of injury if the occupant is tooclose to, or is against, the air bag module duringinflation.

The air bag will deflate quickly after a collision.

The front air bags operate only when theignition switch is in the ON or START po-sition.

After turning the ignition key to the ONposition, the supplemental air bag warninglight illuminates. The supplemental air bagwarning light will turn off after about 7

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-35

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 53: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

seconds if the system is operational.

Front passenger air bag and statuslight

WARNING

The front passenger air bag is designedto automatically turn OFF under someconditions. Read this section carefullyto learn how it operates. Proper use ofthe seat, seat belt and child restraints isnecessary for most effective protection.

Failure to follow all instructions in thismanual concerning the use of seats,seat belts and child restraints can in-crease the risk or severity of injury in anaccident.

Status light:

The front passenger air bag status light islocated on the overhead console. The light op-erates as follows:

� Unoccupied passenger seat: The lightis OFF and the front passenger air bag isOFF and will not inflate in a crash.

� Passenger seat occupied by a small adult,child or child restraint as outlined in thissection: The light illuminates to indicatethat the front passenger air bag is OFF andwill not inflate in a crash.

� Occupied passenger seat and the passengermeets the conditions outlined in this section:The light is OFF to indicate that thefront passenger air bag is operational.

Front passenger air bag:

The front passenger air bag is designed toautomatically turn OFF when the vehicle is op-erated under some conditions as described

SSS0681Front passenger air bag status light

1-36 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 54: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

below in accordance with U.S. regulations. If thefront passenger air bag is OFF, it will not inflatein a crash. The driver air bag and other air bagsin your vehicle are not part of this system.

The purpose of the regulation is to help reducethe risk of injury or death from an inflating air bagto certain front passenger seat occupants, suchas children, by requiring the air bag to beautomatically turned OFF.

The occupant classification sensor (pattern sen-sor) is in the front passenger seat cushion and isdesigned to detect an occupant and objects onthe seat. For example, if a child is in the frontpassenger seat, the Advanced Air Bag System isdesigned to turn the passenger air bag OFF inaccordance with the regulations. Also, if a childrestraint of the type specified in the regulationsis on the seat, the occupant classification sensorcan detect it and cause the air bag to turn OFF.

Front passenger seat adult occupants who areproperly seated and using the seat belt asoutlined in this manual should not cause thepassenger air bag to be automatically turnedOFF. For small adults it may be turned OFF,however, if the occupant does not sit in the seatproperly (for example, by not sitting upright, bysitting on an edge of the seat, or by otherwisebeing out of position), this could cause thesensor to turn the air bag OFF. Always be sure to

be seated and wearing the seat belt properly forthe most effective protection by the seat belt andsupplemental air bag.

The occupant classification sensor is designedto operate as described above to turn the frontpassenger air bag OFF for specified child re-straints as required by the regulations. Failing toproperly secure child restrains and to use theAutomatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (childrestraint mode) may allow the restraint to tip ormove in an accident or sudden stop. This canalso result in the passenger air bag inflating in acrash instead of being OFF. See “Child re-straints” earlier in this section for proper use andinstallation.

If the front passenger seat is not occupied, thepassenger air bag is designed not to inflate in acrash. However, heavy objects placed on theseat could result in air bag inflation, because ofthe object being detected by the occupantclassification sensor. Other conditions couldalso result in air bag inflation, such as if a child isstanding on the seat, or if two children are on theseat, contrary to the instructions in this manual.Always be sure that you and all vehicle occu-pants are seated and restrained properly.

Using the passenger air bag status light, you canmonitor when the front passenger air bag isautomatically turned OFF with the seat occu-

pied. The light will not illuminate when the frontpassenger seat is unoccupied.

If an adult occupant is in the seat but thepassenger air bag status light is illuminated(indicating that the air bag is OFF), it could bethat the person is a small adult, or is not sittingon the seat properly.

If a child restraint must be used in the front seat,the passenger air bag status light may or may notbe illuminated, depending on the size of the childand the type of child restraint being used. If theair bag status light is not illuminated (indicatingthat the air bag might inflate in a crash), it couldbe that the child restraint or seat belt is not beingused properly. Make sure that the child restraintis installed properly, the seat belt is used prop-erly and the occupant is positioned properly. Ifthe air bag status light is still not illuminated, trya different child restraint.

If the passenger air bag status light will notilluminate even though you believe that the childrestraint, the seat belts and the occupant areproperly positioned, the system may be sensingan unoccupied seat (in which case the air bag isOFF). A NISSAN dealer can check that thesystem is OFF by using a special tool. However,until you have confirmed with your dealer thatyour air bag is working properly, do not transporta child in this vehicle.

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-37

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 55: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The air bag system and passenger air bag statuslight will take a few seconds to register a changein the passenger seat status. However, if theseat becomes unoccupied, the air bag statuslight will remain off.

If a malfunction occurs in the front passenger airbag system, the supplemental air bag warninglight , located in the meter and gaugesarea, will blink. Have the system checked by aNISSAN dealer.

Other supplemental front-impact airbag precautions

WARNING

� Do not place any objects on thesteering wheel pad or on the instru-ment panel. Also, do not place anyobjects between any occupant andthe steering wheel or instrumentpanel. Such objects may becomedangerous projectiles and cause in-jury if the front air bag inflates.

� Do not place objects with sharpedges on the seat. Also, do not place

heavy objects on the seat that willleave permanent impressions in theseat. Such objects can damage theseat or occupant classification sen-sor (pattern sensor). This can affectthe operation of the air bag systemand result in serious personal injury.

� Do not use water or acidic cleaners(hot steam cleaners) on the seat. Thiscan damage the seat or occupantclassification sensor. This can alsoaffect the operation of the air bagsystem and result in serious personalinjury.

� Immediately after inflation, severalfront air bag system components willbe hot. Do not touch them; you mayseverely burn yourself.

� No unauthorized changes should bemade to any components or wiring ofthe supplemental air bag system.This is to prevent accidental inflationof the supplemental air bag or dam-age to the supplemental air bagsystem.

� Do not make unauthorized changesto your vehicle’s electrical system,suspension system or front endstructure. This could affect properoperation of the front air bag system.

� Tampering with the front air bag sys-tem may result in serious personalinjury. Tampering includes changesto the steering wheel and the instru-ment panel assembly by placing ma-terial over the steering wheel padand above the instrument panel or byinstalling additional trim materialaround the air bag system.

� Modifying or tampering with the frontpassenger seat may result in seriouspersonal injury. For example, do notchange the front seats by placingmaterial on the seat cushion or byinstalling additional trim material,such as seat covers, on the seat thatare not specifically designed to as-sure proper air bag operation. Addi-tionally, do not stow any objects un-der the front passenger seat or the

1-38 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 56: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

seat cushion and seatback. Such ob-jects may interfere with the properoperation of the occupant classifica-tion sensor.

� No unauthorized changes should bemade to any components or wiring ofthe seat belt system. This may affectthe front air bag system. Tamperingwith the seat belt system may resultin serious personal injury.

� Work on and around the front air bagsystem should be done by a NISSANdealer. Installation of electricalequipment should also be done by aNISSAN dealer. The SupplementalRestraint System (SRS) wiringshould not be modified or discon-nected. Unauthorized electrical testequipment and probing devicesshould not be used on the air bagsystem.

� A cracked windshield should be re-placed immediately by a qualified re-pair facility. A cracked windshieldcould affect the function of the

supplemental air bag system.

� The SRS wiring harness connectorsare yellow and orange for easy iden-tification.

When selling your vehicle, we request that youinform the buyer about the front air bag systemand guide the buyer to the appropriate sectionsin this Owner’s Manual.

Front seat-mounted side-impactsupplemental air bag androof-mounted curtain side-impactsupplemental air bag systems (if soequipped)

This section includes the information about boththe side air bag system �A and the curtain airbag system�B . Curtain air bags are not availableon Roadster models.

The side air bags are located in the outside ofthe seatback of the front seats. The curtain airbags are located in the side roof rails. Thesesystems are designed to meet voluntary guide-

SSS0209A

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-39

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 57: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

lines to help reduce the risk of injury to out-of-position occupants. However, all of the infor-mation, cautions and warnings in thismanual still apply and must be followed.The side air bags and curtain air bags aredesigned to inflate in higher severity side colli-sions on the side that the vehicle is impacted,although they may inflate if the forces in anothertype of collision are similar to those of a higherseverity side impact. They are designed to inflateon the side where the vehicle is impacted. Theymay not inflate in certain side collisions.

Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always anindication of proper side air bag and curtain airbag operation.

When the side air bags and curtain air bagsinflate, a fairly loud noise may be heard, followedby release of smoke. This smoke is not harmfuland does not indicate a fire. Care should betaken not to inhale it, as it may cause irritationand choking. Those with a history of a breathingcondition should get fresh air promptly.

Side air bags, along with the use of seat belts,help to cushion the impact force on the chest ofthe front occupants. Curtain air bags help tocushion the impact force to the head of occu-pants. They can help save lives and reduceserious injuries. However, an inflating side airbag and curtain air bag may cause abrasions orother injuries. Side air bags and curtain air bags

do not provide restraint to the lower body.

The seat belts should be correctly worn and thedriver and passenger seated upright as far aspractical away from the side air bag, and seatedas far away as practical from the door finishersand side roof rails. The side air bags and curtainair bags inflate quickly in order to help protectthe front occupants. Because of this, the force ofthe side air bags and curtain air bags inflatingcan increase the risk of injury if the occupant istoo close to, or is against these air bag modulesduring inflation. The side air bags and curtain airbags will deflate quickly after the collision isover.

The side air bags and curtain air bagsoperate only when the ignition switch is inthe ON or START position.

After turning the ignition key to the ONposition, the supplemental air bag warninglight illuminates. The air bag warning lightwill turn off after about 7 seconds if thesystems are operational.

WARNING

� Do not place any objects near theseatback of the front seats. Also, do

not place any objects (an umbrella,bag, etc.) between the front door fin-isher and the front seat. Such objectsmay become dangerous projectilesand cause injury if a side air baginflates.

� Right after inflation, several side airbag and curtain air bag system com-ponents will be hot. Do not touchthem; you may severely burn your-self.

� No unauthorized changes should bemade to any components or wiring ofthe side air bag and curtain air bagsystems. This is to prevent accidentalinflation of the side air bags andcurtain air bags or damage to theside air bag and curtain air bag sys-tems.

� Do not make unauthorized changesto your vehicle’s electrical system,suspension system or side panel.This could affect proper operation ofthe side air bag and curtain air bagsystems.

1-40 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 58: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� Tampering with the side air bag sys-tem may result in serious personalinjury. For example, do not changethe front seats by placing materialnear the seatback or by installingadditional trim material, such as seatcovers, around the side air bag.

� Work around and on the side air bagand curtain air bag systems shouldbe done by a NISSAN dealer. Instal-lation of electrical equipment shouldalso be done by a NISSAN dealer.The SRS wiring harnesses* shouldnot be modified or disconnected. Un-authorized electrical test equipmentand probing devices should not beused on the side air bag system.

* The SRS wiring harness connectorsare yellow and orange for easy iden-tification.

When selling your vehicle, we request that youinform the buyer about the side air bag andcurtain air bag systems and guide the buyer tothe appropriate sections in this Owner’s Manual.

Seat belts with pretensioners

WARNING

� The pretensioners cannot be reusedafter activation. They must be re-placed together with the retractorand buckle as a unit.

� If the vehicle becomes involved in afrontal collision but a pretensioner isnot activated, be sure to have thepretensioner system checked and, ifnecessary, replaced by a NISSANdealer.

� No unauthorized changes should bemade to any components or wiring ofthe pretensioner system.

This is to prevent damage to or acci-dental activation of the pretension-ers. Tampering with the pretensionersystem may result in serious per-sonal injury.

� Work around and on the preten-sioner system should be done by a

NISSAN dealer. Installation of elec-trical equipment should also be doneby a NISSAN dealer. Unauthorizedelectrical test equipment and probingdevices should not be used on thepretensioner system.

� If you need to dispose of a pre-tensioner or scrap the vehicle, con-tact a NISSAN dealer. Correct pre-tensioner disposal procedures areset forth in the appropriate NISSANService Manual. Incorrect disposalprocedures could cause personalinjury.

The pretensioner system activates in conjunctionwith the front air bag system. Working with theseat belt retractor, it helps tighten the seat beltwhen the vehicle becomes involved in certaintypes of collisions, helping to restrain front seatoccupants.

The pretensioner is encased with the seat beltretractor. These seat belts are used the sameway as conventional seat belts.

When a pretensioner activates, smoke is re-leased and a loud noise may be heard. Thesmoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire.

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-41

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 59: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Care should be taken not to inhale it as it maycause irritation and choking. Those with a historyof a breathing condition should get fresh airpromptly.

If any abnormality occurs in the pretensionersystem, the supplemental air bag warning light

will not come on, will flash intermittently orwill turn on for 7 seconds and remain on after theignition key has been turned to the ON orSTART position. In this case, the pretensionermay not function properly. They must bechecked and repaired. Take your vehicle to aNISSAN dealer.

When selling your vehicle, we request that youinform the buyer about the pretensioner andguide the buyer to the appropriate sections inthis Owner’s Manual.

SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAGWARNING LABELSWarning labels about the supplemental front-impact air bag and front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag (if so equipped)systems are placed in the vehicle as shown inthe illustration.

SSS0206

1-42 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 60: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAGWARNING LIGHT

The supplemental air bag warning light, display-ing in the instrument panel, monitors thecircuits of the supplemental front-impact air bag,front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental airbag (if so equipped), roof-mounted curtain side-impact supplemental air bag (if so equipped forCoupe models) and seat belt pretensioner sys-tems. The monitored circuits include the Air bagControl Unit (ACU), crash zone sensor, satellitesensors, front air bag modules, side air bagmodules, curtain air bag modules, pretensionersand all related wiring.

After turning the ignition key to the ON position,the supplemental air bag warning light illumi-nates. The supplemental air bag warning lightwill turn off after about 7 seconds if the system isoperational.

If any of the following conditions occur, the frontair bag, side air bag and curtain air bag, andpretensioner systems need servicing:

� The supplemental air bag warning light re-mains on after approximately 7 seconds.

� The supplemental air bag warning lightflashes intermittently.

� The supplemental air bag warning light doesnot come on at all.

Under these conditions, the front air bag, side airbag, curtain air bag and/or pretensioner systemsmay not operate properly. They must be checkedand repaired. Take your vehicle to a NISSANdealer.

WARNING

If the supplemental air bag warninglight is on, it could mean that the frontair bag, side air bag, curtain air bag,and/or pretensioner systems will not

operate in an accident. To help avoidinjury to yourself or others, have yourvehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer assoon as possible.

Repair and replacement procedure

The front air bags, side air bags (if so equipped),curtain air bags (if so equipped for Coupemodels) and pretensioners are designed to in-flate on a one-time-only basis. As a reminder,unless it is damaged, the supplemental air bagwarning light will remain illuminated after inflationhas occurred. Repair and replacement of thesesystems should be done only by a NISSANdealer.

When maintenance work is required on thevehicle, the front air bags, side air bags, curtainair bags, pretensioners and related parts shouldbe pointed out to the person conducting themaintenance. The ignition key should always bein the LOCK position when working under thehood or inside the vehicle.

WARNING

� Once a front air bag, side air bag or

SPA1097

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-43

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 61: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

curtain air bag has inflated, the airbag module will not function againand must be replaced. Additionally, ifany of the front air bags inflate, theactivated pretensioners must also bereplaced. The air bag module andpretensioner system should be re-placed by a NISSAN dealer. The airbag module and pretensioner systemcannot be repaired.

� The front air bag, side air bag, curtainair bag and pretensioner systemsshould be inspected by a NISSANdealer if there is any damage to thefront end or side portion of the ve-hicle.

� If you need to dispose of thesesupplemental systems or scrap thevehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer.

Correct disposal procedures are setforth in the appropriate NISSAN Ser-vice Manual. Incorrect disposal pro-cedures could cause personal injury.

1-44 Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 62: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

MEMO

Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-45

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 63: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

2 Instruments and controls

Instrument panel ................................................................... 2-2Meters and gauges .............................................................. 2-3Speedometer and odometer ........................................ 2-4Tachometer ....................................................................... 2-5Engine coolant temperature gauge ............................ 2-5Fuel gauge ........................................................................ 2-6Engine oil pressure gauge ........................................... 2-7Volt meter ......................................................................... 2-8Trip computer .................................................................. 2-8

Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders ........ 2-11Checking bulbs ............................................................. 2-11Warning lights ............................................................... 2-11Indicator lights ............................................................... 2-15Audible reminders ........................................................ 2-17

Security systems ................................................................ 2-18Vehicle security system .............................................. 2-18NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System ...................... 2-19

Windshield wiper and washer switch ........................... 2-21Rear window wiper and washer switch(Coupe models) .................................................................. 2-22Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch .... 2-23Headlight and turn signal switch ................................... 2-24Xenon headlights .......................................................... 2-24Headlight switch ........................................................... 2-24

Daytime running light system (Canada only) ........ 2-25Turn signal switch ........................................................ 2-26Instrument brightness control ................................... 2-26

Hazard warning flasher switch ....................................... 2-27Horn ....................................................................................... 2-27Heated seats (if so equipped) ........................................ 2-28Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off switch(if so equipped) .................................................................. 2-29Traction Control System (TCS) off switch(if so equipped) .................................................................. 2-29Clock ..................................................................................... 2-30Adjusting the time ........................................................ 2-30

Power outlet ........................................................................ 2-31Storage ................................................................................. 2-32Instrument pocket (except for navigation systemequipped models) ........................................................ 2-32Sunglasses holder (Coupe models) ........................ 2-32Cargo net......................................................................... 2-33Cup holders ................................................................... 2-33Console box .................................................................. 2-35Rear floor box ................................................................ 2-35Rear parcel box ............................................................ 2-37Stowing golf bags ......................................................... 2-37Coat hook (Coupe models) ........................................ 2-38

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 64: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Windows .............................................................................. 2-39Power windows ............................................................ 2-39Automatic adjusting function ...................................... 2-40

Interior lights ........................................................................ 2-41Room light ...................................................................... 2-41Map lights ...................................................................... 2-41

Vanity mirror light ............................................................... 2-42Luggage compartment light (Coupe models) ............. 2-42Trunk light (Roadster models).......................................... 2-42

HomeLink Universal Transceiver (if so equipped).... 2-43Programming HomeLink ........................................... 2-43Programming HomeLink for Canadiancustomers ....................................................................... 2-45Operating the HomeLink UniversalTransceiver ..................................................................... 2-45Programming trouble-diagnosis ............................... 2-45Clearing the programmed information .................... 2-45Reprogramming a single HomeLink button ........ 2-45If your vehicle is stolen ............................................... 2-46

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 65: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Headlight/turn signal switch2. Instrument brightness control switch3. Steering wheel switch for audio control (if soequipped) or switch for Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System (if so equipped)

4. Driver supplemental air bag/Horn5. Meters/gauges

6. Cruise control main/set switch(if so equipped)

7. Trip computer mode/setting switch8. Wiper/washer switch9. Center ventilator10. Passenger supplemental air bag

11. Side ventilator12. Soft top operating switch (for Roadstermodels)

13. VDC (Vehicle dynamic control) OFF switch(if so equipped) or TCS (Traction controlsystem) OFF switch (if so equipped)

14. Fuel-filler door opener switch15. Hood lock release handle16. Fuse box17. Tilting steering wheel lock lever18. Ignition switch/steering lock19. Navigation system display* or Instrumentpocket

20. Audio system/Clock21. Rear window and outside mirror defrosterswitch

22. Hazard warning flasher switch23. Cup holder24. Heated seat switch (if so equipped)25. Heater/air conditioner control26. Power outlet*: Refer to the separate Navigation SystemOwner’s Manual.SIC3266

INSTRUMENT PANEL

2-2 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 66: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Combination meter:

1. Warning/Indicator lights

2. Turn signal/hazard indicator lights

3. Tachometer

4. Speedometer

5. Instrument brightness control switch(See “Headlight and turn signal switch” laterin this section.)

6. Fuel gauge

7. Engine coolant temperature gauge

8. Automatic transmission position indicator orManual transmission shift up indicator(See “Driving the vehicle” in the “5. Startingand driving” section.)

9. Reset knob for trip odometer

10. Odometer (Total/Twin trip)

11. Trip computer setting switch(See “Trip computer” later in this section.)

12. Trip computer mode switch(See “Trip computer” later in this section.)

SIC3329

METERS AND GAUGES

Instruments and controls 2-3

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 67: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Triple meter:

1. Trip computer

2. Engine oil pressure gauge

3. Volt meter

�1 Speedometer�2 Odometer�3 Twin trip odometer�4 Reset knob for trip odometer

SPEEDOMETER AND ODOMETER

Speedometer

The speedometer indicates vehicle speed inmiles per hour (MPH) and kilometers per hour(km/h).

Odometer/Twin trip odometerThe odometer/twin trip odometer are displayedwhen the ignition switch is in the ON position.

The odometer records the total distance thevehicle has been driven.

The twin trip odometer records the distance ofindividual trips.

SIC1948 SIC1949A

2-4 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 68: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Changing the display:

Pushing the reset knob changes the display asfollows:

TRIP A → TRIP B → TRIP A

Resetting the trip odometer:

Pushing the reset knob for more than 1 secondresets the trip odometer to zero.

TACHOMETER

The tachometer indicates engine speed in revo-lutions per minute (rpm). Do not rev engine intothe red zone �A .

CAUTION

When engine speed approaches the redzone, shift to a higher gear or reduceengine speed. Operating the engine inthe red zone may cause serious enginedamage.

ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATUREGAUGEThe gauge indicates the engine coolant tem-perature.

The engine coolant temperature is within thenormal range�A when the gauge needle pointswithin the zone shown in the illustration.

The engine coolant temperature will vary with theoutside air temperature and driving conditions.

SIC3328 SIC2371A

Instruments and controls 2-5

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 69: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CAUTION

If the gauge indicates a coolant tem-perature near the hot (H) end of thenormal range, reduce vehicle speed todecrease the temperature. If the gaugeis over the normal range, stop the ve-hicle as soon as safely possible. If theengine is overheated, continued opera-tion of the vehicle may seriously dam-age the engine. See “If your vehicleoverheats” in the “6. In case of emer-gency” section for immediate action re-quired. FUEL GAUGE

The gauge indicates the approximate fuel level inthe tank.

The gauge may move slightly during braking,turning, acceleration, or going up or down hill.

The gauge needle is designed to move to the E(Empty) position when the ignition key is turnedto the OFF position.

Refill the fuel tank before the gauge regis-ters the E (Empty) position.

The low fuel warning light comes on whenthe fuel tank is getting low. Refuel as soonas it is convenient, preferably before thegauge reaches the E position. There will bea small reserve of fuel in the tank when thefuel gauge needle reaches the E position.

The indicates that the fuel-filler door islocated on the passenger’s side of the vehicle.

CAUTION

� If the vehicle runs out of fuel, themalfunction indicator light

(MIL) may come on. Refuel as soonas possible. After a few driving trips,the light should turn off. If thelight remains on after a few drivingtrips, have the vehicle inspected by aNISSAN dealer.

� For additional information, see “Mal-function indicator light (MIL)” later inthis section.

SIC2556

2-6 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 70: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

ENGINE OIL PRESSURE GAUGEThe gauge indicates the engine lubrication sys-tem oil pressure while the engine is running.When the engine speed is high, the engine oilpressure is also high. When it is low, the gaugeindicates the low oil pressure.

CAUTION

� This gauge is not designed to indi-cate low engine oil level. Use thedipstick to check the oil level. (See“Engine oil” in the “8. Maintenanceand do-it-yourself” section.)

� If the gauge needle does not movewith the proper amount of engine oil,have the vehicle checked by aNISSAN dealer. Continued vehicle

operation in such a condition couldcause serious damage to the engine.

SIC1954AType A

SIC1953AType B

Instruments and controls 2-7

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 71: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

VOLT METERWhen the ignition switch is turned to the ONposition, the volt meter indicates the batteryvoltage; while the engine is running, it indicatesthe alternator voltage of 11 - 15 volts (normalrange �A ). However, while cranking the engine,the volts drop below the normal range.

If the needle is not in the normal range�A whilethe engine is running, it may indicate that thecharging system is not functioning properly.Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

TRIP COMPUTERThe display of the trip computer is situated in thetriple meter. When the ignition switch is turnedto ON, the display scrolls all the modes of thetrip computer and then shows the mode chosenbefore the ignition switch is turned OFF.

Switches for the trip computer are located onthe side of the combination meter panel. Tooperate the trip computer, push the side of theswitches as shown above.

�A : Trip computer mode switch�B : Trip computer setting switchWhen the ignition switch is turned to ON, modesof the trip computer can be selected by pushingthe trip computer mode switch �A .Each time the mode switch �A is pushed, thedisplay will change as follows:

Speed indicator → Outside air temperature(ICY)→ Distance to empty (dte)→ Average fuel

SIC1955 SIC3357 SIC2997

2-8 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 72: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

consumption and speed → Elapsed time andtrip odometer → Stopwatch → Up-shift indica-tor setting (for M/T models) → Speed indicator

Speed indicator (mph or km/h)The vehicle speed is displayed in MPH or km/hwhile driving.

The speed indicator in the trip computerindicates the reference speed. The actualspeed indicated by the speedometer (com-bination meter) may differ from the one inthe trip computer.

Outside air temperature(ICY — °F or °C)The outside air temperature is displayed in °F or°C in the range of −22 to 131°F (−30 to 55°C).

The outside air temperature mode includes a lowtemperature warning feature: below 37°F (3°C),the outside air temperature mode is automati-cally selected and the ICY indicator will illumi-nate in order to draw the driver’s attention. Pushthe mode switch �A if you wish to return to themode that was selected before the warningoccurred. The ICY indicator will continue blink-ing as long as the temperature remains below39°F (4°C).

The ambient temperature sensor is located infront of the radiator. The sensor may be affected

by road or engine heat, wind directions andother driving conditions. The display may differfrom the actual ambient temperature or thetemperature displayed on various signs or bill-boards.

Distance to empty (dte — mls or km)

The distance to empty (dte) mode provides youwith an estimation of the distance that can bedriven before refueling. The dte is constantlybeing calculated, based on the amount of fuel inthe fuel tank and the actual fuel consumption.

The display is updated every 30 seconds.

The dte mode includes a low range warningfeature: when the fuel level is low, the dte modeis automatically selected and the digits blink inorder to draw the driver’s attention. Press themode switch�A if you wish to return to the modethat was selected before the warning occurred.The dte indicator will remain blinking until thevehicle is refueled.

When the fuel level drops even lower, the dtedisplay will change to (----).

NOTE:

� If the amount of fuel added while theignition switch is OFF is small, the dis-play just before the ignition switch is

turned OFF may continue to be dis-played.

� When driving uphill or rounding curves,the fuel in the tank shifts, which maymomentarily change the display.

Average fuel consumption(mpg or l (liter)/100 km) and speed(av. mph or av. km/h)

Fuel consumption:

The average fuel consumption mode shows theaverage fuel consumption since the last reset.Resetting is done by pushing the trip computersetting switch�B for more than approximately 1second. (The average speed is also reset at thesame time.)

The display is updated every 30 seconds. Atabout the first 1/3 miles (500 m) after a reset,the display shows (----).

Speed:

The average speed mode shows the averagevehicle speed since the last reset. Resetting isdone by pushing the setting switch�B for morethan approximately 1 second. (The average fuelconsumption is also reset at the same time.)

The display is updated every 30 seconds. The

Instruments and controls 2-9

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 73: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

first 30 seconds after a reset, the display shows(----).

Elapsed time (h:m:s) and tripodometer (mls or km)

Elapsed time:

The elapsed time mode shows the time since thelast reset. The displayed time can be reset bypushing the trip computer setting switch �B formore than approximately 1 second. (The tripodometer is also reset at the same time.)

Trip odometer:

The trip odometer mode shows the total dis-tance the vehicle has been driven since the lastreset. Resetting is done by pushing the settingswitch�B for more than approximately 1 second.(The elapsed time is also reset at the same time.)

Stopwatch (h:m:s)You can use the trip computer as a stopwatch.Each time the trip computer setting switch�B ispushed, the stopwatch will be operated as fol-lows:

After 100 hours, the time will start from the resetdisplay again.

Even if the display is switched to the other modewhile the time is starting, the stopwatch contin-ues to advance until you stop the time in thestopwatch mode. When the ignition switch isturned to the OFF position, the time is reset.

Up-shift indicator setting (rpm) (formanual transmission models)The up-shift indicator setting mode is used toset the desired engine speed (rpm) for theup-shift indicator (situated in the tachometer) toilluminate. When the engine speed approachesor reaches the set figure, the up-shift indicatorwill flash or illuminate to show the driver thetiming for shifting into a higher gear. See “Drivingthe vehicle” in the “5. Starting and driving”section for the use of the up-shift indicator.

When the up-shift indicator setting mode isselected, the rpm indicator blinks and the enginespeed currently set is displayed. (The initialfactory setting is 7,500 rpm.) The figure can bechanged between 2,000 and 9,000 rpm bypushing trip computer setting switch�B . Press-ing the switch for less than approximately 1second will add the figure by 100 rpm. If pushingfor more than approximately 1 second, the figurewill increase by 500 rpm.

If the battery cable is disconnected, the setengine speed will be returned to the initial figure(7,500 rpm).

Display priorityIf a low outside air temperature warning,low dte (distance to empty) range warningand low tire pressure warning occur simul-taneously, other display modes switch au-tomatically to the outside air temperaturedisplay.

When trip computer mode switch �A ispressed, the display switches to the modechosen before the warning display, but theICY indicator will continue blinking.

2-10 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 74: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

or Anti-lock Braking System(ABS) warning light

Low washer fluid warning light High beam indicator light (Blue)

Automatic transmission check warninglight (A/T models)

Seat belt warning light Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)

or Brake warning light Supplemental air bag warning light Slip indicator light

Charge warning lightAutomatic transmission position indicatorlight (A/T models)

Traction Control System (TCS) off indica-tor light (if so equipped)

Door open warning lightCruise main switch indicator light(if so equipped)

Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off indi-cator light (if so equipped)

Engine oil pressure warning lightCruise set switch indicator light(if so equipped)

Soft top indicator light (Roadster models)

Low tire pressure warning light Front passenger air bag status light Turn signal/hazard indicator lights

CHECKING BULBSApply the parking brake and turn the ignition keyto ON without starting the engine. The followinglights will come on:

, or , ,

The following lights come on briefly and then gooff:

, or , , , ,,

If any light fails to come on, it may indicate aburned-out bulb or an open circuit in the elec-

trical system. Have the system repairedpromptly.

WARNING LIGHTS

or Anti-lock BrakingSystem (ABS)warning light

When the ignition switch is in the ON position,the Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warninglight illuminates and then turns off. This indicatesthe ABS is operational.

If the ABS warning light illuminates while theengine is running, or while driving, it may indicatethe ABS is not functioning properly. Have thesystem checked by a NISSAN dealer.

If an ABS malfunction occurs, the anti-lockfunction is turned off. The brake system thenoperates normally, but without anti-lock assis-tance. See “Brake system” in the “5. Startingand driving” section.

WARNING/INDICATOR LIGHTSAND AUDIBLE REMINDERS

Instruments and controls 2-11

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 75: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Automatic transmission checkwarning light (A/T models)

When the ignition switch is turned to the ONposition, the automatic transmission checkwarning light comes on and then turns off. Thisindicates that the automatic transmission systemis operational.If the light comes on while the engine is runningor while driving, it may indicate that the auto-matic transmission system is not functioningproperly. Have a NISSAN dealer check andrepair the transmission.

or Brake warning lightThis light functions for both the parking brakeand the foot brake systems.

Parking brake indicator:

When the ignition switch is in the ON position,the light comes on when the parking brake isapplied.

Low brake fluid warning light:

The light warns of a low brake fluid level. If thelight comes on while the engine is running withthe parking brake not applied, stop the vehicleand perform the following:

1. Check the brake fluid level. Add brake fluid asnecessary. See “Brake and clutch fluid” in the“8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.

WARNING

� Your brake system may not be work-ing properly if the warning light is on.Driving could be dangerous. If youjudge it to be safe, drive carefully tothe nearest service station for re-pairs. Otherwise, have your vehicletowed because driving it could bedangerous.

� Pressing the brake pedal with theengine stopped and/or a low brakefluid level may increase your stop-ping distance and braking will re-quire greater pedal effort as well aspedal travel.

� If the brake fluid level is below theMINIMUM or MIN mark on the brakefluid reservoir, do not drive until thebrake system has been checked at aNISSAN dealer.

2. If the brake fluid level is correct, have thewarning system checked by a NISSANdealer.

Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warningindicator:

When the parking brake is released and thebrake fluid level is sufficient, if both the brakewarning light and the ABS warning light illumi-nate, it may indicate the ABS is not functioningproperly. Have the brake system checked by aNISSAN dealer. See “Anti-lock Braking System(ABS) warning light” earlier in this section.

Charge warning light

If the light comes on while the engine is running,it may indicate that the charging system is notfunctioning properly. Turn the engine off andcheck the alternator belt. If the belt is loose,broken, missing or if the light remains on, see aNISSAN dealer immediately.

CAUTION

Do not continue driving if the belt isloose, broken or missing.

Door open warning light

This light comes on when any of the doorsand/or rear hatch are not closed securely whilethe ignition switch is in the ON position.

2-12 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 76: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Engine oil pressure warninglight

This light warns of low engine oil pressure. If thelight flickers or comes on during normal driving,pull off the road in a safe area, stop the engineimmediately and call a NISSAN dealer or otherauthorized repair shop.

The engine oil pressure warning light is notdesigned to indicate a low oil level. Use thedipstick to check the oil level. See “Engineoil” in the “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself”section.

CAUTION

Running the engine with the engine oilpressure warning light on could causeserious damage to the engine almostimmediately. Turn off the engine assoon as it is safe to do so.

Low tire pressure warning light

Your vehicle is equipped with a Tire PressureMonitoring System (TPMS) that monitors the tirepressure of all tires except the spare.

The low tire pressure warning light warns of low

tire pressure or indicates that the TPMS is notfunctioning properly.

After the ignition switch is turned ON, this lightilluminates for about 1 second and turns off.

Low tire pressure warning:

If the vehicle is being driven with low tire pres-sure, the warning light will illuminate.

When the low tire pressure warning light illumi-nates, you should stop and adjust the tire pres-sure to the recommended COLD tire pressureshown on the Tire and Loading Information label.The low tire pressure warning light does notautomatically turn off when the tire pressure isadjusted. After the tire is inflated to the recom-mended pressure, the vehicle must be driven atspeeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h) to activate theTPMS and turn off the low tire pressure warninglight. Use a tire pressure gauge to check the tirepressure.

For additional information, see “Tire pressuremonitoring system (TPMS)” in the “5. Startingand driving” section and in the “6. In case ofemergency” section.

TPMS malfunction:

If the TPMS is not functioning properly, the lowtire pressure warning light will flash for approxi-mately 1 minute when the ignition switch is

turned ON. The light will remain on after the 1minute. Have the system checked by a NISSANdealer.

For additional information, see “Tire pressuremonitoring system (TPMS)” in the “5. Startingand driving” section.

WARNING

� If the light does not illuminate withthe ignition switch turned ON, havethe vehicle checked by a NISSANdealer as soon as possible.

� If the light illuminates while driving,avoid sudden steering maneuvers orabrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed,pull off the road to a safe locationand stop the vehicle as soon as pos-sible. Driving with under-inflatedtires may permanently damage thetires and increase the likelihood oftire failure. Serious vehicle damagecould occur and may lead to an acci-dent and could result in serious per-sonal injury. Check the tire pressurefor all four tires. Adjust the tire pres-

Instruments and controls 2-13

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 77: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

sure to the recommended COLD tirepressure shown on the Tire andLoading Information label to turn thelow tire pressure warning light OFF.If the light stays on after adjustingthe tire pressure and driving over 16MPH (25 km/h), have the systemchecked by a NISSAN dealer. If youhave a flat tire, replace it with a sparetire as soon as possible.

� When a spare tire is mounted or awheel is replaced, the TPMS will notfunction and the low tire pressurewarning light will flash for approxi-mately 1 minute. The light will remainon after 1 minute. Contact yourNISSAN dealer as soon as possiblefor tire replacement and/or systemresetting.

� Replacing tires with those not origi-nally specified by NISSAN could af-fect the proper operation of theTPMS.

CAUTION

� The TPMS is not a substitute for theregular tire pressure check. Be sureto check the tire pressure regularly.

� If the vehicle is being driven atspeeds of less than 16 MPH (25km/h), the TPMS may not operatecorrectly.

� Be sure to install the specified size oftires to the front and rear.

Low washer fluid warning light

This light comes on when the washer fluid is at alow level. Add washer fluid as necessary. See“Window washer fluid” in the “8. Maintenanceand do-it-yourself” section.

Seat belt warning light

The seat belt warning light and chime remind youto fasten seat belts. The light illuminates when-ever the ignition key is turned to ON, and willremain illuminated until the driver’s seat belt isfastened.

The seat belt warning light may also illuminate if

the front passenger’s seat belt is not fastenedwhen the front passenger’s seat is occupied. For5 seconds after the ignition switch is in the ONposition, the system does not activate the warn-ing light for the front passenger.

See “Seat belts” in the “1. Safety — Seats, seatbelts and supplemental restraint system” sectionfor precautions on seat belt usage.

Supplemental air bag warninglight

After turning the ignition key to the ON position,the supplemental air bag warning light will illu-minate. The supplemental air bag warning lightwill turn off after about 7 seconds if the system isoperational.

If any of the following conditions occur, the frontair bag, side air bag (if so equipped) and curtainair bag (if so equipped), and pretensioner sys-tems need servicing and your vehicle must betaken to a NISSAN dealer.

� The supplemental air bag warning light re-mains on after approximately 7 seconds.

� The supplemental air bag warning lightflashes intermittently.

� The supplemental air bag warning light doesnot come on at all.

2-14 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 78: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Unless checked and repaired, the supplementalrestraint system (air bag system) and/or thepretensioners may not function properly. Foradditional information, see “Supplemental re-straint system” in the “1. Safety — Seats, seatbelts and supplemental restraint system” sec-tion.

WARNING

If the supplemental air bag warninglight is on, it could mean that the frontair bag, side air bag, curtain air bagand/or pretensioner systems will notoperate in an accident. To help avoidinjury to yourself or others, have yourvehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer assoon as possible.

INDICATOR LIGHTS

Automatic transmissionposition indicator light (A/Tmodels)

When the ignition key is turned to the ONposition, the indicator in the tachometer showsthe automatic transmission selector lever posi-tion. See “Driving the vehicle” (automatic trans-

mission) in the “5. Starting and driving” section.

Cruise main switch indicatorlight (if so equipped)

The light comes on when the cruise control mainswitch is pushed. The light goes out when themain switch is pushed again. When the cruisemain switch indicator light comes on, the cruisecontrol system is operational.

Cruise set switch indicatorlight (if so equipped)

The light comes on while the vehicle speed iscontrolled by the cruise control system. If thelight blinks while the engine is running, it mayindicate the cruise control system is not func-tioning properly. Have the system checked by aNISSAN dealer.

Front passenger air bag statuslight

The front passenger air bag status light( ) will be lit and the passenger front air bagwill be OFF depending on how the front passen-ger seat is being used.

For front passenger air bag status light opera-tion, see “NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System” inthe “1. Safety — Seats, seat belts and supple-mental restraint system” section of this manual.

High beam indicator light(Blue)

This light comes on when the headlight highbeam is on and goes out when the low beam isselected.

Malfunction Indicator Light(MIL)

If the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) comes onsteady or blinks while the engine is running, itmay indicate a potential emission control mal-function.

The malfunction indicator light may also come onsteady if the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, orif the vehicle runs out of fuel. Check to make surethe fuel-filler cap is installed and closed tightly,and that the vehicle has at least 3 US gallons (14liters) of fuel in the fuel tank.

After a few driving trips, the light shouldturn off if no other potential emission controlsystem malfunction exists.

If this indicator light comes on steady for 20seconds and then blinks for 10 seconds whenthe engine is not running, it indicates that thevehicle is not ready for an emission controlsystem inspection/maintenance test. See“Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M)test” in the “9. Technical and consumer informa-

Instruments and controls 2-15

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 79: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

tion” section of this manual.

Operation

The malfunction indicator light will come on inone of two ways:

� Malfunction indicator light on steady — Anemission control system malfunction hasbeen detected. Check the fuel-filler cap. If thefuel-filler cap is loose or missing, tighten orinstall the cap and continue to drive thevehicle. The light should turn off after afew driving trips. If the light does notturn off after a few driving trips, have thevehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer. Youdo not need to have your vehicle towed to thedealer.

� Malfunction indicator light blinking — An en-gine misfire has been detected which maydamage the emission control system. To re-duce or avoid emission control system dam-age:

a) Do not drive at speeds above 45 MPH(72 km/h).

b) Avoid hard acceleration or deceleration.c) Avoid steep uphill grades.d) If possible, reduce the amount of cargobeing hauled or towed.

The malfunction indicator light may stopblinking and come on steady.

Have the vehicle inspected by a NISSANdealer. You do not need to have your vehicletowed to the dealer.

CAUTION

Continued vehicle operation withouthaving the emission control systemchecked and repaired as necessarycould lead to poor driveability, reducedfuel economy, and possible damage tothe emission control system.

Slip indicator lightThe light will blink when the Vehicle DynamicControl (VDC) system or the Traction ControlSystem (TCS) is operating, thus alerting thedriver to the fact that the road surface is slipperyand the vehicle is nearing its traction limits.

This light also comes on when the ignition switchis turned to the ON position. The light will turn offif the VDC or TCS is operational.

Traction Control System (TCS)off indicator light (if soequipped)

The light comes on when the Traction ControlSystem (TCS) off switch is pushed to OFF. Thisindicates the TCS is not operating.

This light also comes on when the ignition switchis turned to the ON position. The light will turn offif the TCS is operational.

When the TCS off indicator light and slip indi-cator light come on with the TCS turned on, thislight alerts the driver to the fact that the system’sfail-safe mode is operating, that is the TCS maynot be functioning properly. Have the systemchecked by a NISSAN dealer. If a malfunctionoccurs in the system, the traction control func-tion will be canceled but the vehicle is stilldriveable. For additional information, see “Trac-tion Control System (TCS)” in the “5. Startingand driving” section of this manual.

Vehicle Dynamic Control(VDC) off indicator light (if soequipped)

The light comes on when the Vehicle DynamicControl (VDC) off switch is pushed to OFF. Thisindicates the VDC system and Traction ControlSystem (TCS) are not operating.

2-16 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 80: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

This light also comes on when the ignition switchis turned to the ON position. The light will turn offif the VDC system is operational.

When the VDC off indicator light and slip indi-cator light come on with the VDC system turnedon, this light alerts the driver to the fact that thesystem’s fail-safe mode is operating, that is theVDC system may not be functioning properly.Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.If a malfunction occurs in the system, the VDCsystem function will be canceled but the vehicleis still driveable. For additional information, see“Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system” in the“5. Starting and driving” section of this manual.

Soft top indicator light(Roadster models)

This light illuminates when the soft top is beingoperated or it is stopped before reaching a fullopen/close state. When the top is fully opened,the light will turn off. When the top is fully closed,the light will flash.

The soft top can be moved with the soft topoperating switch only under all of the followingconditions:

� When the vehicle is stopped.

� When the foot brake pedal is depressed.

� When the ignition switch is ON.

CAUTION

Operate the soft top with the enginerunning to prevent a discharged battery.

When the soft top is in motion, and any of theabove conditions are discontinued or the pas-senger power seat switches (on the cushion orthe seatback) are operated, the top will stopmoving. Remove your hand from the operatingswitch, and push it again under the aboveconditions until the top is fully opened or closed.The soft top indicator light will turn off when thetop open operation is completely finished. Whenclosing the top, the light, which is illuminated,will begin to flash when the top close operationis completely finished. Securely engage the topto the vehicle by operating the top latch lever.The light will turn off.

If the soft top indicator light flashes with theignition switch ON (whether the top is operatedor not, and when the top is engaged), it mayindicate the electric soft top control unit is notfunctioning properly. Have your vehicle checkedby a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

For more details about the electric soft topoperation, see “Soft top” in the “3. Pre-drivingchecks and adjustments” section.

Turn signal/hazard indicatorlights

The light flashes when the turn signal switchlever or hazard switch is turned on.

AUDIBLE REMINDERS

Key reminder chime

The chime will sound if the driver’s side door isopened while the key is left in the ignition switch(ignition switch is turned off). Remove the keyand take it with you when leaving the vehicle.

Light reminder chime

The chime will sound when the driver’s door isopened with the headlight switch on unless thekey is in the ignition switch. Make sure to turn thelight switch off when you leave the vehicle.

Seat belt warning chimeThe chime will sound for about 6 seconds unlessthe driver’s seat belt is securely fastened.

Brake pad wear warningThe disc brake pads have audible wear warn-ings. When a brake pad requires replacement, itwill make a high pitched scraping sound whenthe vehicle is in motion whether or not the brakepedal is depressed. Have the brakes checked as

Instruments and controls 2-17

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 81: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

soon as possible if the warning sound is heard.

Your vehicle has two types of security systems,as follows:

� Vehicle Security System

� NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System

The security condition will be shown by thesecurity indicator light.

VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM

The vehicle security system provides visual andaudible alarm signals if someone opens thedoors or rear hatch/trunk lid when the system isarmed. It is not, however, a motion detectiontype system that activates when a vehicle is

moved or when a vibration occurs.

The system helps deter vehicle theft but cannotprevent it, nor can it prevent the theft of interioror exterior vehicle components in all situations.Always secure your vehicle even if parking for abrief period. Never leave your keys in the vehicle,and always lock the vehicle when unattended.Be aware of your surroundings, and park insecure, well-lit areas whenever possible.

Many devices offering additional protection,such as component locks, identification markers,and tracking systems, are available at auto sup-ply stores and specialty shops. A NISSAN dealermay also offer such equipment. Check with yourinsurance company to see if you may be eligiblefor discounts for various theft protection fea-tures.

SIC2132

SECURITY SYSTEMS

2-18 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 82: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Security indicator light

This light�A blinks whenever the ignition switchis in the LOCK, OFF or ACC position. This isnormal.

How to arm the vehicle securitysystem

1. Close all windows.

The system can be activated even if thewindows are open.

2. Remove the key from the ignition switch.

3. Close and lock all doors and rear hatch/trunklid.

Lock all doors by using the key or the keyfob.When using the keyfob, the hazard indicatorsflash twice to indicate all doors are locked.

4. Confirm that the security indicator lightcomes on. The security indicator light glowsfor about 30 seconds and then blinks. Thesystem is now activated. If, during this 30second time period, the door is unlocked bythe key or the keyfob, or the ignition key isturned to ACC or ON, the system will notactivate.

Even when the driver and/or passengersare in the vehicle, the system will activatewith all doors and rear hatch/trunk lidlocked and ignition key off. Turn the igni-tion key to ACC to turn the system off.

Vehicle security system activationThe security system will give the following alarm:

� The headlights blink and the horn soundsintermittently.

� The alarm automatically turns off after ap-proximately 50 seconds. However, the alarmreactivates if the vehicle is tampered withagain. The alarm can be shut off by unlockinga door with the key, or by pushing the

UNLOCK button on the keyfob.

The alarm is activated by:

� Opening the door without using the key orkeyfob.

� Opening the rear hatch or the trunk lid with-out using the keyfob.

How to stop an activated alarm

The alarm will stop only by unlocking a door withthe key, or by pushing the UNLOCK but-ton on keyfob. The alarm will not stop if theignition key is turned to ACC or ON.

If the system does not operate as de-scribed above, have it checked by aNISSAN dealer.

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZERSYSTEM

The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System will notallow the engine to start without the use of theregistered key.

If the engine fails to start using the registered key(for example, when interference is caused byanother registered key, an automated toll roaddevice or automated payment device on the keyring), restart the engine using the followingprocedures:

SIC1699A

Instruments and controls 2-19

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 83: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Leave the ignition switch in the ON positionfor approximately 5 seconds.

2. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF or LOCKposition and wait approximately 10 seconds.

3. Repeat steps 1 and 2.

4. Restart the engine while holding the device(which may have caused the interference)separate from the registered key.

If this procedure allows the engine to start,NISSAN recommends placing the registeredkey on a separate key ring to avoid interfer-ence from other devices.

Statement related to section 15 of FCCrules for NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer Sys-tem (CONT ASSY-BCM, ANT ASSY-IMMOBILISER)

This device complies with part 15 of theFCC Rules and RSS-210 of IndustryCanada. Operation is subject to the follow-ing two conditions;

(1) This device may not cause harmful in-terference, and (2) this device must acceptany interference received, including inter-ference that may cause undesired opera-tion of the device.

CHANGES OR MODIFICATIONS NOT EX-PRESSLY APPROVED BY THE PARTY RE-

SPONSIBLE FOR COMPLIANCE COULDVOID THE USER’S AUTHORITY TO OPER-ATE THE EQUIPMENT.

Security indicator light

This light�A blinks whenever the ignition switchis in the LOCK, OFF or ACC position. Thisfunction indicates the security system equippedon the vehicle is operational.

If the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System ismalfunctioning, this light will remain on while theignition switch is in the ON position.

If the light still remains on and/or theengine will not start, see a NISSAN dealerfor NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer Systemservice as soon as possible. Bring all reg-istered keys that you have when visiting a

SIC1699A

2-20 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 84: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

NISSAN dealer for service.

The windshield wiper and washer operateswhen the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Push the lever down to operate the wiper at thefollowing speed:

�1 Intermittent (INT) — intermittent operationcan be adjusted by turning the knob toward�A (Slower) or �B (Faster).

�2 Low (LO) — continuous low speed operation�3 High (HI) — continuous high speed operationPush the lever up �4 to have one sweepoperation (MIST) of the wiper.

Pull the lever toward you �5 to operate the

washer. Then the wiper will also operate severaltimes.

WARNING

In freezing temperatures the washer so-lution may freeze on the windshield andobscure your vision which may lead toan accident. Warm the windshield withthe defroster before you wash the wind-shield.

CAUTION

� Do not operate the washer continu-ously for more than 30 seconds.

� Do not operate the washer if thereservoir tank is empty.

� Do not fill the window washer reser-voir tank with washer fluid concen-trates at full strength. Some methylalcohol based washer fluid concen-trates may permanently stain thegrille if spilled while filling the win-dow washer reservoir tank.

SIC2998

WINDSHIELD WIPER ANDWASHER SWITCH

Instruments and controls 2-21

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 85: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� Pre-mix washer fluid concentrateswith water to the manufacturer’s rec-ommended levels before pouring thefluid into the window washer reser-voir tank. Do not use the windowwasher reservoir tank to mix thewasher fluid concentrate and water.

The rear window wiper and washer operatewhen the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Turn the switch clockwise from the OFF positionto operate the wiper.

�1 Intermittent (INT) — intermittent operation(not adjustable)

�2 Low (ON) — continuous low speed operationPush the switch forward �3 to operate thewasher. Then the wiper will also operate severaltimes.

WARNING

In freezing temperatures the washer so-lution may freeze on the rear windowand obscure your vision. Warm the rearwindow with the defroster before youwash the rear window.

CAUTION

� If the rear window wiper operation isinterrupted by snow or ice, the wipermay stop moving to protect its motor.If this occurs, turn the wiper switch toOFF and remove the snow or ice onand around the wiper arms. Afterabout 1 minute, turn the switch ONagain to operate the wiper.

� Do not operate the washer continu-ously for more than 30 seconds.

� Do not operate the washer if thereservoir tank is empty.

� Do not fill the window washer reser-

SIC3297

REAR WINDOW WIPER ANDWASHER SWITCH (Coupemodels)

2-22 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 86: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

voir tank with washer fluid concen-trates at full strength. Some methylalcohol based washer fluid concen-trates may permanently stain thegrille if spilled while filling the win-dow washer reservoir tank.

� Pre-mix washer fluid concentrateswith water to the manufacturer’s rec-ommended levels before pouring thefluid into the window washer reser-voir tank. Do not use the windowwasher reservoir tank to mix thewasher fluid concentrate and water.

To defog/defrost the rear window glass andoutside mirrors, start the engine and push theswitch on. The indicator light �A will come on.Push the switch again to turn the defroster off.

It will automatically turn off in approximately 15minutes.

CAUTION

� When cleaning the inner side of therear window, be careful not to scratchor damage the rear window de-

froster.

� Do not use the rear window defrosterswitch while the soft top is beingoperated or fully opened. The heatmay damage the top material and/orcomponents. (for Roadster models)

SIC3000

REAR WINDOW AND OUTSIDEMIRROR DEFROSTER SWITCH

Instruments and controls 2-23

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 87: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

XENON HEADLIGHTS

WARNING

HIGH VOLTAGE

� When xenon headlights are on, theyproduce a high voltage. To prevent anelectric shock, never attempt tomodify or disassemble. Always haveyour xenon headlights replaced at aNISSAN dealer.

� Xenon headlights provide consider-ably more light than conventionalheadlights. If they are not correctlyaimed, they might temporarily blindan oncoming driver or the driverahead of you and cause a seriousaccident. If headlights are not aimedcorrectly, immediately take your ve-hicle to a NISSAN dealer and havethe headlights adjusted correctly.

When the xenon headlight is initially turned on,its brightness or color varies slightly. However,the color and brightness will soon stabilize.

� The life of xenon headlights will beshortened by frequent on-off operation.It is generally desirable not to turn offthe headlights for short intervals (forexample, when the vehicle stops at atraffic signal). Even when the daytimerunning lights are active (Canada only),the xenon headlights do not turn on.This way the life of the xenon headlightsis not reduced.

� If the xenon headlight bulb is close toburning out, the brightness will drasti-cally decrease, the light will start blink-ing, or the color of the light will becomereddish. If one or more of the abovesigns appear, contact a NISSAN dealer. HEADLIGHT SWITCH

Lighting

�1 Turn the switch to the position:

The front park, side marker, tail, license plateand instrument lights will come on.

�2 Turn the switch to the position:

Headlights will come on and all the otherlights remain on.

SIC3291

HEADLIGHT AND TURN SIGNALSWITCH

2-24 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 88: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CAUTION

Use the headlights with the engine run-ning to avoid discharging the vehiclebattery.

Headlight beam select

�1 To select the high beam, push the leverforward. The high beam lights come on andthe high beam indicator light illumi-nates.

�2 Pull the lever back to select the low beam.�3 Pulling the lever toward you will flash theheadlight high beam.

Battery saver system

� When the headlight switch is in the orposition while the ignition switch is in

the ON position, the lights will automatically

turn off 5 minutes after the ignition switch hasbeen turned to the OFF position.

� After the headlights automatically turn off withthe headlight switch in the or po-sition, the headlights will illuminate again for 5minutes if the headlight switch is turned tothe OFF position and then turned to the

or position.

CAUTION

Even though the battery saver featureautomatically turns off the headlightsafter a period of time, you should turnthe headlight switch to the OFF positionwhen the engine is not running to avoiddischarging the vehicle battery.

DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM(Canada only)The headlights (low beam) automatically illumi-nate when the engine is started with the parkingbrake released. The daytime running lights op-erate with the headlight switch in the OFFposition or in the position.

If the parking brake is applied before the engineis started, the daytime running lights do not

SIC3315

Instruments and controls 2-25

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 89: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

illuminate. The daytime running lights illuminateonce the parking brake is released. The daytimerunning lights will remain on until the ignitionswitch is turned off.

TURN SIGNAL SWITCH

�1 Turn signalMove the lever up or down to signal the turningdirection. When the turn is completed, the turnsignals cancel automatically.

�2 Lane change signalTo indicate a lane change, move the lever up ordown to the point where lights begin flashing.

INSTRUMENT BRIGHTNESSCONTROLThe instrument brightness control operateswhen the light switch is in the or

position and the ignition switch is in theON position.

To adjust the brightness of instrument panellights, press the control switches located on theleft side of the meter panel. Pressing the upperswitch �A will brighten the lights. The lowerswitch�B will dim the lights. Repeatedly press-ing the lower switch will turn the lights off.

SIC3316 SIC3001

2-26 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 90: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Push the switch (located on the front part of thecenter console) on to warn other drivers whenyou must stop or park under emergency condi-tions. All turn signal lights will flash.

Some state or provincial laws may prohibitthe use of the hazard warning flasherswitch while driving.

WARNING

� If stopping for an emergency, be sureto move the vehicle well off the road.

� Do not use the hazard warning flash-ers while moving on the highway un-less unusual circumstances force youto drive so slowly that your vehiclemight become a hazard to other traf-fic.

� Turn signals do not work when thehazard warning flasher lights are on.

The flasher will operate with the ignition switch inany position.

To sound the horn, push the center pad area ofthe steering wheel.

WARNING

Do not disassemble the horn. Doing socould affect proper operation of thesupplemental front air bag system. Tam-pering with the supplemental front airbag system may result in serious per-sonal injury.

SIC2475 SIC2195

HAZARD WARNING FLASHERSWITCH

HORN

Instruments and controls 2-27

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 91: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The seats are warmed by built-in heaters. Theswitches are located on the center console.

1. Start the engine.

2. Select heat range.

�1 For high heat, push the (High) sideof the switch.

�2 For low heat, push the (Low) side ofthe switch.

�3 For no heat, the switch has a center OFFposition between low and high.

The indicator light �A in the switch willilluminate when low or high is selected.

The heater is controlled by a thermostat,automatically turning the heater on and off.The indicator light will remain on as long asthe switch is on.

3. When the vehicle’s interior is warmed, orbefore you leave the vehicle, be sure to turnthe switch to the OFF position �3 .

An optional ventilated net seat has this built-inheater only in the seat cushion part, not in theseatback.

CAUTION

� The battery could be discharged ifthe seat heater is operated while theengine is not running.

� Do not use the seat heater for ex-tended periods or when no one isusing the seat.

� Do not put anything on the seatwhich insulates heat, such as a blan-ket, cushion, seat cover, etc. Other-wise, the seat may become over-heated.

� Do not place anything hard or heavy

on the seat or pierce it with a pin orsimilar object. This may result indamage to the heater.

� Any liquid spilled on the heated seatshould be removed immediately witha dry cloth.

� When cleaning the seat, never usegasoline, benzine, thinner, or anysimilar materials.

� If any abnormalities are found or theheated seat does not operate, turnthe switch off and have the systemchecked by a NISSAN dealer.

SIC3002

HEATED SEATS (if so equipped)

2-28 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 92: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The vehicle should be driven with the VehicleDynamic Control (VDC) system on for mostdriving conditions.

If the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, the VDCsystem reduces the engine output to reducewheel spin. The engine speed will be reducedeven if the accelerator is depressed to the floor.If maximum engine power is needed to free astuck vehicle, turn the VDC system off.

To turn off the VDC system, push the VDC OFFswitch (located on the lower side of the instru-ment panel). The indicator light will comeon.

Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart the

engine to turn on the system. See “VehicleDynamic Control (VDC) system” in the “5. Start-ing and driving” section.

The vehicle should be driven with the TractionControl System (TCS) on for most driving con-ditions.

If the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, the TCSreduces the engine output to reduce wheel spin.The engine speed will be reduced even if theaccelerator is depressed to the floor. If maximumengine power is needed to free a stuck vehicle,turn the TCS off.

To turn off the TCS, push the TCS OFF switch(located on the lower side of the instrumentpanel). The indicator light will come on.Push it again or restart the engine to turn thesystem back on.

SIC1881 SIC1967

VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL(VDC) OFF SWITCH (if soequipped)

TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM(TCS) OFF SWITCH (if soequipped)

Instruments and controls 2-29

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 93: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

See “Traction Control System (TCS)” in the “5.Starting and driving” section.

The digital clock (in the audio unit) displays timewhen the ignition switch is in the ACC or ONposition.

If the battery cable is disconnected, theclock will reset its time and the correcttime will not be indicated. Readjust thetime.

ADJUSTING THE TIME

Adjust the time in the following steps:

1. Switch the display to the clock adjustingmode.Type A (audio with 1 CD player):Push and hold the DISP (Clock) button �Auntil the clock display starts to flash.

Type B (audio with 6 CD changer):Push and hold the RPT button �B until theclock display starts to flash.

2. Push the SEEK/TRACK button �C ( ,) to adjust the hour. Push the TUNE

button �D ( , ) to adjust the

SIC3003

CLOCK

2-30 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 94: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

minute. Pushing the or side willadvance the time and the or sidewill turn back the time.

3. Push the DISP button �A (Type A), or RPT�B button (Type B) to finish the adjustment.

ResettingType A (audio with 1 CD player):Push the DISP �A and TUNE �D buttons.Type B (audio with 6 CD changer):Push the RPT �B and TUNE �D buttons.The time will be set to a time signal.

For example, if these buttons are pushed whilethe time is between 8:00 and 8:29, the displaywill be reset to 8:00. If pushed while it isbetween 8:30 and 8:59, the display will be resetto 9:00. At the same time the display will returnto the previous audio mode.

The power outlet is for powering electrical ac-cessories such as cellular telephones.

CAUTION

� The outlet and plug may be hot dur-ing or immediately after use.

� This power outlet is not designed foruse with a cigarette lighter unit.

� Do not use accessories that exceed acombined power draw of 12 volt,120W (10A) for both the front and

rear power outlets. Do not usedouble adapters or more than oneaccessory with a single power outlet.

� Use power outlet with the enginerunning to avoid discharging the ve-hicle battery.

� Avoid using power outlets when theair conditioner, headlights or rearwindow defroster is on.

� Before inserting or disconnecting aplug, be sure to turn off the powerswitch of electrical accessory being

SIC2258Front

SIC1968Rear

POWER OUTLET

Instruments and controls 2-31

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 95: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

used or the ACC power of the vehicle.

� Push the plug in as far as it will go. Ifgood contact is not made, the plugmay overheat or the internal tem-perature fuse may open.

� Do not allow water to contact theoutlet. When not in use, be sure toclose the lid.

INSTRUMENT POCKET (except fornavigation system equipped models)To open the lid, push the knob up �1 .To close, pull the lid down �2 .

WARNING

Keep the pocket lid closed while drivingto help prevent injury in an accident or asudden stop.

SUNGLASSES HOLDER (Coupemodels)The sunglasses holder can be opened by push-ing the button �A .

WARNING

Keep the sunglasses holder closedwhile driving to prevent an accident.

SIC3004 SIC2317

STORAGE

2-32 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 96: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CAUTION

� Do not use for anything other thanglasses.

� Do not leave sunglasses in the sun-glasses holder while parking in directsunlight. The heat may damage thesunglasses.

CARGO NET

The net located under the instrument panel(passenger’s side) can be used to hold smallobjects.

The net can be removed when necessary.

WARNING

� Do not place sharp objects in the net.Such objects may become dangerousprojectiles and cause injury when thevehicle is moving or if the vehicle is

involved in a collision.

� The cargo restrained in the net mustnot exceed 4 lb (2 kg) or the net maynot stay secured.

CUP HOLDERS

CAUTION

� Avoid abrupt starting and brakingwhen the cup holder is being used toprevent spilling the drink. If the liquidis hot, it can scald you or your pas-senger.

� Use only soft cups in the cup holder.Hard objects can injure you in anaccident.

SIC3006

Instruments and controls 2-33

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 97: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

FrontType A:

To open the cup holder, slide the lid �1 .Install the partition plate into the slit �2 .

Type B:

Larger containers can be placed in the consolebox. Push the button�1 to open the console boxlid. The partition �A can be removed.

Soft bottle holder

CAUTION

� Do not use bottle holder for any otherobjects that could be thrown about inthe vehicle and possibly injurepeople during sudden braking or anaccident.

� Do not use bottle holder for openliquid containers.

SIC3007 SIC3384 SIC3008

2-34 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 98: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CONSOLE BOXPushing the button�1 will open the lid slightly,then pull up the lid manually �2 . The centerconsole box is equipped with a card holder�A .The inside tray (cup holder and partitions) canbe removed by pulling it up.

If objects (coins, etc.) fall into the rear section ofthe center console box, remove the rear wall�Bof the box as shown, and pick up the objects.

CAUTION

Be careful not to pinch your fingerswhen removing the rear wall �B .

REAR FLOOR BOXThe rear floor box is located behind the passen-ger’s seat.

Fold the passenger’s seatback forward to ac-cess the rear floor box.

Coupe model: Pull on the lever �A .Roadster model: Push the upper portion of thepower seatback tilt switch �B .

SIC3385 SIC3010 SSS0203Coupe model

Instruments and controls 2-35

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 99: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Return the passenger’s seatback to a lockedposition after using the rear floor box.Coupe model: Pull up on the lever�A and returnthe seatback.Roadster model: Push the lower portion of thepower seatback tilt switch �B .

The rear floor box may be opened by pulling thehandle. The rear floor box light illuminates whenthe box lid is opened with the headlight switchON.

When locking�1 or unlocking�2 the rear floorbox, use the master key.

The rear floor box has additional space under thebottom plate.

WARNING

Keep rear floor box lid closed whiledriving to help prevent injury in an acci-dent or a sudden stop.

SIC3348Roadster model

SIC1975A SIC2377

2-36 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 100: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

REAR PARCEL BOXPush the upper part of the lid to open the rearparcel box. For models without the Navigationsystem, two boxes are available.

WARNING

Keep rear parcel box lid closed whiledriving to help prevent injury in an acci-dent or a sudden stop.

STOWING GOLF BAGSFollow the instructions here to stow golf bags inthe rear cargo space of your vehicle. Normallytwo bags can be stowed in the luggage area(Coupe models) or one bag in the trunk (Road-ster models).

However, in some cases you may not be able tostow the above number of golf bags in yourvehicle, depending on their sizes or types.

Coupe models

Normally, two standard golf bags can be stowedacross the strut tower bar in the luggage area asillustrated (A and B). When stowing a golf bag Ain the rear space, insert the top of the golf bag

SIC1977

SIC2196

Instruments and controls 2-37

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 101: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

into left side of the luggage area�1 then put thebag down �2 .

Roadster models

Normally, one standard golf bag C can bestowed in the trunk. Insert the top of the golf baginto left side of the trunk �1 then put the bagdown �2 .

COAT HOOK (Coupe models)The hooks are locked above the side windowsas shown in the illustration.

CAUTION

Do not apply a total load of more than 2lb (1 kg) to a single hook.

SIC2237

SIC2378

2-38 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 102: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

POWER WINDOWS

WARNING

� Make sure that all passengers havetheir hands, etc. inside the vehiclewhile it is in motion and before clos-ing the windows. Use the windowlock switch to prevent unexpecteduse of the power windows.

� Do not leave children unattended in-side the vehicle. They could unknow-ingly activate switches or controlsand become trapped in a window.Unattended children could becomeinvolved in serious accidents.

The power windows operate when the ignitionkey is in the ON position and for about 45seconds, after the ignition key is turned to theOFF position. If the driver’s door or the frontpassenger’s door is opened during this period ofabout 45 seconds, power to the windows iscanceled.

The power window switches will be deactivatedduring the soft top operation. (Roadster models)

Driver’s side power window switch1. Driver side window2. Passenger side window3. Window lock button

To open or close the window, push down�A orpull up �B the switch and hold it. The mainswitch (driver side switches) will open or closeall the windows.

Passenger side power window switchThe passenger side switch will open or closeonly the corresponding window. To open orclose the window, hold the switch down or up.

Locking passenger’s windowWhen the lock button �C is pushed in, only thedriver side window can be opened or closed.Push it in again to cancel.

SIC3286 SIC3287

WINDOWS

Instruments and controls 2-39

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 103: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Automatic operation

To fully open or close the window, completelypress or lift the switch and release it; it need notbe held. The window will automatically open orclose all the way. To stop the window, just pressor lift the switch on the opposite side.

Auto reverse functionIf the control unit detects something caught in awindow as it moves up, the window will beimmediately lowered.

The auto reverse function can be activated whena window is closed by automatic operation whenthe ignition key is in the ON position or for about

45 seconds after the ignition key is turned to theOFF position.

Depending on the environment or drivingconditions, the auto reverse function maybe activated if an impact or load similar tosomething being caught in the windowoccurs.

WARNING

There are some small distances imme-diately before the closed position whichcannot be detected. Make sure that allpassengers have their hands, etc., in-side the vehicle before closing the win-dow.

Automatic window lowering (Roadstermodels)When the soft top operating switch is pressed,the power windows will automatically be low-ered completely. The windows do not rise auto-matically after the soft top open/close operationis completed. Use the power window switchesto raise them.

AUTOMATIC ADJUSTINGFUNCTION

CAUTION

When the battery cable is removed fromthe battery terminal, do not close eitherof the front doors. The automatic win-dow adjusting function will not work,and the side roof panel/top side railmay be damaged.

The power window has an automatic adjustingfunction. When the door is being opened, thewindow is automatically lowered slightly to avoidcontact between the window and the side roofpanel/top side rail. When the door is closed, thewindow is automatically raised slightly.

SIC3288

2-40 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 104: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

ROOM LIGHT

The interior light has a two-position switch. (�A :DOOR, �B : OFF)When the switch is in the DOOR position, thelight will illuminate when a door is opened.

The light will stay on for about 30 seconds when:

� The doors are unlocked by the keyfob, a keyor the power door lock switch while all doorsare closed.

� The driver’s door is opened and then closedwhile the key is removed from the ignitionswitch.

� The key is removed from the ignition switchwhile all doors are closed.

The interior light will turn off while the 30 secondtimer is activated, when:

� The driver’s door is locked either with thekeyfob, a key or the power door lock switch.

� The ignition switch is turned ON.

MAP LIGHTSTo turn on the light, push the plastic surface�Cof the light. Push it again to turn off the light.

When the map light stays on, it will auto-matically turn off 30 minutes after the

ignition switch has been turned to the OFFposition. To turn on the light again, turn theignition switch to the ON position.

The map and vanity mirror lights will automati-cally turn off 30 minutes after the latest operationof the following with the ignition switch in theACC or OFF position:

� Opening or closing any door

� Locking or unlocking with the keyfob, a key orthe power door lock switch

� Inserting or removing a key from the ignitionswitch

These lights will turn on again when any of theabove operations is performed after the lightshave turned off automatically. (The lights will turnoff 30 minutes after the latest operation of theabove as well.)

CAUTION

� Turn off the lights when you leave thevehicle.

� Do not use for extended periods oftime with the engine stopped. Thiscould result in a discharged battery.

SIC1980ACoupe models

SIC2238Roadster models

INTERIOR LIGHTS

Instruments and controls 2-41

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 105: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The light on the vanity mirror will turn on whenthe cover on the vanity mirror is opened.

When the vanity mirror light stays on, it willautomatically turn off 30 minutes after theignition switch has been turned to the OFFposition. To turn on the light again, turn theignition switch to the ON position.

The light illuminates when the rear hatch isopened. When the rear hatch is closed, the lightwill go off.

The light illuminates when the trunk lid isopened. When the trunk lid is closed, the lightwill go off.

SIC1859

VANITY MIRROR LIGHT LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT LIGHT(Coupe models)

TRUNK LIGHT (Roadster models)

2-42 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 106: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The HomeLink Universal Transceiver provides aconvenient way to consolidate the functions ofup to three individual hand-held transmitters intoone built-in device.

HomeLink Universal Transceiver:

� Will operate most Radio Frequency (RF)devices such as garage doors, gates, homeand office lighting, entry door locks and se-curity systems.

� Is powered by your vehicle’s battery. Noseparate batteries are required. If the vehi-cle’s battery is discharged or is discon-nected, HomeLink will retain all program-ming.

Once the HomeLink Universal Transceiveris programmed, retain the original trans-mitter for future programming procedures(for example, new vehicle purchases).Upon sale of the vehicle, the programmedHomeLink Universal Transceiver buttonsshould be erased for security purposes.For additional information, refer to “Pro-gramming HomeLink ” later in this sec-tion.

WARNING

� Do not use the HomeLink UniversalTransceiver with any garage dooropener that lacks safety stop andreverse features as required by fed-eral safety standards. (These stan-dards became effective for openermodels manufactured after April 1,1982). A garage door opener whichcannot detect an object in the path ofa closing garage door and then auto-matically stop and reverse, does notmeet current federal safety stan-dards. Using a garage door openerwithout these features increases therisk of serious injury or death.

� During the programming procedure,your garage door or security gate willopen or close (if the transmitter iswithin range). Make sure that peopleand objects are clear of the garagedoor, gate, etc. that you areprogramming.

� Your vehicle’s engine should beturned off while programming theHomeLink Universal Transceiver.

PROGRAMMING HomeLinkTo program your HomeLink Transceiver to op-erate a garage door, gate, or entry door opener,home or office lighting, you need to be at thesame location as the device. Note: Garage dooropeners (manufactured after 1996) have “rollingcode protection”. To program a garage dooropener equipped with “rolling code protection”;you will need to use a ladder to get up to thegarage door opener motor to be able to accessthe training button.

HomeLink UNIVERSALTRANSCEIVER (if so equipped)

Instruments and controls 2-43

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 107: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. To begin, press and hold the 2 outerHomeLink buttons (to clear the memory)until the indicator light �A blinks (after 20seconds). Release both buttons.

2. Position the end of the hand-held transmitter1 - 3 in (26 - 76 mm) away from theHomeLink surface.

3. Using both hands, simultaneously press andhold both the HomeLink button you want toprogram and the hand-held transmitter but-ton.DO NOT release the buttons until step 4 hasbeen completed.

4. Hold down both buttons until the indicatorlight on the HomeLink flashes, changingfrom a “slow blink” to a “rapid blink”. Whenthe indicator light flashes rapidly, both but-tons may be released. The rapidly flashinglight indicates successful programming. Toactivate the garage door or other pro-grammed device, press and hold the pro-grammed HomeLink button - releasing

when the device begins to activate.

5. If the indicator light on the HomeLink blinksrapidly for two seconds and then turns solid,HomeLink has picked up a “rolling code”garage door opener signal. You will need toproceed with the next steps to train theHomeLink to complete the programmingwhich may require a ladder and anotherperson for convenience.

6. Press and release the training button locatedon the garage door opener’s motor to acti-vate the “training mode”. This button is usu-ally located near the antenna wire that hangsdown from the motor. If the wire originatesfrom under a light lens, you will need toremove the lens to access the training button.

NOTE:

Once you have pressed and released thetraining button on the garage door open-er’s motor and the “training light” is lit, youhave 30 seconds in which to perform step7. Use the help of a second person forconvenience to assist when performingthis step.

7. Quickly within 30 seconds of pressing andreleasing the garage door opener programbutton, firmly press and release theHomeLink button you’ve just programmed.

SIC3012 SIC3011

2-44 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 108: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Press and release the HomeLink button upto three times to complete the training.

8. Your HomeLink button should now be pro-grammed.

To program the remaining HomeLink buttonsfor additional door or gate openers, follow steps2-8 only.

NOTE:

Do not repeat step 1 unless you want to“clear” all previously programmedHomeLink buttons.

If you have any questions or are having difficultyprogramming your HomeLink buttons, refer tothe HomeLink web site at: www.homelink.comor call 1-800-355-3515.

PROGRAMMING HomeLink FORCANADIAN CUSTOMERSPrior to 1992, D.O.C. regulations required hand-held transmitters to stop transmitting after 2seconds. To program your hand-held transmitterto HomeLink , continue to press and hold theHomeLink button (note steps 2 through 4under “Programming HomeLink ”) while youpress and re-press (“cycle”) your hand-heldtransmitter every 2 seconds until the indicatorlight flashes rapidly (indicating successful pro-gramming).

NOTE:

When programming a garage door opener,etc., it is advised to unplug the deviceduring the “cycling” process to preventpossible damage to the garage dooropener components.

OPERATING THE HomeLinkUNIVERSAL TRANSCEIVER

The HomeLink Universal Transceiver (onceprogrammed) may now be used to activate thegarage door, etc. To operate, simply press theappropriate programmed HomeLink UniversalTransceiver button. The red indicator light willilluminate while the signal is being transmitted.

PROGRAMMINGTROUBLE-DIAGNOSISIf the HomeLink does not quickly learn thehand-held transmitter information:

� replace the hand-held transmitter batterieswith new batteries.

� position the hand-held transmitter with itsbattery area facing away from the HomeLinksurface.

� press and hold both the HomeLink andhand-held transmitter buttons without inter-ruption.

� position the hand-held transmitter 2 to 5 in(50 to 127 mm) away from the HomeLinksurface. Hold the transmitter in that positionfor up to 15 seconds. If HomeLink is notprogrammed within that time, try holding thetransmitter in another position - keeping theindicator light in view at all times.

If you continue to have programming difficulties,please contact the NISSAN Consumer AffairsDepartment. The phone numbers are located inthe Foreword of this Owner’s Manual.

CLEARING THE PROGRAMMEDINFORMATIONIndividual buttons cannot be cleared, however toclear all programming, press and hold the twooutside buttons and release when the indicatorlight begins to flash (approximately 20 seconds).

REPROGRAMMING A SINGLEHomeLink BUTTONTo reprogram a HomeLink Universal Trans-ceiver button, complete the following.

1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink but-ton. Do not release the button until step 4has been completed.

2. When the indicator light begins to flashslowly (after 20 seconds), position the hand-held transmitter 2 to 5 in (50 to 127 mm)

Instruments and controls 2-45

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 109: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

away from the HomeLink surface.

3. Press and hold the hand-held transmitterbutton.

4. The HomeLink indicator light will flash, firstslowly and then rapidly. When the indicatorlight begins to flash rapidly, release bothbuttons.

The HomeLink Universal Transceiver buttonhas now been reprogrammed. The new devicecan be activated by pushing the HomeLinkbutton that was just programmed. This proce-dure will not affect any other programmedHomeLink buttons.

IF YOUR VEHICLE IS STOLENIf your vehicle is stolen, you should change thecodes of any non-rolling code device that hasbeen programmed into HomeLink . Consult theOwner’s Manual of each device or call themanufacturer or dealer of those devices foradditional information.

When your vehicle is recovered, you willneed to reprogram the HomeLink Univer-sal Transceiver with your new transmitterinformation.

FCC Notice:

This device complies with FCC rules part15. Operation is subject to the following

two conditions: (1) This device may notcause harmful interference and (2) Thisdevice must accept any interference thatmay be received, including interferencethat may cause undesired operation.

The transmitter has been tested and com-plies with FCC and DOC/MDC rules.Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible for com-pliance could void the user’s authority tooperate the device.

DOC: ISTC 1763K1313

FCC I.D.: CB2V67690

2-46 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 110: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

MEMO

Instruments and controls 2-47

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 111: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

MEMO

2-48 Instruments and controls

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 112: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

3 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Keys ......................................................................................... 3-2NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys ................ 3-2

Doors ....................................................................................... 3-3Locking with key ............................................................. 3-3Locking with inside lock knob ..................................... 3-4Locking with power door lock switch ....................... 3-4

Remote keyless entry system ............................................ 3-5How to use remote keyless entry system ................ 3-5

Hood ........................................................................................ 3-8Rear hatch (Coupe models) .............................................. 3-9Opener operation ........................................................... 3-9Secondary rear hatch release .................................... 3-10

Trunk lid (Roadster models) ............................................ 3-10Opener operation ......................................................... 3-10Interior trunk lid release ............................................... 3-11Secondary trunk lid release ........................................ 3-12

Soft top (Roadster models) .............................................. 3-13

Before operating the top ............................................. 3-13When operating the top .............................................. 3-15Opening the top ............................................................ 3-18Closing the top .............................................................. 3-19If the top does not open or close electrically ........ 3-19Care of the soft top and the vehicle body.............. 3-22

Fuel-filler door ..................................................................... 3-23Opener operation ......................................................... 3-23Fuel-filler cap ................................................................. 3-23

Steering wheel .................................................................... 3-25Tilt operation .................................................................. 3-25

Sun visors.............................................................................. 3-25Mirrors ................................................................................... 3-26Inside mirror .................................................................... 3-26Automatic anti-glare inside mirror(if so equipped) ............................................................ 3-26Outside mirrors ............................................................. 3-27

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 113: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Master keys*2. Valet key*3. Key number plate(* With built-in transponder chip)A key number plate is supplied with your keys.Record the key number and keep it in a safeplace (such as your wallet), not in the vehicle. Ifyou lose your keys, see a NISSAN dealer forduplicates by using the key number. NISSANdoes not record any key numbers so it is veryimportant to keep track of your key number plate.

A key number is only necessary when you havelost all keys and do not have one to duplicatefrom. If you still have a key, this key can be

duplicated by a NISSAN dealer.

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZERSYSTEM KEYS

You can only drive your vehicle using the masteror valet keys which are registered to the NISSANVehicle Immobilizer System components in yourvehicle. These keys have a transponder chip inthe key head.

The master key can be used for all the locks.

The valet key cannot be used for the rear floorbox lock. To protect belongings when you leavea key with someone, give them the valet key only.

Never leave these keys in the vehicle.

Additional or replacement keys:

If you still have a key, the key number is notnecessary when you need extra NISSAN VehicleImmobilizer System keys. Your dealer can dupli-cate your existing key. As many as 5 keys can beused with one vehicle. You should bring all theregistered keys that you have to a NISSANdealer for registration. This is because the reg-istration process will erase the memory of all keycodes previously registered into the NISSANVehicle Immobilizer System. After the registra-tion process, these components will only recog-nize keys coded into the NISSAN Vehicle Immo-bilizer System during registration. Any key that is

not given to your dealer at the time of registrationwill no longer be able to start your vehicle.

CAUTION

Do not allow the NISSAN Vehicle Immo-bilizer System key, which contains anelectrical transponder, to come in con-tact with salt water. This could cause thesystem to malfunction.

SPA1379D

KEYS

3-2 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 114: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

� Always have the doors locked whiledriving. Along with the use of seatbelts, this provides greater safety inthe event of an accident by helping toprevent persons from being thrownfrom the vehicle. This also helps keepchildren and others from uninten-tionally opening the doors, and willhelp keep out intruders.

� Before opening any door, alwayslook for and avoid oncoming traffic.

� Do not leave children unattended in-side the vehicle. They could unknow-ingly activate switches or controls.Unattended children could becomeinvolved in serious accidents.

LOCKING WITH KEY

The power door lock system allows you to lockor unlock all doors including the rear hatch/trunklid simultaneously.

� Turning the driver’s door key to the rear of thevehicle �1 will lock all doors including therear hatch/trunk lid.

� Turning the driver’s door key one time to thefront of the vehicle�2 will unlock the driver’sdoor and rear hatch/trunk lid. From that po-sition, returning the key to neutral (where thekey can only be removed and inserted) andturning it to the front again within 5 seconds

will unlock the passenger’s door.

Opening and closing windowsTurn the driver’s door key towards the front ofthe vehicle (UNLOCK position) and hold forabout 1 second, all door windows will begin tolower.

To close all door windows, turn the key to theLOCK position and hold for about 1 second.

To stop opening or closing, turn the key to theneutral position.

In the event of a hand in the way, or otherobstruction, the auto reverse function will acti-vate.

SPA1503A

DOORS

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-3

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 115: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

LOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCKKNOBPushing the door inside lock knob to the LOCK�1 or UNLOCK �2 position will lock or unlockthe corresponding door. (The rear hatch/trunk lidlock is linked with the driver side door lock.)

To individually lock the doors from the outside(without a key), move the inside lock knob to theLOCK position. Then close the door.

When locking the door without a key, besure not to leave the key inside the vehicle.

LOCKING WITH POWER DOORLOCK SWITCH

All doors will be locked when the power doorlock switch is pushed to the LOCK position�1with the driver’s or front passenger’s door open.Then close the door and all doors will be locked.

When locking the door this way, be certainnot to leave the key inside the vehicle.

To unlock, push the power door lock switch tothe UNLOCK position �2 .Lockout protectionWhen the power door lock switch (driver or front

passenger) is moved to the LOCK position �1with the key in the ignition and any door open, alldoors will lock and unlock automatically. Thishelps to prevent the keys from being accidentallylocked inside the vehicle.

SPA2420 SPA2320

3-4 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 116: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

It is possible to lock/unlock all doors (includingthe rear hatch/trunk lid), release the rearhatch/trunk lid and activate the panic alarm byusing the keyfob from outside the vehicle.Before locking the doors, make sure thekey is not left in the vehicle.The keyfob can operate at a distance of approxi-mately 33 ft (10 m) from the vehicle. (Theeffective distance depends upon the conditionsaround the vehicle.)As many as 5 keyfobs can be used with onevehicle. For information concerning the purchaseand use of additional keyfobs, contact a NISSANdealer.

The keyfob will not function when:

� the battery is discharged,

� the distance between the vehicle and thekeyfob is over 33 ft (10 m).

The panic alarm and the rear hatch/trunklid release will not activate when the key isin the ignition switch.

CAUTION

The following conditions or occurrenceswill damage the keyfob.

� Do not allow the keyfob to becomewet.

� Do not drop the keyfob.

� Do not strike the keyfob sharplyagainst another object.

� Do not place the keyfob for an ex-tended period in an area where tem-peratures exceed 140°F (60°C).

If a keyfob is lost or stolen, NISSANrecommends erasing the ID code of thatkeyfob. This will prevent the keyfobfrom unauthorized use to unlock thevehicle. For information regarding theerasing procedure, please contact aNISSAN dealer.

For information regarding the replacement of abattery, see “Keyfob battery replacement” in the“8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.

�1 LOCK button�2 UNLOCK button�3 HATCH/TRUNK button�4 PANIC buttonHOW TO USE REMOTE KEYLESSENTRY SYSTEM

Locking doors

1. Remove the ignition key.*1 *2

2. Close all the doors.*3

3. Push the LOCK button on the keyfob.

SPA1918

REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRYSYSTEM

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-5

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 117: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

4. All the doors will lock.

All of the doors will lock when the LOCKbutton on the keyfob is pushed even

though a door remains open and/or theignition switch is in the ON position.

5. The hazard indicator flashes twice and thehorn chirps once.

� When the LOCK button is pushed withall doors locked, the hazard indicator flashestwice and the horn chirps once as a reminderthat the doors are already locked.

*1: Doors lock with the keyfob while a key is inthe ignition switch. However, the panicalarm and the rear hatch/trunk lid release willnot activate when the key is in the ignitionswitch.

*2: Doors lock with the keyfob while the ignitionswitch is in the ON position. However, thehazard indicator and horn will not function.

*3: Doors lock with the keyfob while any door isopen. However, the hazard indicator andhorn will not function.

Unlocking doors

1. Push the UNLOCK button on the key-fob once.

� The driver’s door and rear hatch/trunk lidunlock.

� The hazard indicator flashes once if all doorsare completely closed with the ignition switchin any position except the ON position.

� The interior light turns on and the light timeractivates for 30 seconds when the switch isin the DOOR position with the ignition switchin any position except the ON position.

2. Push the UNLOCK button on the key-fob again within 5 seconds.

� Passenger’s door unlocks.

� The hazard indicator flashes once if all doorsare completely closed.

All doors will be locked automatically unless oneof the following operations is performed within 1minute of pushing the UNLOCK button.

� Any door or rear hatch/trunk lid is opened.

� The ignition switch is turned to the ONposition.

The interior light can be turned off withoutwaiting for 30 seconds by turning the ignitionswitch to the ON position or by locking thedoors with the keyfob.

Opening the windows

Push the UNLOCK button on the keyfoband the driver’s door will unlock.

Continue to push the UNLOCK button for3 seconds. All the door windows will start to belowered. Keep pushing the UNLOCK but-ton until the windows are fully open.

To stop lowering the windows, release the UN-LOCK button. To start lowering the win-dows again, push the UNLOCK buttonagain for 3 more seconds.

Releasing the rear hatch/trunk lid

1. Push the HATCH/TRUNK button onthe keyfob for longer than 0.5 second withthe key removed from the ignition switch.

2. The rear hatch (Coupe) or trunk lid (Road-ster) opens.

Using the panic alarm

If you are near your vehicle and feel threatened,you may activate the alarm to call attention bypushing and holding the PANIC button onthe keyfob for longer than 0.5 second (withthe key removed from the ignition switch).

The theft warning alarm and headlights will stayon for 30 seconds.

3-6 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 118: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The panic alarm stops when:

� It has run for 30 seconds, or

� The LOCK button or the UNLOCKbutton is pushed, or

� The PANIC button or theHATCH/TRUNK button is pushed onthe keyfob for longer than 0.5 second.

Setting hazard indicator and hornmode

This vehicle is set in hazard indicator and hornmode when you first receive the vehicle.

In hazard indicator and horn mode, when theLOCK button is pushed, the hazard indi-cator flashes twice and the horn chirps once.When the UNLOCK button is pushed, thehazard indicator flashes once.

If hazard indicator and horn mode is not neces-sary, you can switch to hazard indicator onlymode by following the switching procedure.

In hazard indicator only mode, when the LOCK

button is pushed, the hazard indicatorflashes twice. When the UNLOCK buttonis pushed, neither the hazard indicator nor thehorn operates.

(Switching procedure)

Push the LOCK and UNLOCK but-tons on the keyfob simultaneously for more than2 seconds to switch from one mode to the other.

When pushing the buttons to set hazard indica-tor only mode, the hazard indicator flashes 3times.

When pushing the buttons to set hazard indica-tor and horn mode, the hazard indicator flashes

SPA1260

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-7

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 119: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

once and the horn chirps once.

1. Pull the hood lock release handle�1 locatedbelow the instrument panel; the hood willthen spring up slightly.

2. Raise the lever �2 at the front of the hoodwith your fingertips and raise the hood.

3. Insert the assist bar into the slot �3 in thefront edge of the hood.

4. When closing the hood, reset the assist barto its original position, then slowly close thehood and make sure it locks into place.

Hold the coated part�A when removing orresetting the support rod. Avoid direct con-tact with the metal parts, as they may be

hot immediately after the engine has beenstopped.

WARNING

� Make sure the hood is completelyclosed and latched before driving.Failure to do so could cause the hoodto fly open and result in an accident.

� If you see steam or smoke comingfrom the engine compartment, toavoid injury do not open the hood.

SPA2313

HOOD

3-8 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 120: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

Do not drive with the rear hatch open.This could allow dangerous exhaustgases to be drawn into the vehicle. See“Precautions when starting and driving”in the “5. Starting and driving” sectionfor exhaust gas.

OPENER OPERATION

The rear hatch release switch is located be-tween the license plate lights.

To open the rear hatch, unlock it with one of thefollowing operations then push the releaseswitch:

� Push the UNLOCK button on the key-fob once. (Pushing the HATCH/TRUNK

button on the keyfob can open the rearhatch at once without pushing the releaseswitch.)

� Insert the key into the door key cylinder andturn the door key counterclockwise once.

� Push the power door lock switch to theUNLOCK side.

The rear hatch employs a spring componentwhich enables you to lift up the hatch by onehand. Because of this, sometimes the rear hatchmay clatter when the lock is released, but it is nota malfunction.

To close, push the rear hatch down securely.

The rear hatch release switch is linked with thedriver side door lock. To open the rear hatch,unlock the driver side door.

SPA1507

REAR HATCH (Coupe models)

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-9

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 121: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

SECONDARY REAR HATCHRELEASEThe secondary rear hatch release mechanismallows opening the rear hatch in the event ofdischarged battery or emergency.

The release (string) handle is located under thestrut tower bar inside the luggage compartment.

To open the rear hatch from the inside,firmly pull the release handle to the direc-tion shown above until the lock releases.

WARNING

� Do not drive with the trunk lid open.This could allow dangerous exhaustgases to be drawn into the vehicle.See “Precautions when starting anddriving” in the “5. Starting and driv-ing” section for exhaust gas.

� Closely supervise children when theyare around cars to prevent them fromplaying and becoming locked in thetrunk where they could be seriouslyinjured. Keep the car locked, with thetrunk closed when not in use, andprevent children’s access to car keys.

OPENER OPERATION

The trunk lid release switch is located betweenthe license plate lights.

To open the trunk lid, unlock it with one of thefollowing operations then push the releaseswitch:

� Push the UNLOCK button on the key-fob once. (Pushing the HATCH/TRUNK

button on the keyfob can open thetrunk lid at once without pushing the releaseswitch.)

� Insert the key into the door key cylinder andturn it counterclockwise once.

SPA1556 SPA1685

TRUNK LID (Roadster models)

3-10 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 122: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� Push the power door lock switch to theUNLOCK side. (After locking the doors with akeyfob, this switch is not available due to thesecurity system.)

To close, push the trunk lid down securely.

The trunk lid release switch is linked with thedriver side door lock. To open the trunk lid,unlock the driver side door.

Cancel switchWhen the cancel switch (located inside the rearfloor box) is OFF, the trunk lid cannot be openedwith the release switch. It can be opened only bypushing the HATCH/TRUNK button onthe keyfob.

INTERIOR TRUNK LID RELEASE

WARNING

Closely supervise children when theyare around cars to prevent them fromplaying and becoming locked in thetrunk where they could be seriously in-jured. Keep the car locked, with thetrunk closed when not in use, and pre-vent children’s access to car keys.

SPA1686 SPA1687

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-11

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 123: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The interior trunk lid release mechanism pro-vides a means of escape for children and adultsin the event they become locked inside the trunk.

The handle �A is located inside the trunk com-partment as illustrated.

To open the trunk lid from the inside, pullthe release handle towards you until thelock releases and push up on the trunk lid.The release lever is made of a material thatglows in the dark after a brief exposure toambient light.

SECONDARY TRUNK LID RELEASEThe secondary trunk lid release mechanism al-lows opening the trunk lid in the event of dis-charged battery or emergency.

Remove the cover�1 (located inside of the rearfloor box) using a suitable tool �2 as shown.Access the release (string) handle �3 .To open the trunk lid from the inside, firmlypull the release handle to the directionshown above until the lock releases.

SPA1688

3-12 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 124: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Soft top operating switch

2. Soft top indicator light (on the combinationmeter)

3. Top side rail

4. Top latch lever

5. Soft top

6. Top storage lid

7. Trunk lid

8. Rear window

9. Rear section of the top

BEFORE OPERATING THE TOPThe soft top of your 350Z Roadster is electricallyoperated. You can fully open or close the toponly by pressing the operating switch (on thelower side of the instrument panel).

The soft top operating switch must be operatedunder all of the following conditions:

� When the foot brake pedal is depressed.

� When the vehicle is stopped.

� When the engine is running.

CAUTION

Always keep the engine running whileoperating the soft top. The top will alsooperate when the ignition switch is inthe ON position, but run the engine toprevent a discharged battery.

Be sure to follow the operating instructions, andall the warnings and cautions in this section.Improper operation of the top could causea system malfunction, damage, or deterio-ration of the top material and related parts.

WARNING

� Park the vehicle in a safe and levelplace and apply the parking brake.

� Make sure the area is clear of ob-stacles and there is enough clear-ance over the top (for example, in agarage or a covered area). More thanapproximately 6.6 ft (2 m) from theground is required to open or closethe top safely. Otherwise, the topmay damage any objects above it

SPA2339Interior/exterior view

SOFT TOP (Roadster models)

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-13

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 125: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

while moving. The top operating sys-tem could also be damaged.

� Do not operate the top in a strongwind. It could be blown by the wind,striking someone or damage the top.

� Do not allow anyone to stand up orextend any portion of their body outof the opening while the vehicle is inmotion or while the top is being op-erated.

� In an accident you could be thrownfrom the vehicle with an open top.Always use seat belts and properchild restraints.

CAUTION

� Do not operate the top when thetemperature is below 32°F (0°C). Thismay result in damage to the top ma-terial or operating system.

� Remove water drops, snow, ice orsand from the top, and dry the sur-

face of the top completely beforeopening it.

� Do not open the top when it is wet ordamp. This may cause interior waterdamage, stains or mildew on the topmaterial.

� Be sure to turn off the rear windowdefroster switch. Never turn it onwhile the top is being operated orfully opened. The heat may damagethe top material.

CAUTION

� Do not place any objects between thetop cloth and the structure. Doing socould interfere with top operationand cause damage to the top operat-ing system or the objects.

� Do not place anything on the top andthe storage lid. Even small items mayinterfere with the top operation andcould cause damage to the top or the

SPA1701

3-14 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 126: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

vehicle body.

� Do not place anything in the top stor-age area. The top will not fit thereproperly, and this could damage thetop and/or the vehicle body.

� Do not sit or place excessive weighton the top and the storage lid, espe-cially when the top is being operated.The top may be damaged.

� Do not drive the vehicle with the toppartially opened. Always make surethe top is either fully opened orclosed before driving.

� Secure items so that they cannot beblown from the vehicle while drivingwith the top open.

� When a child restraint is installed inthe passenger seat, be sure to turnthe seatback tilt cancel switch (lo-cated on the passenger seatback) tothe CANCEL position, or the childrestraint may be damaged.

Make sure the trunk lid is securely closed beforeoperating the top.

WHEN OPERATING THE TOP

WARNING

Keep hands and other parts of the bodyaway frommoving parts such as the top,storage lid and power windows.

CAUTION

Keep all parts of the top linkage clear ofobstructions, or the top latch may not besecurely locked.

NOTE:

� In case of low battery or low tempera-ture, the top may temporarily stop mov-ing during the operation. This functionsto protect the top control mechanism,and it is not a malfunction.

� If the top is opened and closed repeat-edly in a short period of time, it maystop moving to protect the top motor.Wait for a few minutes before operatingthe top again.

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-15

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 127: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Top latch lever

The soft top has three locking points to engagethe front edge of the top to the vehicle body.Operating the top latch lever enables you to lockor unlock all three locking points at the sametime.

CAUTION

Before opening the top, be sure torelease the top latch. After closing,securely engage the top to the vehiclebody.

To release the latch (before opening thetop):

�1 Push the safety switch �A .�2 The latch lever �B is lowered.�3 Swing the lever forward until the latch isreleased.

To engage the latch (after closing the top):

Check that the top is in the fully closed position.

�1 Push the safety switch �A .�2 The latch lever �B is lowered.

�3 Rotate the lever forward until the front edgeof the top is completely joined to the vehiclebody.

�4 Rotate the lever toward you and push it upinto the stored position. Make sure the top issecurely engaged to the vehicle body.

The soft top indicator light will flash with theignition switch ON when the top is not en-gaged. See “Soft top indicator light” later inthis section.

When releasing or engaging the top latch,you may hear the latch operating. This isnormal and not a malfunction.

SPA1690

3-16 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 128: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Soft top indicator light

The soft top indicator light in the instrumentpanel shows the conditions of top operation. Thelight illuminates when the soft top is beingoperated or if it is stopped before reaching thefully opened or closed position. When the top isfully opened, the light will turn off. When the topis fully closed, the light will flash.

When the soft top is in motion, and any of thefollowing conditions occur, the top will stopmoving:

� The vehicle is moved.

� The ignition switch is turned to OFF.

� The foot brake pedal is released.

� The passenger power seat switch (on thecushion or the seatback) is operated.

Remove your hand from the soft top operatingswitch, and push the switch again to move thetop to the fully opened or closed position. Thesoft top indicator light will turn off when the topopen operation is completely finished. Whenclosing the top, the light, which is illuminated,will begin to flash when the top close operationis completely finished. Securely engage the topto the vehicle body by operating the top latchlever. The light will turn off.

If the soft top indicator light flashes with theignition switch ON (whether the top is operatedor not, and when the top is engaged), it mayindicate the top operating system is not func-tioning properly. Have your vehicle checked by aNISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

Automatic passenger seatback tiltfunctionThe passenger seatback will automatically tiltforward when the soft top is operated. Thisfunction is designed to draw your passenger’sattention to the rear section of the top, which willcome into the passenger compartment frombehind during the top operation. The seatbackwill return to the original position when the entire

top operation is completed.

This automatic seatback movement will bestopped:

� When the passenger seat sliding or recliningswitch (on the seat cushion) is operated.

� When the power seatback tilt switch (on theseatback) is operated.

� When the seatback tilt cancel switch isturned to the CANCEL position.

Remove your hand from the soft top operatingswitch, and push it again to resume operation.The passenger seatback will start tilting forwardagain from the present position, and the soft topwill start opening or closing. If the top movementis interrupted at this time, the next time youresume top operation, the seatback will first tiltforward from the present position, then the topwill start moving again.

If you need to cancel this function or when achild restraint is installed in the passenger seat,push the seatback tilt cancel switch to theCANCEL position. For the seatback tilt cancelswitch, see “Tilting and reclining passenger’sseat from driver’s seat” in the “1. Safety —Seats, seat belts and supplemental restrain sys-tem” section.

If the seatback tilt cancel switch is in the CAN-

SPA1691

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-17

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 129: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CEL position and the passenger seat is occu-pied, ask the passenger to sit forward when thetop is being opened or closed.

Automatic window loweringWhen the soft top operating switch is pressed,the power windows will automatically be low-ered completely. The windows do not rise auto-matically after the top operation is completed.Use the power window switches to raise them.

OPENING THE TOP

1. Apply the parking brake and move the selec-tor lever to the P (Park) position (for theautomatic transmission model) or the shiftlever to the N (Neutral) position (for themanual transmission model).

2. Start the engine.

3. Depress the foot brake pedal.

4. Release the front edge of the top from thevehicle body with the top latch lever.

5. Push OPEN on the soft top operating switchand hold it until the top is fully opened.

• The soft top indicator light will illuminatewhile the top is in motion. (In about 20seconds, the opening movement will finishand the indicator light turns off.)

• Windows will automatically be fullyopened.

• The passenger seatback will automaticallymove forward, unless the seatback tiltcancel switch is in the CANCEL position.It will return to the original position afterthe top operation. (See “Automatic pas-senger seatback tilt function” shown onthe previous page of this section.)

6. Release the switch when the top is fullyopened. (The indicator light turns off.)

NOTE:

If you release the switch and press it againwhile the top is being opened, the top willslightly move to the closing direction, thenstart moving to the opening directionagain. The top is designed to move in thisway. It is not a malfunction.

SPA1692

3-18 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 130: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CLOSING THE TOP

1. Apply the parking brake and move the selec-tor lever to the P (Park) position (for theautomatic transmission model) or the shiftlever to the N (Neutral) position (for themanual transmission model).

2. Start the engine.

3. Depress the foot brake pedal.

4. Push CLOSE on the soft top operatingswitch and hold it until the top is fully closed.

• The soft top indicator light will illuminatewhile the top is in motion. (In about 20

seconds, the closing movement will fin-ish.)

• Windows will automatically be fullyopened.

• The passenger seatback will automaticallymove forward, unless the seatback tiltcancel switch is in the CANCEL position.It will return to the original position afterthe top operation. (See “Automatic pas-senger seatback tilt function” shown onthe previous page of this section.)

5. Release the switch when the top is fullyclosed. (The indicator light, which is illumi-nated, will begin to flash.)

6. Securely engage the front edge of the top tothe vehicle body with the top latch lever. (Theindicator light turns off.)

IF THE TOP DOES NOT OPEN ORCLOSE ELECTRICALLYIf you cannot operate the soft top with theoperating switch, first check whether all thefollowing operating conditions are completed:

� foot brake pedal is depressed

� vehicle is stopped

� ignition switch is ON (Run the engine whenoperating the top.)

If the top still does not move under the aboveconditions or has any system malfunction, see aNISSAN dealer as soon as possible. When youmust close the top by yourself, in the event ofemergency or when an immediate dealer serviceis not available, close the top manually accordingto the procedures shown in this section.

When closing the soft top manually:

� Move the vehicle to a safe place, away fromtraffic.

� Two people should perform this procedure,as some of the top parts are extremely heavy.

The top cannot be opened manually.

WARNING

� Do not drive with the top partiallyopened.

� If the top cannot be operated prop-erly, see a NISSAN dealer as soon aspossible to have your vehiclechecked.

SPA1693

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-19

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 131: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Open the trunk lid. In the event of dischargedbattery, you need to open the trunk lid asfollows:

a. Open the rear floor box behind the passengerseat.

b. Remove the cap�A using a suitable tool�B .c. Pull the string handle (secondary trunk lidrelease)�C until the trunk lid lock is released.

d. Lift up the trunk lid.

2. Open the top storage lid

a. Remove floorboard inside of the trunk.

b. Remove the harness connector �D of thestorage lid motor installed on the back rightside of the trunk by pulling in a downwarddirection.

c. Pull down the lock release cable (right andleft) �E .

d. Listen for a clicking sound of the lock releas-ing.

e. Pull up the storage lid from the left and rightside of vehicle by hand.

CAUTION

The storage lid is extremely heavy. Pull-ing it up should be done by two people.

SPA1694 SPA1695

3-20 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 132: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

3. Close the soft top.a. Remove the harness connectors of the topmotor, �F (right side of the vehicle) and �H(left side).

CAUTION

Two harness connectors are installed onthe right side and three on the left sideas shown. Only the harness connectors�F and �H should be removed. (Do notremove the other harness connectors�G , �I and �J .)

b. A person on each side of the vehicle shouldslowly pull the top to the closed position.

c. Latch the front edge of the top to the vehiclebody with the top latch lever.

4. Push the storage lid down to the vehicle bodypanel and close it. (Listen for locking soundsfrom both right and left sides of the lid.)

5. Lower the rear section of the top.

a. Remove the shock absorber �K which sup-ports the rear section of the top from thevehicle body. (Both the left and right sidemust be removed — the figure above showsthe left side.) To remove the shock absorber,remove the holder �L on the terminal partusing a flat-bladed screwdriver �M .

CAUTION

When the shock absorber is removed,the rear section of the top loses support

SPA1734Right side

SPA1708Left side

SPA1697

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-21

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 133: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

and falls simultaneously. Support thetop by hand so it does not strike thebody.

b. Lower the rear part of the top and push itonto the top storage lid. The top is locked tothe storage lid, but the bottom of the rear partis not closed tightly.

CAUTION

� After closing the top manually, havethe system checked and/or repairedby a NISSAN dealer as soon as pos-sible.

� Avoid leaving the vehicle outside forlong periods or driving at highspeeds. The rear of the top is notlocked completely, and this may al-low wind and rain to get into yourvehicle.

CARE OF THE SOFT TOP AND THEVEHICLE BODY

To use your Roadster safely and comfortably,

you need to observe all the warnings and cau-tions shown in the previous pages. Also, tomaintain a good appearance of the soft top andthe vehicle body, you need to care for them bycleaning and/or washing properly.

CAUTION

� Do not use an automatic car wash ora high-pressure car wash to cleanyour vehicle. The top may be dam-aged and water may leak into theinside of the vehicle.

� Store the vehicle with the top closedif it is not to be used for long periods.Keeping the top stowed for long pe-riods may cause wrinkles on the sur-face of the top.

See “Cleaning exterior” in the “7. Appearanceand care” section for detailed instructions.

� A protective clear tape is applied to the topstorage lid painted surface where the soft topcontacts the surface. When the top is fullyclosed, the tape may transmit some light,visible from the inside of the vehicle. Thisdoes not affect the water and air tightness ofthe seal.

� The inner surface of the trunk and top storagelids may show a fibrous, or marbled pattern.This is the normal appearance of the materialused in these parts.

3-22 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 134: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

OPENER OPERATIONTo open the fuel-filler door, push the openerswitch located below the instrument panel. Tolock, close the fuel-filler door securely.

FUEL-FILLER CAP

�1 To remove the fuel-filler cap, turn it counter-clockwise.

�2 Hang the string of the cap on the hook�A asshown while refueling.

The fuel-filler cap is a ratcheting type. Tightenthe cap clockwise until ratcheting clicks areheard.

WARNING

� Gasoline is extremely flammable and

highly explosive under certain condi-tions. You could be burned or seri-ously injured if it is misused or mis-handled. Always stop the engine anddo not smoke or allow open flamesor sparks near the vehicle when refu-eling.

� Do not attempt to top off the fueltank after the fuel pump nozzle shutsoff automatically. Continued refuel-ing may cause fuel overflow, result-ing in fuel spray and possibly a fire.

SPA1508 SPA2421

FUEL-FILLER DOOR

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-23

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 135: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� Use only an original equipment typefuel-filler cap as a replacement. It hasa built-in safety valve needed forproper operation of the fuel systemand emission control system. An in-correct cap can result in a seriousmalfunction and possible injury. Itcould also cause the malfunction in-dicator light to come on.

� Do not fill a portable fuel container inthe vehicle or trailer. Static electricitycan cause an explosion of flammableliquid, vapor or gas in any vehicle ortrailer. To reduce the risk of seriousinjury or death when filling portablefuel containers:— Always place the container on theground when filling.

— Do not use electronic deviceswhen filling.

— Keep the pump nozzle in contactwith the container while you arefilling it.

— Use only approved portable fuelcontainers for flammable liquid.

� Never pour fuel into the throttle bodyto attempt to start your vehicle.

CAUTION

� If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body,flush it away with water to avoidpaint damage.

� Tighten until the fuel-filler cap clicks.Failure to tighten the fuel-filler capproperly may cause the mal-function indicator light (MIL) to illu-minate. If the light illuminatesbecause the fuel-filler cap is loose ormissing, tighten or install the cap andcontinue to drive the vehicle. The

light should turn off after a fewdriving trips. If the light doesnot turn off after a few driving trips,have the vehicle inspected by aNISSAN dealer.

� For additional information, see the“Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” inthe “2. Instruments and controls”

section.

3-24 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 136: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

TILT OPERATIONPush the lock lever down and adjust the steeringwheel up or down to the desired position.

Push the lock lever up securely to lock thesteering wheel in place.

WARNING

Do not adjust the steering wheel whiledriving. You could lose control of yourvehicle and cause an accident.

1. To block out glare from the front, swing downthe main sun visor �1 .

2. To block glare from the side, remove the mainsun visor from the center mount and swing itto the side �2 .

3. To use the extension sun visor �3 (if soequipped), pull it out from the main sun visoras shown.

CAUTION

Do not store the main sun visor beforestoring the extension sun visor.SPA2314

SPA2176

STEERING WHEEL SUN VISORS

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-25

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 137: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

INSIDE MIRRORAdjust the height and the angle of the insidemirror to the desired position.

The night position�1 will reduce glare from theheadlights of vehicles behind you at night.

Use the day position�2 when driving in daylighthours.

WARNING

Use the night position only when neces-sary, because it reduces rear view clar-ity.

AUTOMATIC ANTI-GLARE INSIDEMIRROR (if so equipped)

The inside mirror is designed so that it automati-cally changes reflection according to the inten-sity of the headlight of the following vehicle.

When the inside mirror is in the “I” (AUTO)position�1 , excessive glare from the headlightsof the vehicle behind you will be reduced. TheAUTO indicator light �A (green) will be on.When the switch of the inside mirror is in the“�” (OFF) position �2 , the inside mirror willoperate normally.

For HomeLink Universal Transceiver, see the

SPA1792 SPA2143 SPA2157

MIRRORS

3-26 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 138: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

description in the “2. Instruments and controls”section.

OUTSIDE MIRRORS

WARNING

Objects viewed in the outside mirror onthe passenger side are closer than theyappear. Be careful when moving to theright. Using only this mirror could causean accident. Use the inside mirror orglance over your shoulder to properlyjudge distances to other objects.

The outside mirror will operate only when theignition switch is in the ACC or ON position.

Turn the control knob (located on the driver sidedoor armrest) to right or left to select the right orleft outside mirror, then adjust using the knob.

SPA1390

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-27

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 139: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Foldable outside mirrorsFold the outside mirror by pushing it toward therear of the vehicle.

IC0565

3-28 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 140: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

4 Display screen, heater, air conditioner andaudio systems

Safety note .............................................................................. 4-2Control panel buttons — with navigation system.......... 4-2Names of the components ............................................ 4-2How to use joystick and “ENTER” button................. 4-3How to use “BACK” button .......................................... 4-3Setting up the start-up screen ..................................... 4-3How to use “INFO” button ............................................ 4-3How to use “SETTING” button .................................... 4-5How to use the “ ” button.................................... 4-8

Ventilators ............................................................................... 4-8Center ventilators ............................................................ 4-8Side ventilators ................................................................ 4-8

Heater and air conditioner (Automatic) .......................... 4-9Automatic operation .................................................... 4-10Manual operation .......................................................... 4-10Operating tips ............................................................... 4-11

Servicing air conditioner .................................................. 4-12Audio system ....................................................................... 4-12Radio ............................................................................... 4-12FM radio reception ...................................................... 4-13

AM radio reception ...................................................... 4-13Satellite (SAT) radio reception (if so equipped) ... 4-13Audio operation precautions ..................................... 4-14FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) player ...... 4-19FM-AM-SAT radio with compact disc (CD)changer ........................................................................... 4-23CD care and cleaning ................................................. 4-29Steering wheel switch for audio control (if soequipped)......................................................................... 4-29Antenna ........................................................................... 4-30

Car phone or CB radio .................................................... 4-31Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System withNISSAN voice recognition (if so equipped) ............... 4-31Using the system........................................................... 4-33Control buttons .............................................................. 4-35Getting started ............................................................... 4-35List of voice commands............................................... 4-37Speaker adaptation (SA) mode ................................. 4-42Troubleshooting guide.................................................. 4-45

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 141: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

� Do not disassemble or modify thissystem. If you do, it may result inaccidents, fire, or electric shock.

� Do not use this system if you noticeany abnormality, such as a frozenscreen or lack of sound. Continueduse of the system may result in acci-dent, fire or electric shock.

� In case you notice any foreign objectin the system hardware, spill liquidon it, or notice smoke or smell com-ing from it, stop using the systemimmediately and contact a NISSANdealer. Ignoring such conditions maylead to accidents, fire, or electricshock.

When you use this system, make sure the engineis running.

If you use the system with the engine notrunning (ignition ON or ACC) for a longtime, it will use up all the battery power,and the engine will not start.

Reference symbols:

“ENTER” button

This is a button on the control panel.

“Display” key

This is a select key on the screen. By selectingthis key you can proceed to the next function.

NAMES OF THE COMPONENTS1. JOYSTICK and “ENTER” button

2. “INFO” button

3. “SETTING” button

4. “BACK” button

5. “ ” brightness control button

For Navigation System control buttons (otherthan above), refer to the separate NavigationSystem Owner’s Manual.

SAA1289

SAFETY NOTE CONTROL PANEL BUTTONS —WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM

4-2 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 142: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

HOW TO USE JOYSTICK AND“ENTER” BUTTONChoose an item on the display using the joystickand push the ENTER button for operation.

HOW TO USE “BACK” BUTTONThis button has two functions.

To return to the previous screen:

When this button is pushed during setup, setupwill be canceled, and the screen will return to theprevious screen.

To finish the set-up:

When this button is pushed after setup is com-pleted, the settings will be renewed as directed,and the screen will return to the map.

INFO:

When the “BACK” button must be pushed, (forexample, after the setup is finished) instructionsare given in the operation procedure of eachsection in this manual. If the “BACK” button ispushed when not finished with the setup, thesetting will be canceled, and the screen willreturn to the previous screen.

SETTING UP THE START-UPSCREENWhen you turn the ignition key to the ACCposition, the SYSTEM START-UP warning isdisplayed on the screen. Read the warning andselect the “OK” key then push the “ENTER”button.

If you do not push the ENTER button, thissystem will not proceed to the next step display.

To proceed to the next step, refer to the separateNavigation System Owner’s Manual.

HOW TO USE “INFO” BUTTON

When the “INFO” button is pushed, the “Main-tenance” screen will be displayed.

Maintenance information

To set the maintenance interval for the EngineOil or Oil Filter, choose an item using the joystickand push the “ENTER” button.

You can also set to display a message to remindyou that the maintenance needs to be per-formed.

The following example shows how to set theengine oil change interval. Use the same steps

SAA1290

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-3

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 143: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

to set the other maintenance information.

1. Reset the driving distance to the new main-tenance schedule.

2. Set the interval (mileage) of the maintenanceschedule. To determine the recommendedmaintenance interval, refer to your “NISSANService and Maintenance Guide”.

3. To display the MAINTENANCE INFORMA-TION automatically when the set trip distanceis reached, highlight the “Interval Re-minder” key with the joystick and push the“ENTER” button.

4. To return the display to the “Maintenance”screen, push the “BACK” button.

“Maintenance” display cannot be operatedwhen the vehicle is moving. Stop the vehicle in asafe place to see the information.

SAA1291

4-4 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 144: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Maintenance notice

The “Maintenance Notice” screen (“ENGINEOIL” or “OIL FILTER”) will be automaticallydisplayed as shown when both of the followingconditions are met:

� the vehicle is driven the set distance and theignition switch is turned OFF.

� the ignition switch is turned ON the next timethe vehicle will be driven.

To return to the previous display after the“Maintenance Notice” screen is displayed,push the “BACK” button.

The “Maintenance Notice” screen displayseach time the ignition switch is turned ON untilone of the following conditions are met:

� “Reset Distance” is selected.

� “Interval Reminder” is set OFF.

� the maintenance interval is set again.

*: Refer to the separate Navigation SystemOwner’s Manual.

HOW TO USE “SETTING” BUTTONThe “Settings” screen will appear when the“SETTING” button is pushed.

SAA1332 SAA1292Engine Oil �1 /Oil Filter�2

SAA1293

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-5

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 145: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Display settings

The following menu will appear when pushingthe “SETTING” button, selecting “Display” keyand pushing the “ENTER” button.

Display:

To turn off the screen, select the “Display” keyand push the “ENTER” button to turn off the“ON” indicator. When any mode button ispushed with the screen off, the screen turns onfor further operation. The screen will turn offautomatically 5 seconds after the operation isfinished on the map display.

To turn on the screen, select the “Display” key

and turn on the “ON” indicator.

Brightness/Contrast:

To adjust the brightness and contrast of thescreen, select the “Brightness” or “Contrast”key and push the “ENTER” button. Then you canadjust the brightness to darker or brighter andthe contrast to lower or higher using the joystick.

Clock settingsThe following display will appear when pushingthe “SETTING” button, selecting the “Clock”key and pushing the “ENTER” button.

On-screen Clock:

When this item is turned to ON, a clock is alwaysdisplayed in the upper right corner of the screen.

This clock will indicate the time almost exactlybecause it is always adjusted by the GPSsystem.

SAA1540 SAA1091

4-6 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 146: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Clock Format:

Choose either the 12-hour clock display or the24-hour clock display.

Offset Adjust:

Adjust the time by increasing or decreasing perminute.

Daylight Saving Time:

Turn this item to ON for daylight saving timeapplication.

Time Zone:

Choose the time zone from the following

� Pacific

� Mountain

� Central

� Eastern

� Atlantic

� Newfoundland

Language/Units settingsThe Language/Units settings screen will appearwhen selecting the “Language/Units” key andpushing the “ENTER” button.

Select the “Select Language” or “SelectUnits” key and push the “ENTER” button.

Language: “English” or “Français”

Unit: “US” — Mile, °F, MPG“Metric” — km, °C, L/100 km

Select the “ON” key of the desired language orunits and push the “ENTER” button.

SAA1295 SAA1296Display of Select Language

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-7

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 147: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

HOW TO USE THE “ ”BUTTONPush the “ ” (DAY/NIGHT) button to switchthe display brightness to the daytime or night-time mode, and adjust the brightness by movingthe joystick right or left.

If no operation is done within 10 seconds, or ifthe “BACK” button is pushed, the display willreturn to the previous display.

Push the “ ” button for more than 2 sec-onds to turn the display off. Push the buttonagain for more than 2 seconds to turn the displayon.

CENTER VENTILATORSAdjust the air flow direction of ventilators.

Moving the lever up or down will open �A orclose �B the vents.To change the air flow direction, turn the dial�C .

SIDE VENTILATORSAdjust the air flow direction of ventilators by�Aopening,�B closing or�C rotating as illustrated.

SAA0600 SAA0601

VENTILATORS

4-8 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 148: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Air flow control dial

2. Temperature control dial*

* The display of degrees:“60-75-90” is used for °F (US).“18-25-32” is used for °C (Canada).

3. Fan speed control dial

4. Rear window defroster button(See the “2. Instruments and controls” sec-tion.)

5. Air intake button(Air recirculation and Fresh air)

6. A/C (air conditioner) button

WARNING

� The air conditioner cooling functionoperates only when the engine isrunning.

� On hot, sunny days, temperatures ina closed vehicle could quickly be-come high enough to cause severe orpossibly fatal injuries to people oranimals. Do not leave children oradults who would normally require

the assistance of others in your ve-hicle. Unattended pets should alsonot be left alone.

� Do not use the recirculation mode forlong periods as it may cause theinterior air to become stale and thewindows to fog up.

Start the engine and operate the controls toactivate the air conditioner.

NOTE:

In your vehicle, the air conditioner systemis designed to automatically activate thecooling function when operating the airflow control dial, the fan speed control dialor the air intake button. (The indicator lighton the A/C button will illuminate.) Push theA/C button off when the cooling function isnot necessary.

SAA1297

HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER(Automatic)

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-9

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 149: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

AUTOMATIC OPERATION

Cooling and/or dehumidified heating(AUTO)

This mode may be normally used all year roundas the system automatically works to keep aconstant temperature. Air flow distribution andfan speed are also controlled automatically.

1. Turn the fan speed control dial and air flowcontrol dial to the AUTO position. The airconditioner will automatically turn on. (TheA/C button indicator light illuminates.)

2. Turn the temperature control dial to set thedesired temperature.

� Adjust the temperature to about 75°F (24°C)for normal operation.

� The temperature of the passenger compart-ment will be maintained automatically. Airflow distribution and fan speed are also con-trolled automatically.

A visible mist may be seen coming from theventilators in hot, humid conditions as the air iscooled rapidly. This does not indicate a malfunc-tion.

Heating (AUTO; A/C off)The air conditioner does not activate. When you

need to heat only, use this mode.

1. Turn the fan speed control dial and air flowcontrol dial to the AUTO position. (The airconditioner will turn on.)

2. Push the A/C button to turn off the airconditioner. (The A/C button indicator lightwill turn off.)

3. Turn the temperature control dial to set thedesired temperature.

� The temperature of the passenger compart-ment will be maintained automatically. Airflow distribution and fan speed are also con-trolled automatically.

� Do not set the temperature lower than theoutside air temperature. Otherwise the sys-tem may not work properly.

� Not recommended if windows fog up.

Dehumidified defrosting or defogging1. Turn the fan speed control dial to the desiredposition.

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the DEFposition.

3. Turn the temperature control dial to set thedesired temperature.

� To quickly remove ice from the outside of the

windows, turn the fan speed control dial tothe maximum position.

� As soon as possible after the windshield isclean, turn the air flow control dial to theAUTO position to return to the auto mode.

� When the air flow control dial is turned to theor position, the air conditioner

will automatically be turned on at outsidetemperatures above 23°F (−5°C) to defogthe windshield, and the air recirculation modewill automatically be turned off.

Outside air is drawn into the passengercompartment to improve the defogging per-formance.

MANUAL OPERATION

Fan speed controlTurn the fan speed control dial to manuallycontrol the fan speed.

Turn the dial to the AUTO position to return toautomatic control of the fan speed.

Air recirculation/Fresh airEach time the air intake button is pushed, theindicator light on the button will alternate

(Air recirculation) and (Fresh air).

When the indicator light is on, the interior

4-10 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 150: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

air is recirculated. (When the air recirculationmode is selected with the A/C indicator off whilethe fan speed control dial is in the AUTOposition, the air conditioner will turn on.)

When the indicator light is on, the outsideair is drawn into the passenger compartment.

� When the air intake button is pushed forlonger than 1.5 seconds, both indicator lights( and ) will flash twice, and thenthe intake air will be controlled automatically.During this AUTO mode, the indicator light ofthe currently selected mode illuminates.

� When the air flow control dial is in theor position, the air recirculation

mode does not activate.

Air flow controlTurning the air flow control dial selects the airoutlet to:

: Air flows from center and side ventila-tors.

: Air flows from center and side ventila-tors and foot outlets.

: Air flows mainly from foot outlets.

: Air flows from defroster and foot out-lets.

: Air flows mainly from defroster outlets.

To turn the system offTurn the fan speed control dial to the OFFposition.

OPERATING TIPSWhen the engine coolant temperature and out-side air temperature are low, the air flow from thefoot outlets may not operate for a maximum of150 seconds. However, this is not a malfunction.After the coolant temperature warms up, the airflow from the foot outlets will operate normally.

Sensor �A on the instrument panel helps main-tain a constant temperature; do not put anythingon or around this sensor.

SAA0603

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-11

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 151: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The air conditioning system in your NISSANvehicle is charged with a refrigerant designedwith the environment in mind. This refrigerantwill not harm the earth’s ozone layer. How-ever, special charging equipment and lubricantare required when servicing your NISSAN airconditioner. Using improper refrigerants or lubri-cants will cause severe damage to your airconditioning system. See “Capacities and rec-ommended fuel/lubricants” in the “9. Technicaland consumer information” section for air con-ditioning system refrigerant and lubricant recom-mendations.

A NISSAN dealer will be able to service yourenvironmentally friendly air conditioning system.

WARNING

The air conditioner system contains re-frigerant under high pressure. To avoidpersonal injury, any air conditioner ser-vice should be done only by an experi-enced technician with proper equip-ment.

RADIO

Turn the ignition key to ACC or ON and pressthe POWER, FM or AM button to turn on theradio. If you listen to the radio with the engine notrunning, the key should be turned to the ACCposition.

Radio reception is affected by station signalstrength, distance from radio transmitter, build-ings, bridges, mountains and other external in-fluences. Intermittent changes in reception qual-ity normally are caused by these externalinfluences.

Using a cellular phone in or near the ve-hicle may influence radio reception quality.

Radio reception

Your radio system is equipped with state-of-the-art electronic circuits to enhance radio recep-tion. These circuits are designed to extend re-ception range, and to enhance the quality of thatreception.

However there are some general characteristicsof FM, AM and SAT (satellite — if so equipped)radio signals that can affect radio receptionquality in a moving vehicle, even when the finestequipment is used. These characteristics arecompletely normal in a given reception area, and

do not indicate any malfunction in your radiosystem.

Remember that a moving vehicle is not the idealplace to listen to a radio. Because of the move-ment, reception conditions will constantlychange. Buildings, terrain, signal distance andinterference from other vehicles can workagainst ideal reception. Described below aresome of the factors that can affect your radioreception.

Some cellular phones or other devices maycause interference or a buzzing noise to comefrom the audio system speakers. Storing thedevice in a different location may reduce oreliminate the noise.

SERVICING AIR CONDITIONER AUDIO SYSTEM

4-12 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 152: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

FM RADIO RECEPTION

Range: FM range is normally limited to 25 to 30miles (40 to 48 km), with monaural (singlechannel) FM having slightly more range thanstereo FM. External influences may sometimesinterfere with FM station reception even if the FMstation is within 25 miles (40 km). The strengthof the FM signal is directly related to the distancebetween the transmitter and receiver. FM signalsfollow a line-of-sight path, exhibiting many of thesame characteristics as light. For example theywill reflect off objects.

Fade and drift: As your vehicle moves away from

a station transmitter, the signals will tend to fadeand/or drift.

Static and flutter: During signal interference frombuildings, large hills or due to antenna position,usually in conjunction with increased distancefrom the station transmitter, static or flutter canbe heard. This can be reduced by lowering thetreble setting to reduce treble response.

Multipath reception: Because of the reflectivecharacteristics of FM signals, direct and re-flected signals reach the receiver at the sametime. The signals may cancel each other, result-ing in momentary flutter or loss of sound.

AM RADIO RECEPTIONAM signals, because of their low frequency, canbend around objects and skip along the ground.In addition, the signals can be bounced off theionosphere and bent back to earth. Because ofthese characteristics. AM signals are also sub-ject to interference as they travel from transmitterto receiver.

Fading: Occurs while the vehicle is passingthrough freeway underpasses or in areas withmany tall buildings. It can also occur for severalseconds during ionospheric turbulence even inareas where no obstacles exist.

Static: Caused by thunderstorms, electricalpower lines, electric signs and even traffic lights.

SATELLITE (SAT) RADIORECEPTION (if so equipped)When the satellite radio is first installed or thebattery has been replaced, the satellite radiomay not work properly. This is not a malfunction.Wait more than 10 minutes with the satelliteradio ON for the satellite radio to receive all ofthe necessary data.

No satellite radio reception is available when theSAT band option is selected unless optionalsatellite receiver and antenna are installed, andan XM® satellite radio service subscription isactive.

Satellite radio performance may be affected ifcargo carried on the roof blocks the satelliteradio signal.

If possible, do not put cargo over the satelliteantenna.

A buildup of ice on the satellite radio antennacan affect satellite radio performance. Removethe ice to restore satellite radio reception.

Satellite radio is not available in Alaska andHawaii.

SAA0306

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-13

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 153: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

AUDIO OPERATION PRECAUTIONS

Compact Disc (CD) player

CAUTION

� Do not force a compact disc into theCD insert slot. This could damage theCD and/or CD changer/player.

� Trying to load a CD with the CD doorclosed could damage the CD and/orCD changer.

� During cold weather or rainy days, theplayer may malfunction due to the hu-midity. If this occurs, remove the CD anddehumidify or ventilate the player com-pletely.

� The player may skip while driving onrough roads.

� The CD player sometimes cannot func-tion when the passenger compartmenttemperature is extremely high. De-crease the temperature before use.

� Only use high quality 4.7 in (12 cm)round discs that have the “COMPACTdisc DIGITAL AUDIO” logo on the disc orpackaging.

� Do not expose the CD to direct sunlight.

� CDs that are of poor quality, dirty,scratched, covered with fingerprints, orthat have pin holes may not work prop-erly.

� The following CDs may not work prop-erly:

� Copy control compact discs (CCCD)

� Recordable compact discs (CD-R)

� Rewritable compact discs (CD-RW)

� Do not use the following CDs as theymay cause the CD player to malfunction.

� 3.1 in (8 cm) discs

� CDs that are not round

� CDs with a paper label

� CDs that are warped, scratched, orhave abnormal edges

� This audio system can only play prere-corded CDs. CDs with MP3 or WMAformat cannot be written in this audiosystem.

� If the CD cannot be played, one of thefollowing messages will be displayed.

SAA0480

4-14 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 154: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CHECK DISC:

� Confirm that the CD is inserted cor-rectly (the label side is facing up,etc.).

� Confirm that the CD is not bent orwarped and it is free of scratches.

PUSH EJECT:

This is a malfunction due to excessivetemperature inside the player. Removethe CD by pushing the EJECT button.After a short time, reinsert the CD. TheCD can be played when the temperatureof the player returns to normal.

UNPLAYABLE:

The file is unplayable in this audio sys-tem (only MP3 or WMA CD in the audiosystem with a CD changer).

Compact Disc (CD) with MP3 orWMA (for the audio system with a6CD changer)Explanation of terms:

� MP3 — MP3 is short for Moving PicturesExperts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is themost well-known compressed digital audiofile format. This format allows for near “CDquality” sound, but at a fraction of the size of

normal audio files. MP3 conversion of anaudio track from CD-ROM can reduce the filesize by approximately 10:1 ratio (Sampling:44.1 kHz, Bit rate: 128 kbps) with virtually noperceptible loss in quality. MP3 compressionremoves the redundant and irrelevant parts ofa sound signal that the human ear doesn’thear.

� WMA — Windows Media Audio (WMA) is acompressed audio format created by Mi-crosoft as an alternative to MP3. The WMAcodec offers greater file compression thanthe MP3 codec, enabling storage of moredigital audio tracks in the same amount ofspace when compared to MP3s at the samelevel of quality.

� Bit rate — Bit rate denotes the number of bitsper second used by a digital music file. Thesize and quality of a compressed digital audiofile is determined by the bit rate used whenencoding the file.

� Sampling frequency — Sampling frequency isthe rate at which the samples of a signal areconverted from analog to digital (A/D conver-sion) per second.

� Multisession — Multisession is one of themethods for writing data to media. Writingdata once to the media is called a single

session, and writing more than once is calleda multisession.

� ID3/WMA Tag — The ID3/WMA tag is thepart of the encoded MP3 or WMA file thatcontains information about the digital musicfile such as song title, artist, album title,encoding bit rate, track time duration, etc.ID3 tag information is displayed on theAlbum/Artist/Track title line on the display.

* Windows and Windows Media are eitherregistered trademarks and trademarks of Mi-crosoft Corporation in the United Statesand/or other countries.

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-15

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 155: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Playback order:

Playback order of the CD with compressed files(MP3/WMA) is as illustrated above.

� The names of folders not containingMP3/WMA files are not shown in the display.

� If there is a file in the top level of the disc,“ROOT” is displayed.

� The playback order is the order in which thefiles were written by the writing software.Therefore, the files might not play in thedesired order.

SAA1025

4-16 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 156: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Specification chart:

Supported media CD, CD-R, CD-RW

Supported file systemsISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Romeo, Joliet* ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not sup-ported.

Supported ver-sions*1

MP3

Version MPEG1, MPEG2, MPEG2.5

Sampling frequency 8 kHz - 48 kHz

Bit rate 8 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR

WMA

Version WMA7, WMA8, WMA9

Sampling frequency 32 kHz - 48 kHz

Bit rate 48 kbps - 192 kbps, VBR

Tag information (Song title and Artist name)ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3 (MP3only)

Folder levelsFolder levels: 8, Folders: 255 (including root folder),Files: 512 (Max. 255 files for one folder)

Text character number limitation 128 characters

Displayable character codes*2

01: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE(UTF-16 BOM Big Endian), 04: UNICODE (UTF-16Non-BOM Big Endian), 05: UNICODE (UTF-8), 06:UNICODE (Non-UTF-16 BOM Little Endian)

*1 Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot beplayed.

*2 Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed.

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-17

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 157: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Troubleshooting guide:

Symptom Cause and Countermeasure

Cannot play

Check if the disc was inserted correctly.

Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.

Check if there is condensation inside the player. If there is, wait until the condensation is gone (about 1 hour) before using theplayer.

If there is a temperature increase error, the CD player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature.

If there is a mixture of music CD files (CD-DA data) and MP3/WMA files on a CD, only the music CD files (CD-DA data) will beplayed.

Files with extensions other than “.MP3”, “.WMA”, “.mp3” or “.wma” cannot be played. In addition, the character codes and num-ber of characters for folder names and file names should be in compliance with the specifications.

Check if the disc or the file is generated in an irregular format. This may occur depending on the variation or the setting ofMP3/WMA writing applications or other text editing applications.

Check if the finalization process, such as session close and disc close, is done for the disc.

Check if the disc is protected by copyright.

Poor sound qualityCheck if the disc is scratched or dirty.

Bit rate may be too low.

It takes a relatively long time be-fore the music starts playing.

If there are many folder or file levels on the MP3/WMA disc, or if it is a multisession disc, some time may be required before themusic starts playing.

Music cuts off or skipsThe writing software and hardware combination might not match, or the writing speed, writing depth, writing width, etc., might notmatch the specifications. Try using the slowest writing speed.

Skipping with high bit rate files Skipping may occur with large quantities of data, such as for high bit rate data.

Move immediately to the next songwhen playing.

When a non-MP3/WMA file has been given an extension of “.MP3”, “.WMA”, “.mp3” or “.wma”, or when play is prohibited bycopyright protection, there will be approximately 5 seconds of no sound and then the player will skip to the next song.

The songs do not play back in thedesired order.

The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in thedesired order.

4-18 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 158: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

FM-AM RADIO WITH COMPACTDISC (CD) PLAYER

1. MUTE button2. SEEK/APS REW, APS FF/TRACKCHANGE button

3. DISP (Display) CHANGE button4. SCAN tuning button5. CD play button6. RADIO (FM/AM) band select button7. MIX play button

8. RPT (Repeat) play button9. CD EJECT button10. TUNE/FF⋅REW button11. ON⋅OFF/VOL (Volume) control knob12. Audio/Clock display13. Station and preset select button14. AUDIO button

Audio main operation

For all operation precautions, see “Audio opera-tion precautions” earlier in this section.

ON⋅OFF/Volume control:

Turn the ignition key to ACC or ON, and thenpush the ON⋅OFF/VOL (Volume) control knobwhile the system is off to call up the mode (radioor CD) which was playing immediately beforethe system was turned off. When no CD isloaded, the radio will come on. While the systemis on, pushing the ON⋅OFF/VOL control knobturns the system off.

Turn the ON⋅OFF/VOL control knob to adjustthe volume.

AUDIO button (BASS, TREBLE, FADER,BALANCE):

Press the AUDIO button to change the selectingmode as follows.

SAA1298

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-19

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 159: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

BASS → TREBLE → FADE → BALANCE

To adjust Bass, Treble, Fader and Balance, pushthe AUDIO button until the desired mode(BASS, TREBLE, FADER or BALANCE) ap-pears in the display. Push the TUNE( , ) or SEEK ( , ) buttonto adjust Bass and Treble to the desired level.Use the TUNE or SEEK button also to adjustFader or Balance modes. Fader adjusts thesound level between the front and rear speakersand Balance adjusts the sound between theright and left speakers.

After 10 seconds, the radio or CD displayreappears. Once the sound quality is set to thedesired level, push the AUDIO button repeatedlyuntil the radio or CD display appears.

MUTE button:

Push the MUTE button to mute the audio sound.Push the MUTE button again to release themute.

DISP DISPLAY CHANGE:

Push the DISP button for more than 1.5 secondsto adjust the digital clock display. See “Clock” inthe “2. Instruments and controls” section for theclock adjustment operation.

When the DISP button is pushed for less than1.5 seconds while the compact disc is being

played, the display will show the CD play time.

FM-AM radio operationRADIO (FM/AM) band select:

Pushing the RADIO band select button willchange the band as follows:

AM → FM1 → FM2 → AM

When RADIO band select button is pushedwhile the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON, theradio will come on at the station last played.

The last station played will also come on whenthe power knob is turned to ON.

If a compact disc is playing when the RADIOband select button is pushed, the compact discwill automatically be turned off and the last radiostation played will come on.

The FM stereo indicator ST will glow during FMstereo reception. When the stereo broadcastsignal is weak, the radio will automaticallychange from stereo to monaural reception.

TUNE (Tuning) :

Push the TUNE button or for manualtuning. To move quickly through the channels,push and hold either side of the TUNE buttondown for more than 0.5 second.

SEEK tuning:

Push the SEEK button or to tunefrom high to low or low to high frequencies andstops at the next broadcasting station.

SCAN tuning:

Push the SCAN tuning button to tune from lowto high frequencies and stops at each broad-casting station for 5 seconds. Pushing the but-ton again during this 5 second period will stopSCAN tuning and the radio will remain tuned tothat station.

If the SCAN tuning button is not pushed within 5seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next sta-tion.

Station memory operations:

Twelve stations can be set for the FM band (sixfor FM1, six for FM2) and six stations can be setfor the AM band.

1. Tune to the desired station using the SEEK,SCAN or TUNE button.

2. Select the desired station and keep pushingany of the desired station select buttons (1 to6) until a beep sound is heard. (The radiomutes when the select button is pushed.)

3. The channel indicator will then come on and

4-20 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 160: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

the sound will resume. Memorizing is nowcomplete.

4. Other buttons can be set in the same manner.

If the battery cable is disconnected, or ifthe fuse blows, the radio memory will beerased. In that case, reset the desired sta-tions.

Compact disc (CD) player operation

Turn the ignition key to the ACC or ON positionand insert the compact disc into the slot with thelabel side facing up. The compact disc will beguided automatically into the slot and start play-ing.After loading the disc, the number of tracks onthe disc will appear on the display.If the radio is already operating, it will automati-cally turn off and the compact disc will play.

If the system has been turned off while thecompact disc was playing, pushing theON⋅OFF/VOL control knob will start the com-pact disc.

3.1 in (8 cm) diameter compact discs can alsobe used without an adapter.

CD PLAY:

When the CD (CD play) button is pushed withthe system off and the compact disc loaded, the

system will turn on and the compact disc willstart to play.

When the CD button is pushed with the com-pact disc loaded but the radio playing, the radiowill automatically be turned off and the compactdisc will start to play.

DISP CD PLAY TIME:

Push the DISP button for less than 1.5 secondswhile the compact disc is being played to showthe play time on the display.

FF (Fast Forward), REW(Rewind):

When the (fast forward) or (rewind)button is pushed while the compact disc isbeing played, the compact disc will play whilefast forwarding or rewinding. When the button isreleased, the compact disc will return to normalplay speed.

APS (Automatic ProgramSearch) FF, APS REW/TRACK CHANGE:

When the (APS FF) button is pushedwhile the compact disc is being played, theprogram next to the present one will start to playfrom its beginning. Push several times to skipthrough programs. The compact disc will ad-vance the number of times the button is pushed.

(When the last program on the compact disc isskipped through, the first program will beplayed.) When the (APS REW) button ispushed, the program being played returns to itsbeginning. Push several times to skip backthrough programs. The compact disc will goback the number of times the button is pushed.

SCAN tuning:

When the SCAN tuning button is pushed whilethe CD is being played, the beginning of all thetracks of CD will be played for 10 seconds insequence.

Pushing the button again during this 10 secondperiod will stop SCAN tuning. If the SCANtuning button is not pushed within 10 seconds,SCAN tuning moves to the next CD program.

MIX MIX play:

When the MIX button is pushed while the com-pact disc is being played, programs will beplayed at random, not following the sequence onthe compact disc. The same program may berepeated twice. Push the MIX button again toreturn to the normal play mode.

REPEAT (RPT) play:

When the RPT button is pushed while thecompact disc is being played, the play patterncan be changed as follows:

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-21

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 161: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The display shows the following symbol; (nomark): 1 CD RPT (Repeat)

1: 1 TR (Track) RPT

CD EJECT:

When the CD EJECT button is pushed with thecompact disc loaded, the compact disc will beejected.

When this button is pushed while the compactdisc is being played, the compact disc will comeout and the system will turn off.

If the compact disc comes out and is notremoved, it will be pulled back into the slotto protect it. (except for 3.1 in [8 cm] diam-eter compact discs)

If the following message appears on the display,push the EJECT button:

� CHECK DISC — Eject the disc, and checkwhether it is damaged orinserted upside-down.

� CD ERR F * — Eject the disc, and checkwhether it is a proper audioCD. (* shows a differentnumber according to the au-dio condition.)

CD IN indicator:

CD IN indicator appears on the display when theCD is loaded.

4-22 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 162: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

FM-AM-SAT RADIO WITHCOMPACT DISC (CD) CHANGER1. CD LOAD button2. SEEK/APS REW, APS FF/TRACKCHANGE button

3. DISP (Display) CHANGE button4. SCAN tuning button5. CD PLAY button6. RADIO (FM/AM/SAT*) band select button7. PTY (Program type), CAT (Category)* selectbutton

8. RPT (Repeat) play/CLOCK button9. CD EJECT button10. TUNE/FF⋅REW button11. ON⋅OFF/VOL (Volume) control knob12. Audio/Clock display13. Station and preset (FM/AM/SAT*)/CD in-sert or CD play select button

14. AUDIO button

* No satellite radio reception is available whenthe SAT band option is selected unless op-tional satellite receiver and antenna are in-stalled, and an XM® satellite radio servicesubscription is active.

It may take some time to receive the activationsignal after subscribing to the XM satelliteradio provider. After receiving the activationsignal, an available channel list will be auto-matically updated in the radio. Turn the ignitionswitch from the LOCK to ACC position toupdate the channel list.

Satellite radio is not available in Alaska andHawaii.

Audio main operationFor all operation precautions, see “Audio opera-tion precautions” earlier in this section.

Head unit:

The auto loudness circuit enhances the low

SAA1299

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-23

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 163: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

frequency range automatically in both radio re-ception and CD playback.

This audio system has an active noise compen-sation feature called “Audio Pilot”. The AudioPilot uses a microphone to detect external roadnoise and automatically adjusts the amplifier tocompensate for any competing high, midrange,or low frequency noise.

ON⋅OFF/Volume control:

Turn the ignition key to ACC or ON, and thenpush the ON⋅OFF/VOL (Volume) control knobwhile the system is off to call up the mode (radioor CD) which was playing immediately beforethe system was turned off. When no CD isloaded, the radio will come on. While the systemis on, pushing the ON⋅OFF/VOL control knobturns the system off.

Turn the ON⋅OFF/VOL control knob to adjustthe volume.

AUDIO button:

Push the AUDIO button to change the selectingmode as follows.

BASS → TREBLE → FADE → BALANCE →AUDIOP

To adjust Bass, Treble, Fader and Balance, pushthe AUDIO button until the desired mode(BASS, TREBLE, FADER or BALANCE) ap-

pears in the display. Push the TUNE( , ) or SEEK ( , ) buttonto adjust Bass and Treble to the desired level.Use the TUNE or SEEK button also to adjustFader or Balance modes. Fader adjusts thesound level between the front and rear speakersand Balance adjusts the sound between theright and left speakers.

To change the AUDIOP (Audio Pilot) mode toOFF or ON, push the TUNE or SEEK button.

Once you have adjusted the sound quality to thedesired level, push the AUDIO button repeatedlyuntil the radio or CD display reappears. Other-wise, the radio or CD display will automaticallyreappear after about 10 seconds.

CLOCK adjusting:

Push the RPT button for more than 1.5 secondsto adjust the digital clock display.

When the clock adjusting display is selected, thetime (hour or minute) will start flashing. See“Clock” in the “2. Instruments and controls”section for the detailed clock adjustment opera-tion.

DISP DISPLAY CHANGE:

This button will work during satellite radio (if soequipped) and CD operation. Find the detailedfunction in the description of each item.

FM-AM-SAT radio operation

RADIO (FM/AM/SAT) band select:

Pushing the RADIO band select button willchange the band as follows:

(Without satellite radio)

AM → FM1 → FM2 → AM

(With satellite radio)

AM → FM1 → FM2 → SAT → AM

No satellite operation is available during scrollingof modes, unless optional satellite receiver andantenna are installed, and an XM satellite radioservice subscription is active.

When RADIO band select button is pushedwhile the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON, theradio will come on at the station last played.

The last station/channel played will also come onwhen the ON⋅OFF/VOL control knob is pushedto ON.

If a compact disc is playing when the RADIOband select button is turned to ON, the compactdisc will automatically be turned off and the lastradio station/channel played will come on.

The FM stereo indicator ST will glow during FMstereo reception. When the stereo broadcastsignal is weak, the radio will automatically

4-24 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 164: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

change from stereo to monaural reception.

If the satellite radio signal is lost due to interfer-ence while driving, in a parking structure ortunnel for example, “NO SIGNAL” will be dis-played and no satellite radio station will beavailable.

TUNE (Tuning):

Push the TUNE button or for manualtuning. To move quickly through the channels,push and hold either side of the TUNE buttondown for more than 0.5 second.

SEEK tuning:

(For FM and AM radio)

Push the SEEK button or to tunefrom high to low or low to high frequencies andstops at the next broadcasting station.

(For satellite radio)

Push the SEEK button or to seekchannels of the next or previous category.

SCAN tuning:

Push the SCAN tuning button to tune from lowto high frequencies and stops at each broad-casting station for 5 seconds. Pushing the but-ton again during this 5 second period will stopSCAN tuning and the radio will remain tuned tothat station.

If the SCAN tuning button is not pushed within 5seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next sta-tion.

DISP SAT radio display change (if soequipped):

� Pushing the DISP button will display addi-tional information (for example: Title, Artistname) about the satellite radio broadcast.

� Pushing the DISP button for more than 1.5seconds will change the display mode asfollows:

Channel number → Channel name → Artistname → Song title → Channel number

Station memory operations:

Twelve stations/channels can be set for the FMband (6 for FM1, 6 for FM2) and the SAT radio(6 for SAT1, 6 for SAT2), and 6 stations can beset for the AM band.

1. Tune to the desired station/channel using theSEEK, SCAN or TUNE button.

2. Select the desired station/channel and keeppushing any of the desired station/channeland preset buttons (1 to 6) until a beepsound is heard. (The radio mutes when thestation and preset button is pushed.)

3. The channel indicator will then come on and

the sound will resume. Memorizing is nowcomplete.

4. Other buttons can be set in the same manner.

If the battery cable is disconnected, or ifthe fuse blows, the radio memory will beerased. In that case, reset the desired sta-tions.

Radio data system (RDS):

RDS stands for Radio Data System, and is adata information service transmitted by someradio stations on the FM band (not AM band)and/or SAT encoded within a regular radiobroadcast. Currently, most RDS stations are inlarge cities, but many stations are now consid-ering broadcasting RDS data.

RDS can display:

� Station call sign, such as “WHFR 98.3”.

� Station name, such as “The Groove”.

� Music or programming type such as “Classi-cal”, “Country”, or “Rock”.

� Traffic reports about delays or construction.

If the station broadcasts RDS information, theRDS icon is displayed.

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-25

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 165: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Program type (PTY)/Category(CAT) select:

When PTY button is pushed during FM mode,the PTY (CAT) name of the current tuned stationis displayed. When the PTY (CAT) button ispushed during satellite radio mode (if soequipped), the category name of the currentchannel is displayed. During this time if the PTYdata code is zero, or the data is unreadable, thedisplay will show “NONE”.

1. PTY (CAT) selection mode

PTY (CAT) name selection can be done bythe up/down TUNE button or inthe PTY (CAT) selection mode.

It is possible to shift the PTY (CAT) name byone step, with one push of the up/downTUNE button or .

After selecting a PTY (CAT) name, push theSEEK button or SCAN button within 10seconds. Tuning to the PTY (CAT) station willstart. If you do not push the TUNE buttonwithin the 10 second period, the PTY (CAT)mode will be cancelled.

PTY (CAT) name selection can also beachieved by pushing the preset buttons.

Initial PTY (CAT) names are stored in thepreset buttons, but these can be changed by

pushing the preset buttons for more than 1.5seconds when the desired PTY (CAT) nameis in the display.

2. PTY (CAT) SEEK tuning mode

After selecting a PTY (CAT) name, push theSEEK button or within 10 sec-onds. Tuning to the PTY (CAT) station willstart. If you do not push the SEEK buttonwithin the 10 second period, the PTY (CAT)mode will be cancelled.

3. PTY (CAT) SCAN tuning mode

Push the SCAN tuning button to tune thePTY (CAT) name station, and stop at eachbroadcasting station for 5 seconds. Pushingthe button again during this 5 second periodwill stop SCAN tuning and the radio willremain tuned to that station. If the SCANtuning button is not pushed within 5 seconds,SCAN tuning moves to the next station.

Compact disc (CD) changeroperation

Turn the ignition key to the ACC or ON position,push the LOAD button and insert the compactdisc into the slot with the label side facing up.The compact disc will be guided automaticallyinto the slot and start playing.After loading the disc, the number of tracks onthe disc will appear on the display.If the radio is already operating, it will automati-cally turn off and the compact disc will play.

CAUTION

Do not use 3.1 in (8 cm) discs.

If the system has been turned off while thecompact disc was playing, pushing the

4-26 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 166: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

ON⋅OFF/VOL control knob will start the com-pact disc.

CD LOAD:

To insert a CD in the CD changer, push theLOAD button for less than 1.5 seconds. Selectthe loading slot by pushing the CD insert selectbutton (1 to 6), then insert the CD.

To insert 6 CDs to the CD changer in succes-sion, push the LOAD button for more than 1.5seconds.

The inserted slot numbers will illuminate on thedisplay.

CD PLAY:

When the (CD play) button is pushed withthe system off and the compact disc loaded, thesystem will turn on and the compact disc willstart to play.

When the button is pushed with the com-pact disc loaded but the tape or the radioplaying, the tape or radio will automatically beturned off and the compact disc will start to play.

DISP CD PLAY INFORMATION:

When the DISP button is pushed for less than1.5 seconds while the compact disc is beingplayed, the play time will be displayed.

When the DISP button is pushed for more than

1.5 seconds while the CD is being played, thedisc information display will change.

CD:

CD with MP3 or WMA:

FF (Fast Forward), REW(Rewind):

CD:

When the (fast forward) or (rewind)button is pushed while the compact disc isbeing played, the compact disc will play whilefast forwarding or rewinding. When the button isreleased, the compact disc will return to normalplay speed.

CD with MP3 or WMA:

When the or button is pushed forless than 1.5 seconds while the compact disc isbeing played, the folders in the compact disc willchange.

When the or button is pushed formore than 1.5 seconds while the compact discis being played, the compact disc will play while

forwarding or rewinding. When the button isreleased, the compact disc will return to thenormal play speed.

APS (Automatic ProgramSearch) FF, APS REW:

When the (APS FF) button is pushedwhile the compact disc is being played, theprogram next to the present one will start to playfrom its beginning. Push several times to skipthrough programs. The compact disc will ad-vance the number of times the button is pushed.(When the last program on the compact disc isskipped through, the first program will beplayed.) When the (APS REW) button ispushed, the program being played returns to itsbeginning. Push several times to skip backthrough programs. The compact disc will goback the number of times the button is pushed.

CD PLAY select button:

To change CD, push the CD play select button(1 to 6).

SCAN tuning:

When the SCAN tuning button is pushed forless than 1.5 seconds while the CD is beingplayed, the beginning of all the tracks of CDs willbe played for 10 seconds in sequence.

When the SCAN tuning button is pushed formore than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-27

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 167: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

played, the first program in all the CDs will beplayed for 10 seconds.

Pushing the button again during this 10 secondperiod will stop SCAN tuning.

If the SCAN tuning button is not pushed within10 seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the nextdisc program.

REPEAT (RPT):

When the RPT play button is pushed while thecompact disc is played, the play pattern can bechanged.

CD:

CD with MP3 or WMA:

The display shows the following symbols.

(no mark): ALL CD RPT (Repeat)

1 DISC: 1 CD RPT

1: 1 TR (Track) RPT or 1 FLDR (Folder) RPT

MIX: ALL CD MIX

1 DISC MIX: 1 CD MIX

1 MIX: 1 FLDR MIX

CD EJECT:

When the CD EJECT button is pushed with thecompact disc loaded, the compact disc will beejected.

To eject the discs selected by the CD selectbutton, push the EJECT button for less than 1.5seconds.

To eject all the discs in succession, push theEJECT button for more than 1.5 seconds.

When this button is pushed while the compactdisc is being played, the compact disc will comeout and the system will turn off.

If the compact disc comes out and is notremoved, it will be pulled back into the slotto protect it.

If either of the following messages appear on thedisplay, push the EJECT button:

� PUSH EJECT — Eject the disc, and insert itagain.

� CHECK DISC — Eject the disc, and checkwhether it is damaged orinserted upside-down.

� CD ERR F * — Eject the disc, and checkwhether it is a proper audioCD. (* shows a differentnumber according to the au-dio condition.)

CD IN indicator:

CD IN indicator (inserted slot number 1 - 6)appears on the display when the CD is loaded.

4-28 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 168: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CD CARE AND CLEANING

� Handle a CD by its edges. Never touch thesurface of the disc. Do not bend the disc.

� Always place the discs in the storage casewhen they are not being used.

� To clean a disc, wipe the surface from thecenter to the outer edge using a clean, softcloth. Do not wipe the disc using a circularmotion.Do not use a conventional record cleaner oralcohol intended for industrial use.

� A new disc may be rough on its inner andouter edges. Remove the rough edges usingthe side of a pen or pencil as illustrated.

1. VOLUME control switch2. MODE select switch3. POWER on/off switch4. Tuning switch5. POWER on/MODE select switch

STEERING WHEEL SWITCH FORAUDIO CONTROL (if so equipped)The audio system can be operated using thecontrols on the steering wheel.

POWER on/off switch (for Type A)With the ignition switch turned to the ACC orON position, push the POWER on/off switch toturn the audio system on or off.

POWER on/MODE select switch(for Type B)With the ignition switch turned to the ACC orON position, push the POWER on/MODE se-lect switch to turn the audio system on. Push theswitch to change the mode in the sequence ofAM, FM1, FM2, SAT (if so equipped) and CD.

MODE select switch (for Type A)Push the MODE select switch to change themode.

SAA0451 SAA1300Type A

SAA1698Type B

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-29

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 169: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Without satellite radio:

AM, FM1, FM2 and CD or CD changer

With satellite radio:

AM, FM1, FM2, SAT and CD changer

VOLUME control switchesPush up or down the VOLUME control switch toincrease or decrease the volume.

Tuning switchMemory change (radio):

Push up or down the tuning switch for less than1.5 seconds to change the radio frequency.

SEEK tuning (radio):

Push up or down the tuning switch for more than1.5 seconds to seek the next or previous radiostation.

APS (Automatic Program Search) FF,APS REW (CD or CD changer):

Push up or down the tuning switch for less than1.5 seconds to return to the beginning of thepresent program or skip to the next program.Push several times to skip back or skip throughprograms.

This system searches for the blank intervalsbetween selections. If there is a blank interval

within one program or there is no interval be-tween programs, the system may not stop in thedesired or expected location.

FOLDER change (CD changer/CD withMP3 or WMA):

Push up or down the tuning switch for more than1.5 seconds to change the folders (if there areany folders).

DISC change (CD changer/CD withoutMP3 or WMA):

Push up or down the tuning switch for more than1.5 seconds to change the playing disc up ordown.

ANTENNAThe antenna is located at the rear of the vehicle.To remove the antenna, turn it counterclockwise.To reinstall it, screw it securely into the base.

CAUTION

Be sure to remove the antenna beforeentering a low-roof garage or an auto-matic car wash. Otherwise the antennamay be damaged.

SAA0606

4-30 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 170: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

When installing a CB, ham radio or car phone inyour NISSAN vehicle, be sure to observe thefollowing cautions, otherwise the new equip-ment may adversely affect the Engine Controlsystem and other electronic parts.

WARNING

� A cellular telephone should not beused while driving so full attentionmay be given to vehicle operation.Some jurisdictions prohibit the useof cellular telephones while driving.

� If you must make a call while yourvehicle is in motion, the hands freecellular phone operational mode (ifso equipped) is highly recommended.Exercise extreme caution at all timesso full attention may be given tovehicle operation.

� If a conversation in a moving vehiclerequires you to take notes, pull offthe road to a safe location and stopyour vehicle before doing so.

CAUTION

� Keep the antenna as far away aspossible from the electronic controlmodules.

� Keep the antenna wire more than 8 in(20 cm) away from the electronic con-trol system harnesses. Do not routethe antenna wire next to any harness.

� Adjust the antenna standing-waveratio as recommended by the manu-facturer.

� Connect the ground wire from the CBradio chassis to the body.

� For details, consult a NISSAN dealer.

WARNING

� Use a phone after stopping your ve-hicle in a safe location. If you have touse a phone while driving, exerciseextreme caution at all times so fullattention may be given to vehicleoperation.

� If you find yourself unable to devotefull attention to vehicle operationwhile talking on the phone, pull offthe road to a safe location and stopyour vehicle before doing so.

CAUTION

To avoid draining the vehicle battery,use a phone after starting the engine.

CAR PHONE OR CB RADIOBLUETOOTH HANDS-FREEPHONE SYSTEM WITH NISSANVOICE RECOGNITION (if soequipped)

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-31

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 171: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Volume control switch −/+

2. PHONE SEND button

3. PHONE END button

4. Indicator light

5. Microphone

Your vehicle is equipped with the BluetoothHands-Free Phone System. If you are an ownerof a Bluetooth enabled cellular phone, you canset up the wireless connection between yourcellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module.With Bluetooth wireless technology, you canmake or receive a hands-free telephone call withyour cellular phone in the vehicle.

Once your cellular phone is paired to the in-vehicle phone module, no other phone connect-ing procedure is required. Your phone is auto-matically connected with the in-vehicle phonemodule when the ignition switch is turned to theON position with the paired cellular phoneturned on and carried in the vehicle.

You can register up to 5 different Bluetoothcellular phones to the in-vehicle phone module.However, you can talk on only one cellular phoneat a time.

Before using the Bluetooth Hands-Free PhoneSystem, refer to the following notes.

� Set up the wireless connection between a

cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone mod-ule before using the Bluetooth Hands-FreePhone System.

� Some Bluetooth enabled cellular phonesmay not be recognized by the in-vehiclephone module. Please visitwww.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for a recom-mended phone list.

� You will not be able to use a hands-freephone under the following conditions:

— Your vehicle is outside of the telephoneservice area.

— Your vehicle is in an area where it isdifficult to receive radio waves; such as ina tunnel, in an underground parking ga-rage, near a tall building or in a mountain-ous area.

— Your cellular phone is locked to prevent itfrom being dialed.

When the radio wave condition is not ideal orambient sound is too loud, it may be difficult tohear the other person’s voice during a call.

Do not place the cellular phone in an areasurrounded by metal or far away from the in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone qualitydegradation and wireless connection disruption.

While a cellular phone is connected through the

SAA1699

4-32 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 172: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Bluetooth wireless connection, the batterypower of the cellular phone may dischargequicker than usual.

If the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone Systemseems to be malfunctioning, see “Troubleshoot-ing guide” later in this section. You can also visitwww.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for troubleshoot-ing help.

Some cellular phones or other devices maycause interference or a buzzing noise to comefrom the audio system speakers. Storing thedevice in a different location may reduce oreliminate the noise.

Refer to the cellular phone Owner’s Manualregarding the telephone charges, cellular phoneantenna and body, etc.

This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) this devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept any interferencereceived, including interference that maycause undesired operation.

FCC Radiation Exposure Statement:

This equipment complies with FCC radiationexposure limits set forth for an uncontrolledenvironment. This equipment should be installedand operated with minimum distance 8 in (20

cm) between the radiator and your body. ThisTransmitter must not be co-located or operatingin conjunction with any other antenna or trans-mitter.

USING THE SYSTEM

The NISSAN Voice Recognition system allowshands-free operation of the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System.

If the vehicle is in motion, some commands maynot be available so full attention may be given tovehicle operation.

Initialization

When the ignition switch is turned to the ONposition, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initial-ized, which takes a few seconds. When com-pleted, the amber light on the overhead consoleilluminates and the system is ready to acceptvoice commands. If the button is pushedbefore the initialization completes, the systemwill announce “Hands-free phone system notready” and will not react to voice commands.

Operating tipsTo get the best performance out of the NISSANVoice Recognition system, observe the follow-ing:

� Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as

possible. Close the windows to eliminatesurrounding noises (traffic noises, vibrationsounds, etc.), which may prevent the systemfrom recognizing voice commands correctly.

� Wait until the tone sounds before speaking acommand. Otherwise, the command will not bereceived properly.

� Start speaking a command within 5 secondsafter the tone sounds.

� Speak in a natural voice without pausingbetween words.

Giving voice commands

To operate NISSAN Voice Recognition, pushand release the button located on thesteering wheel. The light on the overhead con-sole flashes to signal you have entered a voicerecognition (VR) session. After the tone sounds,speak a command.

The command given is picked up by the micro-phone, and voice feedback is given when thecommand is accepted.

� If you need to hear the available commandsfor the current menu again, say “Help” andthe system will repeat them.

� If a command is not recognized, the systemannounces, “Command not recognized.

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-33

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 173: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Please try again.” Repeat the command in aclear voice.

� If you want to go back to the previouscommand, you can say “Go back” or “Cor-rection” anytime the system is waiting for aresponse.

� You can cancel a command when the systemis waiting for a response by saying, “Cancel”or “Quit.” The system announces “Cancel”and ends the VR session. You can also pushthe button on the steering wheel at anytime. Whenever the VR session is cancelled,a double beep is played to indicate you haveexited the system.

� If you want to adjust the volume of the voicefeedback, push the volume control switch (+or −) on the steering wheel while beingprovided with feedback. You can also use theradio volume control knob.

How to say numbers

NISSAN Voice Recognition requires a certainway to speak numbers in voice commands. Referto the rules and examples below.

� Either “zero” or “oh” can be used for “0”.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

— “One eight oh oh six six two six two ohoh”, or

— “One eight zero zero six six two six two ohoh”

� Words can be used for the first 4 digitsplaces only.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

— “One eight hundred six six two six two ohoh”,

— NOT “One eight hundred six six two sixtytwo hundred, and

— NOT “One eight oh oh six six two sixty twohundred.

� Numbers can be spoken in small groups. Thesystem will prompt you to continuing enteringdigits, if desired.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

— “One eight oh oh”

The system repeats the numbers andprompts you to enter more.

— “six six two”

The system repeats the numbers andprompts you to enter more.

— “six two oh oh”

� You can say “Star” for * and “Pound” for # atanytime in any position of the phone number.

Example: 1-555-1212 *123

— “One five five five one two one two starone two three”

NOTE:

For best results, say phone numbers assingle digits.

4-34 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 174: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CONTROL BUTTONS

The control buttons for the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System are located on the steeringwheel.

TALK/PHONE SEND

Push the button to initiate a VR sessionor answer an incoming call.

You can also use the button to skipthrough system feedback and to enter com-mands during a call. See “List of voice com-mands” and “During a call” later in this sec-tion for more information.

MODE/PHONE END

Push the button to cancel a VR sessionor end a call.

GETTING STARTED

The following procedures will help you getstarted using the Bluetooth Hands-Free PhoneSystem with NISSAN Voice Recognition. Foradditional command options, refer to “List ofvoice commands” later in this section.

Choosing a language

You can interact with the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System using English, Spanish orFrench.

To change the language, perform the following.

1. Press and hold the button for morethan 5 seconds.

2. The system announces: “Press the PHONESEND ( ) button for the hands-freephone system to enter the speaker adapta-tion mode or press the PHONE END( ) button to select a different lan-guage.”

3. Press the button.

For information on speaker adaptation, see

“Speaker adaptation (SA) mode” later in thissection.

4. The system announces the current languageand gives you the option to change thelanguage to Spanish (in Spanish) or French(in French). Use the following chart to selectthe language.

NOTE:

You must press the button or thebutton within 5 seconds to change

the language.

Currentlanguage

Press(TALK/PHONESEND)to select

Press(MODE/PHONE

END)to select

English Spanish French

Spanish English French

French English Spanish

5. If you decide not to change the language, donot press either button. After 5 seconds, theVR session will end, and the language will notbe changed.

SAA1700

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-35

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 175: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Pairing procedure

1. Push the button on the steering wheel.The system announces the available com-mands.

2. Say: “Setup” �A . The system acknowledgesthe command and announces the next set ofavailable commands.

3. Say: “Pair phone” �B . The system acknowl-edges the command and announces the nextset of available commands.

4. Say: “New phone” �C . The system acknowl-edges the command and asks you to initiatepairing from the phone handset �D .When you are asked to enter a PIN code forpairing your Bluetooth cellular phone, oper-ate it to enter the code “1234”.

The code is always “1234” regardless of thenumber of phones paired.

The pairing procedure of the cellular phonevaries according to each cellular phone. Seethe cellular phone Owner’s Manual for de-tails. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructions on pairing NISSANrecommended cellular phones.

5. The system asks you to say a name for thephone �E .If the name is too long or too short, thesystem tells you, then prompts you for a nameagain.

Also, if more than one phone is paired andthe name sounds too much like a namealready used, the system tells you, thenprompts you for a name again.

6. The system asks you to assign a priority level�F . The priority level determines which phoneis active when more than one pairedBluetooth phone is in the vehicle. Follow theinstructions provided by the system or referto “Setup” later in this section for moreinformation on changing priorities.

7. The system will ask if you would like to selecta custom ring tone �G . Follow the instruc-tions provided by the system or refer to“Setup” later in this section for more informa-

tion on selecting ringtones.

Making a call by entering a phonenumber

1. Push the button on steering wheel. Atone will sound.

2. Say: “Call” �A . The system acknowledgesthe command and announces the next set ofavailable commands.

3. Say the number you wish to call �B . Forexample, 555-1212 can be said as “five fivefive one two one two.” See “How to saynumbers” earlier in this section for moreinformation.

4. When you have finished speaking the phonenumber, the system repeats it back andannounces the available commands.

5. Say: “Dial”�C . The system acknowledges thecommand and makes the call.

For additional command options, see “List ofvoice commands” later in this section.

4-36 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 176: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Receiving a call

When you hear the ring tone, press thebutton on the steering wheel.

Once the call has ended, press the buttonon the steering wheel.

NOTE:

If you do not wish to take the call when youhear the ring tone, press the buttonon the steering wheel to reject the call.

For additional command options, see “List ofvoice commands” later in this section.

LIST OF VOICE COMMANDS

When you push and release the button onthe steering wheel, you can choose from thecommands on the Main Menu. The followingpages describe these commands and the com-mands in each sub-menu.

Remember to wait for the tone beforespeaking.

You can say “Help” to hear the list of commandscurrently available anytime the system is waitingfor a response.

If you want to end an action without completingit, you can say “Cancel” or “Quit” at anytime thesystem is waiting for a response. The system willend the VR session. Whenever the VR session iscancelled, a double beep is played to indicateyou have exited the system.

If you want to go back to the previous command,you can say “Go back” or “Correction” anytimethe system is waiting for a response.

When you get used to the menus in the system,you can talk ahead by saying more than onecommand at a time. For example, say, “Call fivefive five one two one two” or “Memo pad record.”

Also, when you get used to the system re-sponses, you can skip ahead to the tone bypressing the button on the steering wheel.However, if you press the button when thesystem is waiting for a response from you it willend the VR session.

“Call”

Name (speak name) �AIf you have stored entries in the Phone Book, youcan dial a number associated with a name andlocation.

See “Phone book” later in this section to learnhow to store entries.

When prompted by the system, say the name ofthe phone book entry you wish to call. Thesystem acknowledges the name.

If there are multiple locations associated with thename, the system asks you to choose the loca-tion.

Once you have confirmed the name and loca-tion, the system begins the call.

Number (speak digits) �BWhen prompted by the system, say the number

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-37

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 177: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

you wish to call. Refer to “How to say numbers”and “Making a call by entering a phone number”earlier in this section for more details.

“Redial” �CUse the Redial command to call the last numberthat was dialed within the vehicle.

NOTE:

The system will not redial the last numberdialed by the handset keypad.

The system acknowledges the command, re-peats the number and begins dialing.

If a redial number does not exist, the systemannounces, “There is no number to redial” andends the VR session.

“Call back” �DUse the Call Back command to dial the numberof the last incoming call within the vehicle.

The system acknowledges the command, re-peats the number and begins dialing. If a callback number does not exist, the system an-nounces, “There is no number to call back” andends the VR session.

During a call

During a call there are several command optionsavailable. Press the button on the steering

wheel to mute the receiving voice and entercommands.

� “Help” — The system announces the avail-able commands.

� “Go back/Correction” — The system an-nounces “Go back,” ends the VR session andreturns to the call.

� “Cancel/Quit” — The system announces“Cancel,” ends the VR session and returns tothe call.

� “Send/Enter/Call/Dial” — Use the Send com-mand to enter numbers during a call. Forexample, if you were directed to dial anextension by an automated system:

Say: “Send one two three four.”

The system acknowledges the command andsends the tones associated with the num-bers. The system then ends the VR sessionand returns to the call.

� “Transfer call” — Use the Transfer Call com-mand to transfer the call from the BluetoothHands-Free Phone System to the cellularphone when privacy is desired.

The system announces, “Transfer call. Calltransferred to privacy mode.” The systemthen ends the VR session.

You can also issue the Transfer Call com-mand again to return to a hands-free callthrough the vehicle.

� “Mute” — Use the Mute command to muteyour voice so the other party cannot hear it.Use the mute command again to unmute yourvoice.

NOTE:

If the other party ends the call or thecellular phone network connection is lostwhile the Mute feature is on, the Mutefeature may need to be reset to “off.”

“Phone book”

The Phone Book stores up to 40 names for eachphone paired with the system. Each name canhave up to 4 locations/phone numbers associatedwith it.

4-38 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 178: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

NOTE:

Each phone has its own separate phonebook. You cannot access Phone A’s phonebook if you are currently connected withPhone B.

“New entry” �AUse the New Entry command to store a newname in the system.

When prompted by the system, say the nameyou would like to give the new entry.

For example, say: “Mary.”

If the name is too long or too short, the systemtells you, then prompts you for a name again.

Also, if the name sounds too much like a namealready stored, the system tells you, thenprompts you for a name again.

Once the system accepts the name and youconfirm it is correct, the system asks for alocation (Home, Office, Mobile or Other).

For example, say: “Home.”

The system acknowledges the location. Thesystem will ask you to say a phone number or totransfer a phone number stored in the cellularphone’s memory.

To enter a phone number by voice command:

For example, say: “five five five one two onetwo.” See “How to say numbers” earlier inthis section for more information.

To transfer a phone number stored in the cellularphone’s memory (if so equipped):

Say: “Transfer entry.”

The system acknowledges the command andasks you to initiate the transfer from the phonehandset. The new contact phone number will betransferred from the cellular phone via theBluetooth communication link.

The transfer procedure varies according to eachcellular phone. See the cellular phone Owner’sManual for details. You can also visitwww.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructionson transferring phone numbers from NISSANrecommended cellular phones.

The system repeats the number and promptsyou for the next command. When you havefinished entering numbers, choose “Store.”

The system confirms the name, location andnumber. The system then asks if you would liketo store another location for the same name. Ifyou do not wish to store another location, thesystem ends the VR session.

“Edit” �BUse the Edit command to alter an existing phone

book entry or to add a 2nd, 3rd or 4th phonenumber to an existing entry.

When prompted by the system, say the name ofthe entry you wish to edit.

The system acknowledges the name and asksyou for the location you would like to edit.

Say the name of the location. The system ac-knowledges the location. The system will ask youto say a phone number or to transfer a phonenumber stored in the cellular phone’s memory.

To enter a phone number by voice command:

For example, say: “five five five one two onetwo.” See “How to say numbers” earlier inthis section for more information.

To transfer a phone number stored in the cellularphone’s memory (if so equipped):

Say: “Transfer entry.”

The system acknowledges the command andasks you to initiate the transfer from the phonehandset. The new contact phone number will betransferred from the cellular phone via theBluetooth communication link.

The transfer procedure varies according to eachcellular phone. See the cellular phone Owner’sManual for details. You can also visitwww.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructions

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-39

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 179: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

on transferring phone numbers from NISSANrecommended cellular phones.

The system repeats the number and promptsyou for the next command. When you havefinished entering numbers, choose “Store.”

The system confirms the name, location andnumber, then announces that the entry has beenstored. The system then ends the VR session.

“Delete” �CUse the Delete command to erase one entryfrom the phone book, all entries from the phonebook, the current redial number or the currentcall back number.

To delete entries from the phone book, say aname or “All entries” when prompted by thesystem.

The system acknowledges the command andasks you to confirm the deletion.

To delete the current redial number or call backnumber, say “redial number” or “call back num-ber” when prompted by the system.

If a redial number or a call back number exists,the system deletes them without asking forconfirmation.

If there is no number for the entry you are trying

to delete, the system says so and ends the VRsession.

“List names” �DUse the List Names command to hear all thenames and locations in the phone book.

The system recites the phone book entries butdoes not include the actual phone numbers.When the playback of the list is complete, thesystem returns to the main menu.

You can stop the playback of the list at any timeby pressing the button on the steeringwheel. The system ends the VR session.

“Memo pad”

The Memo Pad records a maximum of 6 voicememos, each up to 20 seconds long.

“Play” �AThe system plays back all the memos in theorder of newest to oldest. The system ends theVR session.

If there are no memos recorded, the systemannounces “No messages to play.” The systemends the VR session.

“Record” �BThe system announces “Recording” and a tonesounds signaling you to begin.

Speak the information you wish to record clearly.When you are done, press the or

button on the steering wheel.

A tone sounds and the system announces“Memo recorded.” Another tone sounds to endthe VR session.

If the memo pad is full, the system asks if youwish to record over the oldest memo.

“Delete” �CThe Delete command erases all memos. Thesystem asks you to confirm this action beforedeleting all memos.

4-40 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 180: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

“Setup”

Use the Setup command to change optionsassociated with the Bluetooth Hands-FreePhone System.

“Pair phone” �AUse the Pair Phone command to pair a phone tothe Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System.

When you are asked to enter a PIN code forpairing your Bluetooth cellular phone, operate itto enter the code “1234”.

The code is always “1234” regardless of thenumber of phones paired.

Up to 5 phones can be paired. If you try to paira sixth phone, the system announces that you

must first delete one phone or replace an exist-ing phone.

If you try to pair a phone that has already beenpaired to your vehicle’s system, the systemannounces the name the phone is already using.The pairing procedure will then be cancelled.

When prompted by the system, choose from thefollowing commands:

� “New phone” — Refer to “Pairing a phone”earlier in this section.

� “Replace phone” — The system announcesthe names of the phones already paired andasks which you would like to replace.

Once you say the name of the phone youwish to replace, the paring procedure willbegin. Refer to “Pairing procedure” earlier inthis section.

� “List phones” — See the description below.

“List phones” �BUse the List Phones command to hear thenames of the phones currently paired. If nophones are paired, the system announces, “Nopaired phones to list.” The system then ends theVR session.

“Select phone” �CUse the Select Phone command to select a

phone of lesser priority when two or morephones paired with Bluetooth Hands-FreePhone System are in the vehicle at the sametime.

The system asks you to name the phone andconfirm the selection.

Once the selection is confirmed, the selectedphone remains active until the ignition switch isturned OFF or you select a new phone.

“Change priority” �DUse the Change Priority command to change thepriority level of the active phone.

The priority level determines which phone isactive when more than one paired Bluetoothphone is in the vehicle.

The system states the priority level of the activephone and asks for a new priority level (1, 2, 3,4, 5).

If the new priority level is already being used foranother phone, the two phones will swap prioritylevels.

For example, if the current priority levels are:

Priority Level 1 = Phone APriority Level 2 = Phone BPriority Level 3 = Phone C

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-41

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 181: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

and you change the priority level of Phone C toLevel 1, then:

Priority Level 1 = Phone CPriority Level 2 = Phone BPriority Level 3 = Phone A

“Delete phone” �EUse the Delete Phone command to delete aspecific phone or all phones from the BluetoothHands-Free Phone System.

The system announces the names of the phonesalready paired with the system and their prioritylevel. The system then gives you the option todelete a specific phone, all phones or listen to thelist again.

Once you chose to delete a phone or all phones,the system asks you to confirm this action.

NOTE:

When you delete a phone, the associatedphone book for that phone will also bedeleted.

“Select ringtone” �FUse the Select Ringtone command to select thetone heard in the vehicle when an incoming callis received.

The system announces the name of the active

phone and asks you to choose from the follow-ing commands:

� “Ringtone” — The system plays a ringtoneand asks if you would like to select that tone.If you say no, the system plays the nextringtone available and continues to cyclethrough the ringtones until you select one orquit.

� “Silent” — The system asks you to confirmyour wish to disable the ringtone.

“Bluetooth off” �GUse the Bluetooth Off command to turn off theBluetooth Hands-Free Phone System.

When Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System isoff, you will not be able to make or receive callsusing NISSAN Voice Recognition. Also, you willnot have access to the Phone Book.

You can still use the Memo Pad and accessSetup.

To turn on the system again, choose the Blue-tooth On command from the Setup command.

SPEAKER ADAPTATION (SA) MODESpeaker Adaptation allows up to two out-of dia-lect users to train the system to improve recogni-tion accuracy. By repeating a number of com-mands, the users can create a voice model of their

own voice that is stored in the system. The systemis capable of storing a different speaker adapta-tion model for memory A and memory B.

If memory A is available, the system will usememory A to store the model. If memory A is inuse and memory B is available, the system willuse memory B to store the model. If both of thememory locations are in use, the system will askthe user to select which memory location shouldbe overwritten.

Training procedure

The procedure for training a voice is as follows.

1. Position the vehicle in a reasonably quietoutdoor location.

2. Sit in the driver’s seat with the engine run-ning, the parking brake on, and the transmis-sion in Park.

3. Press and hold the button for morethan 5 seconds.

4. The system announces: “Press the PHONESEND ( ) button for the hands-freephone system to enter the speaker adapta-tion mode or press the PHONE END( ) button to select a different lan-guage.”

5. Press the button.

4-42 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 182: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

For information on selecting a different lan-guage, see “Choosing a language” earlier inthis section.

6. Voice memory A or memory B is selectedautomatically. If both memory locations arealready in use, the system will prompt you tooverwrite one. Follow the instructions pro-vided by the system.

7. When preparation is complete and you areready to begin, press the button.

8. The SA mode will be explained. Follow theinstructions provided by the system.

9. When training is finished, the system will tellyou an adequate number of phrases havebeen recorded.

10.The system will ask you to say your name.Follow the instructions to register your name.

11.The system will announce that speaker adap-tation has been completed and the system isready.

The SA mode will stop if:

� The button is pressed for more than 5seconds in SA mode.

� The vehicle is driven during SA mode.

� The ignition switch is turned to the OFF orLOCK position.

Training phrases

During the SA mode, the system instructs you tosay the following phrases.

(The system will prompt you for each phrase.)

� phone book new entry

� dial three oh four two nine

� delete call back number

� setup pair phone

� memo pad play

� eight pause nine three two pause seven

� delete all entries

� call seven two four zero nine

� phone book delete entry

� memo pad record

� dial star two one seven oh

� Yes

� No

� select ring tone

� dial eight five six nine two

� Bluetooth on

� setup change priority

� call three one nine oh two

� nine seven pause pause three oh eight

� Cancel

� call back number

� call star two zero nine five

� delete phone

� dial eight three zero five one

� Home

� four three pause two nine pause zero

� delete redial number

� phone book list names

� call eight oh five four one

� Correction

� setup change ring tone

� dial seven four oh one eight

� setup main menu

� Delete

� dial nine seven two six six

� memo pad delete

� call seven six three oh one

� go back

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-43

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 183: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� call five six two eight zero

� dial six six four three seven

4-44 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 184: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDEThe system should respond correctly to all voice commands without difficulty. If problems are encountered, try the following solutions.

Where the solutions are listed by number, try each solution in turn, starting with number 1, until the problem is resolved.

Symptom Solution

System fails to interpret the command correctly.

1. Ensure that the command is valid. See “List of voice commands” earlier in this section.

2. Ensure that the command is spoken after the tone.

3. Speak clearly without pausing between words and at a level appropriate to the ambient noise level in the vehicle.

4. Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive (for example, windows open or defroster on). NOTE: If it istoo noisy to use the phone, it is likely that the voice commands will not be recognized.

5. If more than one command was said at a time, try saying the commands separately.

6. If the system consistently fails to recognize commands, the voice training procedure should be carried out to im-prove the recognition response for the speaker. See “Speaker adaptation (SA) mode” earlier in this section.

The system consistently selects the wrong entryfrom the phone book.

1. Ensure that the phone book entry name requested matches what was originally stored. This can be confirmed byusing the “List Names” command. See “Phone book” earlier in this section.

2. Replace one of the names being confused with a new name.

Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems 4-45

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 185: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

MEMO

4-46 Display screen, heater, air conditioner and audio systems

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 186: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

5 Starting and driving

Precautions when starting and driving ............................ 5-2Exhaust gas (Carbon monoxide) ................................. 5-2Three-way catalyst .......................................................... 5-3Tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) ................. 5-3Avoiding collision and rollover ..................................... 5-5Drinking alcohol/drugs and driving ............................ 5-6

Ignition switch ....................................................................... 5-6Automatic transmission ................................................. 5-7Manual transmission ....................................................... 5-7Key positions ................................................................... 5-8NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System ........................ 5-8

Before starting the engine ................................................. 5-9Starting the engine ............................................................... 5-9Driving the vehicle ............................................................. 5-10Automatic transmission ............................................... 5-10Manual transmission .................................................... 5-13

Parking brake ...................................................................... 5-15Cruise control (if so equipped) ...................................... 5-16Precautions on cruise control ................................... 5-16Cruise control operations ........................................... 5-17

Break-in schedule .............................................................. 5-18Increasing fuel economy .................................................. 5-18Parking/parking on hills .................................................... 5-19Power steering .................................................................... 5-20Brake system ....................................................................... 5-21Braking precautions ..................................................... 5-21Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) ............................... 5-21

Traction Control System (TCS) (if so equipped) ...... 5-23Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system(if so equipped) .................................................................. 5-23Cold weather driving ......................................................... 5-25Freeing a frozen door lock ......................................... 5-25Anti-freeze ...................................................................... 5-25Battery ............................................................................. 5-25Draining of coolant water ........................................... 5-25Tire equipment .............................................................. 5-25Special winter equipment .......................................... 5-25Driving on snow or ice ................................................ 5-25Engine block heater (if so equipped)....................... 5-26

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 187: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

� Do not leave children or adults whowould normally require the supportof others alone in your vehicle. Petsshould not be left alone either. Theycould accidentally injure themselvesor others through inadvertent opera-tion of the vehicle. Also, on hot,sunny days, temperatures in a closedvehicle could quickly become highenough to cause severe or possiblyfatal injuries to people or animals.

� Properly secure all cargo to help pre-vent it from sliding or shifting. Do notplace cargo higher than the seat-backs. In a sudden stop or collision,unsecured cargo could cause per-sonal injury. (Coupe models)

� Closely supervise children when theyare around cars to prevent them fromplaying and becoming locked in thetrunk where they could be seriouslyinjured. Keep the car locked with thetrunk closed when not in use, and

prevent children’s access to car keys.(Roadster models)

EXHAUST GAS (Carbon monoxide)

WARNING

Do not breathe exhaust gases; they con-tain colorless and odorless carbon mon-oxide. Carbon monoxide is dangerous.It can cause unconsciousness or death.

� If you suspect that exhaust fumes areentering the vehicle, drive with allwindows fully open, and have thevehicle inspected immediately.

� Do not run the engine in closedspaces such as a garage.

� Do not park the vehicle with the en-gine running for any extended lengthof time.

� Keep the rear hatch/trunk lid closedwhile driving, otherwise exhaustgases could be drawn into the pas-

senger compartment. If you mustdrive with the rear hatch/trunk lidopen, follow these precautions:

1. Open all the windows.

2. Set the air recirculation mode OFFand the fan control at the maxi-mum position to circulate the air.

� If electrical wiring or other cable con-nections must pass to a trailerthrough the seal on the rearhatch/trunk lid or the body, followthe manufacturer’s recommendationto prevent carbon monoxide entryinto the vehicle.

� If a special body, camper, or otherequipment is added for recreationalor other usage, follow the manufac-turer’s recommendation to preventcarbon monoxide entry into the ve-hicle. Some recreational vehicle ap-pliances such as stoves, refrigera-tors, heaters, etc. may also generatecarbon monoxide.

PRECAUTIONS WHEN STARTINGAND DRIVING

5-2 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 188: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� The exhaust system and body shouldbe inspected by a qualified mechanicwhenever:

• The vehicle is raised for service.

• You suspect that exhaust fumesare entering into the passengercompartment.

• You notice a change in the soundof the exhaust system.

• You have had an accident involv-ing damage to the exhaust system,underbody, or rear of the vehicle.

THREE-WAY CATALYST

The three-way catalyst is an emission controldevice installed in the exhaust system. Exhaustgases in the converter are burned at high tem-peratures to help reduce pollutants.

WARNING

� The exhaust gas and the exhaust sys-tem are very hot. Keep people, ani-

mals or flammable materials awayfrom the exhaust system compo-nents.

� Do not stop or park the vehicle overflammable materials such as drygrass, waste paper or rags. They mayignite and cause a fire.

CAUTION

� Do not use leaded gasoline. Depositsfrom leaded gasoline will seriouslyreduce the three-way catalyst’s abil-ity to help reduce exhaust pollutants.

� Keep your engine tuned up. Malfunc-tions in the ignition, fuel injection, orelectrical systems can cause overrichfuel flow into the three-way catalyst,causing it to overheat. Do not keepdriving if the engine misfires, or ifnoticeable loss of performance orother unusual operating conditionsare detected. Have the vehicle in-spected promptly by a NISSANdealer.

� Avoid driving with an extremely lowfuel level. Running out of fuel couldcause the engine to misfire, damag-ing the three-way catalyst.

� Do not race the engine while warm-ing it up.

� Do not push or tow your vehicle tostart the engine.

TIRE PRESSURE MONITORINGSYSTEM (TPMS)

Each tire, including the spare (if provided),should be checked monthly when cold andinflated to the inflation pressure recommendedby the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle plac-ard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehiclehas tires of a different size than the size indicatedon the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressurelabel, you should determine the proper tire infla-tion pressure for those tires.)

As an added safety feature, your vehicle hasbeen equipped with a Tire Pressure MonitoringSystem (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pres-sure telltale when one or more of your tires issignificantly under-inflated. Accordingly, whenthe low tire pressure telltale illuminates, youshould stop and check your tires as soon as

Starting and driving 5-3

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 189: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

possible, and inflate them to the proper pres-sure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tirecauses the tire to overheat and can lead to tirefailure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel effi-ciency and tire tread life, and may affect thevehicle’s handling and stopping ability.

Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute forproper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’sresponsibility to maintain correct tire pressure,even if under-inflation has not reached the levelto trigger illumination of the TPMS low tirepressure telltale.

Your vehicle has also been equipped with aTPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when thesystem is not operating properly. The TPMSmalfunction indicator is combined with the lowtire pressure telltale. When the system detects amalfunction, the telltale will flash for approxi-mately one minute and then remain continuouslyilluminated. This sequence will continue uponsubsequent vehicle start-ups as long as themalfunction exists. When the malfunction indica-tor is illuminated, the system may not be able todetect or signal low tire pressure as intended.TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety ofreasons, including the installation of replacementor alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle thatprevent the TPMS from functioning properly.Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale afterreplacing one or more tires or wheels on your

vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alter-nate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to con-tinue to function properly.

Additional information

� The TPMS does not monitor the tire pressureof the spare tire.

� The TPMS will activate only when the vehicleis driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h).Also, this system may not detect a suddendrop in tire pressure (for example a flat tirewhile driving).

� The low tire pressure warning light does notautomatically turn off when the tire pressureis adjusted. After the tire is inflated to therecommended pressure, the vehicle must bedriven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h) toactivate the TPMS and turn off the low tirepressure warning light. Use a tire pressuregauge to check the tire pressure.

� Tire pressure rises and falls depending on theheat caused by the vehicle’s operation andthe outside temperature. Low outside tem-perature can lower the temperature of the airinside the tire which can cause a lower tireinflation pressure. This may cause the low tirepressure warning light to illuminate. If thewarning light illuminates in low ambient tem-

perature, check the tire pressure for all fourtires.

For additional information, see “Low tire pres-sure warning light” in the “2. Instruments andcontrols” section and “Tire pressure monitoringsystem (TPMS)” in the “6. In case of emergency”section.

WARNING

� If the light illuminates while driving,avoid sudden steering maneuvers orabrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed,pull off the road to a safe locationand stop the vehicle as soon as pos-sible. Driving with under-inflatedtires may permanently damage thetires and increase the likelihood oftire failure. Serious vehicle damagecould occur and may lead to an acci-dent and could result in serious per-sonal injury. Check the tire pressurefor all four tires. Adjust the tire pres-sure to the recommended COLD tirepressure shown on the Tire andLoading Information label to turn thelow tire pressure warning light OFF.If you have a flat tire, replace it with a

5-4 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 190: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

spare tire as soon as possible. (See“Flat tire” in the “6. In case of emer-gency” section for changing a flattire.)

� When a spare tire is mounted or awheel is replaced, the TPMS will notfunction and the low tire pressurewarning light will flash for approxi-mately 1 minute. The light will remainon after 1 minute. Contact yourNISSAN dealer as soon as possiblefor tire replacement and/or systemresetting.

� Replacing tires with those not origi-nally specified by NISSAN could af-fect the proper operation of theTPMS.

� Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosoltire sealant into the tires, as this maycause a malfunction of the tire pres-sure sensors.

CAUTION

� The TPMS may not function properlywhen the wheels are equipped withtire chains or the wheels are buried insnow.

� Do not place metalized film or anymetal parts (antenna, etc.) on thewindows. This may cause poor recep-tion of the signals from the tire pres-sure sensors, and the TPMS will notfunction properly.

Some devices and transmitters may temporarilyinterfere with the operation of the TPMS andcause the low tire pressure warning light toilluminate. Some examples are:

� Facilities or electric devices using similarradio frequencies are near the vehicle.

� If a transmitter set to similar frequencies isbeing used in or near the vehicle.

� If a computer (or similar equipment) or aDC/AC converter is being used in or near thevehicle.

FCC Notice:

Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible for com-pliance could void the user’s authority tooperate the equipment.

This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules and RSS-210 of IndustryCanada.

Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) This device may not causeharmful interference, and (2) this devicemust accept any interference received, in-cluding interference that may cause undes-ired operation of the device.

AVOIDING COLLISION ANDROLLOVER

WARNING

Failure to operate this vehicle in a safeand prudent manner may result in lossof control or an accident.

Be alert and drive defensively at all times. Obeyall traffic regulations. Avoid excessive speed,high speed cornering, or sudden steering ma-neuvers, because these driving practices couldcause you to lose control of your vehicle. As

Starting and driving 5-5

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 191: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

with any vehicle, a loss of control couldresult in a collision with other vehicles orobjects, or cause the vehicle to rollover,particularly if the loss of control causes thevehicle to slide sideways. Be attentive at alltimes, and avoid driving when tired. Never drivewhen under the influence of alcohol or drugs(including prescription or over-the-counterdrugs which may cause drowsiness). Alwayswear your seat belt as outlined in the “1. Safety— Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraintsystem” section and also instruct your passen-gers to do so.

Seat belts help reduce the risk of injury incollisions and rollovers. In a rollover crash, anunbelted or improperly belted person issignificantly more likely to be injured orkilled than a person properly wearing aseat belt.

DRINKING ALCOHOL/DRUGS ANDDRIVING

WARNING

Never drive under the influence of alco-hol or drugs. Alcohol in the bloodstreamreduces coordination, delays reaction

time and impairs judgement. Driving af-ter drinking alcohol increases the likeli-hood of being involved in an accidentinjuring yourself and others. Addition-ally, if you are injured in an accident,alcohol can increase the severity of theinjury.

NISSAN is committed to safe driving. You mustnot drive under the influence of alcohol. Everyyear thousands of people are injured or killed inalcohol related accidents. Although the locallaws vary on what is considered to be legallyintoxicated, the fact is that alcohol affects allpeople differently and most people underesti-mate the effects of alcohol.

Remember, drinking and driving don’t mix! Andthat is true for drugs, too (over the counter,prescription, and illegal drugs). Don’t drive ifyour ability to operate your vehicle is impaired byalcohol, drugs, or some other physical condition.

WARNING

Never remove or turn the key to theLOCK position while driving. The steer-ing wheel will lock. This may cause thedriver to lose control of the vehicle andcould result in serious vehicle damageor personal injury.

IGNITION SWITCH

5-6 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 192: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION

The ignition lock is designed so the key cannotbe turned to the LOCK position and removeduntil the selector lever is moved to the P (Park)position.

When removing the key from the ignition switch,make sure the selector lever is in the P (Park)position.

If the selector lever is not returned to the P (Park)position, the key cannot be moved to the LOCKposition.

When the key cannot be turned to the LOCKposition, proceed as follows to remove the key:

1. Move the selector lever into the P (Park)position.

2. Turn the ignition key slightly toward the ONdirection.

3. Turn the key to the LOCK position.

4. Remove the key.

If the key is removed from the ignition switch, theselector lever cannot be moved from P (Park)position. The selector lever can be moved ifthe ignition switch is in the ON positionand the foot brake pedal is depressed.

There is an OFF position �1 in between theLOCK and ACC positions. The OFF position isindicated by a “1” on the key cylinder. When theignition switch is in the OFF position, the steer-ing wheel is not locked.

In order for the steering wheel to be locked, itmust be turned about 1/6 of a turn counterclock-wise from the straight up position.

To lock the steering wheel, turn the key tothe LOCK position. Remove the key. Tounlock the steering wheel, insert the keyand turn it gently while rotating the steer-ing wheel slightly right and left.

MANUAL TRANSMISSION

The ignition switch includes a device that helpsprevent accidental removal of the key whiledriving.

The key can only be removed when the ignitionswitch is in the LOCK position.

To turn the ignition switch to the LOCK positionfrom the ACC or ON position, turn the key to theOFF position, push the key in, then turn the keyto the LOCK position.

There is an OFF position �1 in between theLOCK and ACC positions. The OFF position isindicated by a “1” on the key cylinder.

SSD0392 SSD0503

Starting and driving 5-7

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 193: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

In order for the steering wheel to be locked, itmust be turned about 1/6 of a turn clockwisefrom the straight up position.

To lock the steering wheel, turn the key tothe LOCK position. Remove the key. Tounlock the steering wheel, insert the keyand turn it gently while rotating the steer-ing wheel slightly right and left.

KEY POSITIONSThe switch includes an anti-theft steering lockdevice.

LOCK (Normal parking position) (0)

The ignition key can only be removed when theswitch is in this position.

OFF (1)

The engine can be turned off without locking thesteering wheel.

The ignition lock is designed so that the keycannot be turned to LOCK and removed until theselector lever is moved to the P (Park) position.

ACC (Accessories) (2)

This position activates electrical accessoriessuch as the radio when the engine is not running.

ON (Normal operating position) (3)

This position turns on the ignition system and theelectrical accessories.

START (4)

This position activates the starter motor, startingthe engine.

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZERSYSTEM

The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System will notallow the engine to start without the use of theregistered key.

If the engine fails to start using a registered key(for example, when interference is caused byanother registered key, an automated toll roaddevice or automated payment device on the keyring), restart the engine using the followingprocedures:

1. Leave the ignition switch in the ON positionfor approximately 5 seconds.

2. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF or LOCKposition and wait approximately 10 seconds.

3. Repeat steps 1 and 2.

4. Restart the engine while holding the device(which may have caused the interference)separate from the registered key.

If this procedure allows the engine to start,NISSAN recommends placing the registered keyon a separate key ring to avoid interference fromother devices.

5-8 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 194: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� Make sure the area around the vehicle isclear.

� Maintenance items should be checked peri-odically, for example, each time you checkengine oil.

� Check that all windows and lights are clean.

� Visually inspect tires for their appearance andcondition. Also check tires for proper infla-tion.

� Lock all doors.

� Position seat and adjust head restraints.

� Adjust inside and outside mirrors.

� Fasten seat belts and ask all passengers todo likewise.

� Check the operation of warning lights whenthe ignition key is turned to the ON position.See “Warning/indicator lights and audiblereminders” in the “2. Instruments and con-trols” section.

1. Apply the parking brake.

2. Automatic transmission:

Move the selector lever to P (Park) or N(Neutral). (P preferred.)

The starter is designed not to operate if theselector lever is in one of the driving posi-tions.

Manual transmission:

Move the shift lever to N (Neutral) position,and depress the clutch pedal to the floorwhile cranking the engine.

The starter is designed not to operate unlessthe clutch pedal is fully depressed.

3. Crank the engine with your foot off theaccelerator pedal by turning the ignitionkey to START. Release the key when theengine starts. If the engine starts, but fails torun, repeat the above procedure.

� If the engine is very hard to start in extremelycold weather or when restarting, depress theaccelerator pedal a little (approximately 1/3to the floor) and hold it then crank the engine.Release the key and the accelerator pedalwhen the engine starts.

� If the engine is very hard to start because it isflooded, depress the accelerator pedal all the

way to the floor and hold it. Crank the enginefor 5 to 6 seconds. After cranking the engine,release the accelerator pedal. Crank the en-gine with your foot off the acceleratorpedal by turning the ignition key to START.Release the key when the engine starts. If theengine starts, but fails to run, repeat theabove procedure.

CAUTION

Do not operate the starter for more than15 seconds at a time. If the engine doesnot start, turn the key off and wait 10seconds before cranking again, other-wise the starter could be damaged.

4. Warm-up

Allow the engine to idle for at least 30seconds after starting. Do not race the en-gine while warming it up. Drive at moderatespeed for a short distance first, especially incold weather.

In cold weather, keep the engine running fora minimum of 2 to 3 minutes before shuttingit off. Starting and stopping the engine over ashort period of time may make the vehiclemore difficult to start.

BEFORE STARTING THE ENGINE STARTING THE ENGINE

Starting and driving 5-9

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 195: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION

5-speed automatic transmission

The automatic transmission in your vehicle iselectronically controlled by a transmission con-trol module to produce maximum power andsmooth operation.

Shown on the following pages are the recom-mended operating procedures for this transmis-sion. Follow these procedures for maximum ve-hicle performance and driving enjoyment.

Starting the vehicleAfter starting the engine, fully depress the footbrake pedal and push the selector lever buttonbefore shifting the selector lever to the R (Re-verse), N (Neutral), D (Drive) or Manual shiftmode position. Be sure the vehicle is fullystopped before shifting the selector lever.

This automatic transmission model is de-signed so that the foot brake pedal mustbe depressed before shifting from P (Park)to any drive position while the ignitionswitch is ON.

The selector lever cannot be moved out ofP (Park) position and into any of the othergear positions if the ignition key is turnedto the LOCK, OFF or ACC position or if thekey is removed from the ignition switch.

1. Keep the foot brake pedal depressed andpush the selector lever button to shift into adriving gear.

2. Release the parking brake and foot brake,then gradually start the vehicle in motion.

WARNING

� Do not depress the accelerator pedalwhile shifting from P (Park) or N(Neutral) to R (Reverse), D (Drive) ormanual shift mode. Always depressthe brake pedal until shifting is com-pleted. Failure to do so could causeyou to lose control and have an acci-dent.

� Cold engine idle speed is high, so usecaution when shifting into a forwardor reverse gear before the engine haswarmed up.

� On slippery roads, do not downshift.This may cause a loss of control.

� Never shift to P (Park) or R (Reverse)while the vehicle is moving forward.

Never shift to P (Park) or D (Drive)while vehicle is moving backward.These could cause an accident.

CAUTION

When stopping the vehicle on an uphillgrade, do not hold the vehicle by de-pressing the accelerator pedal. The footbrake should be used for this purpose.

DRIVING THE VEHICLE

5-10 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 196: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

To move the selector lever,

: Push the button while depressing thebrake pedal,: Push the button,: Just move the selector lever.

Shifting

After starting the engine, fully depress the brakepedal and shift the selector lever from P (Park) toR (Reverse), N (Neutral), D (Drive), or Manualshift mode position.

Push the button to shift into P (Park) or R(Reverse). All other positions can be selectedwithout pushing the button.

WARNING

Apply the parking brake if the selectorlever is in any position while the engineis not running. Failure to do so couldcause the vehicle to move unexpectedlyor roll away and result in serious per-sonal injury or property damage.

If the key is turned to OFF or ACC for any reasonwhile the vehicle is in R (Reverse), N (Neutral), orany D (Drive) position, the key cannot be turnedto LOCK and be removed from the ignitionswitch. Move the selector lever to the P (Park)position, then the key can be turned to LOCK.

CAUTION

To prevent automatic transmissiondamage, use the P (Park) or R (Reverse)position only when the vehicle is com-pletely stopped.

P (Park):

Use this selector position when the vehicle isparked or when starting the engine. Make sure

the vehicle is completely stopped. The brakepedal must be depressed and the selectorlever button pushed in to move the selec-tor lever from N (Neutral) or any driveposition to P (Park). Apply the parking brake.When parking on a hill, first depress the footbrake pedal, apply the parking brake, then shiftinto the P (Park) position.

R (Reverse):

Use this position to back up. Always be sure thevehicle is completely stopped before selecting R(Reverse). The brake pedal must be de-pressed and the selector lever buttonpushed in to move the selector lever fromP (Park), N (Neutral) or any drive positionto R (Reverse).

N (Neutral):

Neither forward nor reverse gear is engaged.The engine can be started in this position. Youmay shift to N (Neutral) and restart a stalledengine while the vehicle is moving.

D (Drive):

Use this position for all normal forward driving.

Manual shift modeWhen the selector lever is shifted from D to themanual shift gate with the vehicle stopped orwhile driving, the transmission enters the manual

SSD0346

Starting and driving 5-11

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 197: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

shift mode. Shift range can be selected manu-ally.

In the manual shift mode, the shift range isdisplayed on the position indicator in the meter.

Shift ranges up or down one by one as follows:

M1→← M2

→← M3

→← M4

→← M5

M5 (5th):

Use this position for all normal forward driving athighway speeds.

M4 (4th):

Use this position when driving up long slopes, orfor engine braking when driving down longslopes.

M3 (3rd) and M2 (2nd):

Use for hill climbing or engine braking on down-hill grades.

M1 (1st):

Use this position when climbing steep hillsslowly or driving slowly through deep snow,sand or mud, or for maximum engine braking onsteep downhill grades.

� Remember not to drive at high speeds forextended periods of time in lower than M4range. This reduces fuel economy.

� When shifting up, move the selector lever tothe + (up) side. (Shifts to higher range.)

� When shifting down, move the selector leverto the − (down) side. (Shifts to lower range.)

� Moving the selector lever to the same sidetwice will shift the ranges in succession.However, if this motion is rapidly done, thesecond shifting may not be completed prop-erly.

� In the manual shift mode, the transmis-sion automatically shifts down to 1stgear before the vehicle comes to a stop.When accelerating again, it is necessaryto shift up to the desired range.

� When canceling the manual shift mode, re-turn the selector lever to the D position. Thetransmission returns to the normal drivingmode.

� In the manual shift mode, the transmis-sion may not shift to the selected gear.This helps maintain driving performanceand reduces the chance of vehicle dam-age or loss of control.

Accelerator downshift— In D position —For passing or hill climbing, fully depress theaccelerator pedal to the floor. This shifts the

transmission down into the lower gear, depend-ing on the vehicle speed.

Fail-safeWhen fail-safe operation occurs, the automatictransmission will be locked in 4th gear.

If the vehicle is driven under extreme con-ditions, such as excessive wheel spinningand subsequent hard braking, the fail-safesystem may be activated. This will occureven if all electrical circuits are functioningproperly. In this case, turn the ignition keyOFF and wait for 3 seconds. Then turn thekey back to the ON position. The vehicleshould return to its normal operating con-dition. If it does not return to its normaloperating condition, have a NISSAN dealercheck the transmission and repair if neces-sary.

5-12 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 198: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Shift lock release

If the battery charge is low or discharged, theselect lever may not be moved from the P (Park)position even with the brake pedal depressed.

To move the selector lever, depress the brakepedal, apply the parking brake, and push theshift lock release button by using a suitable toolas shown. Push the selector lever button, thenthe selector lever can be moved to N (Neutral).This allows the vehicle to be moved if the batteryis discharged.

If the lever cannot be moved out of P (Park), havea NISSAN dealer check the automatic transmis-sion system as soon as possible.

MANUAL TRANSMISSION

Shifting

To change gears, or when upshifting or down-shifting, fully depress the clutch pedal, shift intothe appropriate gear then slowly and smoothlyrelease the clutch.

This vehicle is equipped with a short throwshifter manual transmission. To ensure smoothgear changes, fully depress the clutch pedalbefore operating the shift lever. If the clutchpedal is not fully depressed before the transmis-sion is shifted, a gear noise may be heard.Transmission damage could occur.

Start the vehicle in 1st gear and shift to 2nd, 3rd,4th and 5th up to 6th gear in sequence accord-ing to the vehicle speed.

To back up, depress the shift lever and thenmove it to the R (Reverse) position after stop-ping the vehicle completely.

If it is difficult to move the shift lever into R(Reverse) or 1 (Low gear), shift to N (Neutral),then release the clutch pedal. Fully depress theclutch pedal again and shift into R or 1.

WARNING

� Do not downshift abruptly on slip-pery roads. This may cause a loss ofcontrol.

� Do not over-rev the engine whenshifting to a lower gear. This maycause a loss of control or enginedamage.

CAUTION

� Do not rest your foot on the clutchpedal while driving. This may damagethe clutch.

SSD0347 SSD0536

Starting and driving 5-13

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 199: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� Fully depress the clutch pedal beforeshifting to help prevent transmissiondamage.

� Stop your vehicle completely beforeshifting into R (Reverse).

� When the vehicle is stopped with theengine running (for example, at astop light), shift to N (Neutral) andrelease the clutch pedal with the footbrake applied.

Up-shift indicator

The manual transmission up-shift indicator islocated in the tachometer and shows the driverthe timing to shift into a higher gear by illuminat-ing. The use of the up-shift indicator will help youto upshift at a constant engine speed (rpm) fromany gear.

The up-shift indicator will start flashing when theengine speed is within about 500 rpm of the setfigure while driving, and then illuminate after theengine speed reaches the set figure.

The engine speed in revolutions per minute(rpm) for upshifting can be set on the trip

computer display. See “Trip computer” in the “2.Instruments and controls” section for the displaysetting information.

Use the up-shift indicator when driving as fol-lows:

� If the maximum engine speed is desired, setthe figure at 7,500 rpm. (The indicator startsflashing from about 7,000 rpm and comes onsteady at 7,500 rpm.)

� If the maximum engine torque is desired, setthe figure at 4,800 rpm. (The indicator startsflashing from about 4,300 rpm and comes onsteady at 4,800 rpm.)

� If you want to break in your vehicle, use of theup-shift indicator with a rather low figure willhelp you to avoid the high engine speed.

To make the up-shift indicator not come on, setthe figure at above 8,100 rpm.

There may be a slight difference betweenthe timing of the up-shift indicator illumi-nation and the tachometer indication.

SSD0638

5-14 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 200: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Suggested up-shift speedsShown below are suggested vehicle speeds forshifting into a higher gear. These suggestionsrelate to fuel economy and vehicle performance.Actual up-shift speeds will vary according toroad conditions, the weather and individual driv-ing habits.

For normal acceleration in low altitude areas[less than 4,000 ft (1,219 m)]:

Gear change MPH (km/h)1st to 2nd 8 (13)2nd to 3rd 16 (26)3rd to 4th 25 (40)4th to 5th 28 (45)5th to 6th 33 (53)

For quick acceleration in low altitude areas or inhigh altitude areas [over 4,000 ft (1,219 m)]:

Gear change MPH (km/h)1st to 2nd 15 (24)2nd to 3rd 25 (40)3rd to 4th 40 (64)4th to 5th 45 (72)5th to 6th 50 (80)

Suggested maximum speed in eachgearDownshift to a lower gear if the engine is notrunning smoothly, or if you need to accelerate.

Do not exceed the maximum suggested speed(shown below) in any gear. For level road driving,use the highest gear suggested for that speed.Always observe posted speed limits, and driveaccording to the road conditions, which willensure safe operation. Do not over-rev the en-gine when shifting to a lower gear as it maycause engine damage or loss of vehicle control.

Gear MPH (km/h)1st 40 (65)2nd 66 (106)3rd 95 (152)4th —5th —6th —

To apply: pull the parking brake lever up �1 .To release:

1. Firmly apply the foot brake.

2. Automatic transmission models:

Move the selector lever to the P (Park) posi-tion.

Manual transmission models:

Place the shift lever in the N (Neutral) posi-tion.

3. While pulling up on the parking brake leverslightly, push the button �2 and lower thelever completely �3 .

SPA2110

PARKING BRAKE

Starting and driving 5-15

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 201: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

4. Before driving, be sure the brake warninglight goes out.

WARNING

� Be sure the parking brake is fullyreleased before driving. Failure to doso can cause brake failure and leadto an accident.

� Do not release the parking brakefrom outside the vehicle.

� Do not use the gear shift in place ofthe parking brake. When parking, besure the parking brake is fully en-gaged.

� Do not leave children unattended in avehicle. They could release the park-ing brake and cause an accident.

WARNING

Do not use the cruise control when driv-ing under the following conditions:

� When it is not possible to keep thevehicle at a set speed.

� In heavy traffic or in traffic that variesin speed.

� On winding or hilly roads.

� On slippery roads (rain, snow, ice,etc.).

� In very windy areas.

Doing so could cause a loss of vehiclecontrol and result in an accident.

CAUTION

On manual transmission models, do notshift into N (Neutral) without depressingthe clutch pedal when the cruise controlis set. Should this occur, depress theclutch pedal and turn the main switchoff immediately. Failure to do so may

cause engine damage.

PRECAUTIONS ON CRUISECONTROL� If the cruise control system malfunctions, itcancels automatically. The SET indicator lighton the meter panel then blinks to warn thedriver.

� If the engine coolant temperature becomesexcessively high, the cruise control systemwill be canceled automatically.

� If the SET indicator light blinks, turn thecruise control MAIN (ON⋅OFF) switch off andhave the system checked by a NISSANdealer.

� The SET indicator light may blink when thecruise control MAIN switch is turned on whilepushing the RES/ACCEL, COAST/SET, orCANCEL switch. To properly set the cruisecontrol system, perform the preceding stepsin the order indicated.

CRUISE CONTROL (if soequipped)

5-16 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 202: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. ACCEL or RESUME switch

2. COAST or SET switch

3. CANCEL switch

4. MAIN (ON⋅OFF) switch

CRUISE CONTROL OPERATIONS

The cruise control allows driving at a speedbetween 25 to 89 MPH (40 to 144 km/h)without keeping your foot on the acceleratorpedal.

To turn on the cruise control, push the MAINswitch on. The CRUISE indicator light on themeter panel will come on.

To set cruising speed, accelerate the vehicleto the desired speed, push the COAST/SETswitch and release it. (The SET indicator lightwill come on.) Take your foot off the acceleratorpedal. Your vehicle will maintain the set speed.

� To pass another vehicle, depress the ac-celerator pedal. When you release the pedal,the vehicle will return to the previously setspeed.

� The vehicle may not maintain the set speedwhen going up or down steep hills. If thishappens, drive without the cruise control.

To cancel the preset speed, use one of thefollowing three methods:

a) Push the CANCEL switch; The SET indicatorlight will go out.

b) Tap the brake pedal; The SET indicator lightwill go out.

c) Turn the MAIN switch off. Both the CRUISEindicator and SET indicator lights will go out.

� If you depress the brake pedal while pushingthe ACCEL/RES set switch and reset at thecruising speed, turn the MAIN switch offonce and then turn it on again.

� The cruise control will automatically be can-celled if the vehicle slows down more than

approximately 8 MPH (13 km/h) below theset speed.

� If you depress the clutch pedal (manual trans-mission) or move the selector lever to N(Neutral) position (automatic transmission),the cruise control will be canceled.

To reset at a faster cruising speed, use oneof the following three methods:

a) Depress the accelerator pedal. When thevehicle attains the desired speed, push andrelease the COAST/SET switch.

b) Push and hold the ACCEL/RES set switch.When the vehicle attains the speed youdesire, release the switch.

c) Push, then quickly release the ACCEL/RESset switch. Each time you do this, the setspeed will increase by about 1 MPH (1.6km/h).

To reset at a slower cruising speed, use oneof the following three methods:

a) Lightly tap the brake pedal. When the vehicleattains the desired speed, push theCOAST/SET switch and release it.

b) Push and hold the COAST/SET switch. Re-lease the switch when the vehicle slowsdown to the desired speed.

SSD0528

Starting and driving 5-17

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 203: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

c) Push, then quickly release the COAST/SET switch. Each time you do this, the setspeed will decrease by about 1 MPH (1.6km/h).

To resume the preset speed, push and re-lease the ACCEL/RES set switch. The vehiclewill resume the last set cruising speed when thevehicle speed is over 25 MPH (40 km/h).

CAUTION

During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km),follow these recommendations to ob-tain maximum engine performance andensure the future reliability andeconomy of your new vehicle. Failure tofollow these recommendations may re-sult in shortened engine life and re-duced engine performance.

� Avoid driving for long periods at constantspeed, either fast or slow. Do not run theengine over 4,000 rpm.

� Do not accelerate at full throttle in any gear.

� Avoid quick starts.

� Avoid hard braking as much as possible.

� Do not tow a trailer for the first 500 miles(800 km).

� Accelerate slowly and smoothly. Maintaincruising speeds with a constant acceleratorposition.

� Drive at moderate speeds on the highway.Driving at high speed will lower fuel economy.

� Avoid unnecessary stopping and braking.Maintain a safe distance behind other ve-hicles.

� Use a proper gear range which suits roadconditions. On level roads, shift into high gearas soon as possible.

� Avoid unnecessary engine idling.

� Keep your engine tuned up.

� Follow the recommended periodic mainte-nance schedule.

� Keep the tires inflated to the correct pres-sure. Low tire pressure will increase tire wearand lower fuel economy.

� Keep the front wheels in correct alignment.Improper alignment will increase tire wearand lower fuel economy.

� Air conditioner operation lowers fueleconomy. Use the air conditioner only whennecessary.

� When cruising at highway speeds, it is moreeconomical to use the air conditioner and

BREAK-IN SCHEDULE INCREASING FUEL ECONOMY

5-18 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 204: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

leave the windows closed to reduce drag.

� Use the recommended viscosity engine oil.See “Engine oil and oil filter recommenda-tion” in the “9. Technical and consumer infor-mation” section.

WARNING

� Do not stop or park the vehicle overflammable materials such as drygrass, waste paper or rags. They mayignite and cause a fire.

� Never leave the engine running whilethe vehicle is unattended.

� Do not leave children unattended in-side the vehicle.

1. Firmly apply the parking brake.

2. Automatic transmission models:

Move the selector lever to the P (Park) posi-tion.

Manual transmission models:

Place the shift lever in the R (Reverse) posi-tion. When parking on an uphill grade, placethe shift lever in the 1 (Low gear) position.

MSD0002

PARKING/PARKING ON HILLS

Starting and driving 5-19

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 205: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

� Safe parking procedures require thatboth the parking brake be set and thetransmission placed into P (Park) forautomatic transmission models or inan appropriate gear for manualtransmission models. Failure to doso could cause the vehicle to moveunexpectedly or roll away and resultin an accident.

� Make sure the automatic transmis-sion selector lever has been pushedas far forward as it can go and cannotbe moved without depressing thebutton at the end of the lever.

3. To help prevent the vehicle from rolling intothe street when parked on a sloping driveway, it is a good practice to turn the wheelsas illustrated.

� HEADED DOWNHILL WITH CURB: �1Turn the wheels into the curb and move thevehicle forward until the curb side wheelgently touches the curb.

� HEADED UPHILL WITH CURB: �2Turn the wheels away from the curb andmove the vehicle back until the curb sidewheel gently touches the curb.

� HEADED UPHILL OR DOWNHILL, NOCURB: �3Turn the wheels toward the side of the roadso the vehicle will move away from the centerof the road if it moves.

4. Turn the ignition key to the LOCK positionand remove the key.

WARNING

If the engine is not running or is turnedoff while driving, the power assist forthe steering will not work. Steering willbe harder to operate.

The power assisted steering uses a hydraulicpump, driven by the engine, to assist steering.

If the engine stops or drive belt breaks, you willstill have control of the vehicle. However, muchgreater steering effort is needed, especially insharp turns or at low speeds.

POWER STEERING

5-20 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 206: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

BRAKING PRECAUTIONSThe brake system has two separate hydrauliccircuits. If one circuit malfunctions, you will stillhave braking at two wheels.

Vacuum assisted brakesThe brake booster aids braking by using enginevacuum. If the engine stops, you can stop thevehicle by depressing the brake pedal. However,greater foot pressure on the brake pedal will berequired to stop the vehicle and the stoppingdistance will be longer.

Using the brakesAvoid resting your foot on the brake pedal whiledriving. This overheats the brakes, increaseswear on the brakes and pads, and reduces gasmileage.

To help save the brakes and to prevent thebrakes from overheating, reduce speed anddownshift to a lower gear before going down aslope or long grade. Overheated brakes mayreduce braking performance and could result inloss of vehicle control.

WARNING

� While driving on a slippery surface,be careful when braking, accelerat-ing or downshifting. Abrupt brakingor accelerating could cause thewheels to skid and result in an acci-dent.

� If the engine is not running or isturned off while driving, the powerassist for the brakes will not work.Braking will be harder.

Wet brakes

When the vehicle is washed or driven throughwater, the brakes may get wet. As a result, yourbraking distance will be longer and the vehiclemay pull to one side during braking.

To dry brakes, drive the vehicle at a safe speedwhile lightly pressing the brake pedal to heat-upthe brakes. Do this until the brakes return tonormal. Avoid driving the vehicle at high speedsuntil the brakes function correctly.

Parking brake break-inBreak in the parking brake shoes whenever the

stopping effect of the parking brake is weakenedor whenever the parking brake shoes and/ordrums/rotors are replaced, in order to assure thebest braking performance.

This procedure is described in the vehicle ser-vice manual and can be performed by a NISSANdealer.

ANTI-LOCK BRAKING SYSTEM(ABS)

WARNING

� The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS)is a sophisticated device, but it can-not prevent accidents resulting fromcareless or dangerous driving tech-niques. It can help maintain vehiclecontrol during braking on slipperysurfaces. Remember that stoppingdistances on slippery surfaces will belonger than on normal surfaces evenwith ABS. Stopping distances mayalso be longer on rough, gravel orsnow covered roads, or if you areusing tire chains. Always maintain asafe distance from the vehicle in

BRAKE SYSTEM

Starting and driving 5-21

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 207: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

front of you. Ultimately, the driver isresponsible for safety.

� Tire type and condition may also af-fect braking effectiveness.

— When replacing tires, install thespecified size of tires on all fourwheels.

— When installing a spare tire, makesure that it is the proper size and typeas specified on the Tire and LoadingInformation label. See “Tire andLoading Information label” in the “9.Technical and consumer informa-tion” section of this manual.

— For detailed information, see“Wheels and tires” in the “8. Mainte-nance and do-it-yourself” section ofthis manual.

The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) controlsthe brakes so the wheels do not lock during hardbraking or when braking on slippery surfaces.The system detects the rotation speed at eachwheel and varies the brake fluid pressure toprevent each wheel from locking and sliding. Bypreventing each wheel from locking, the system

helps the driver maintain steering control andhelps to minimize swerving and spinning onslippery surfaces.

Using the system

Depress the brake pedal and hold it down.Depress the brake pedal with firm steady pres-sure, but do not pump the brakes. The ABS willoperate to prevent the wheels from locking up.Steer the vehicle to avoid obstacles.

WARNING

Do not pump the brake pedal. Doing somay result in increased stopping dis-tances.

Self-test feature

The ABS includes electronic sensors, electricpumps, hydraulic solenoids and a computer. Thecomputer has a built-in diagnostic feature thattests the system each time you start the engineand move the vehicle at a low speed in forwardor reverse. When the self-test occurs, you mayhear a “clunk” noise and/or feel a pulsation in thebrake pedal. This is normal and does not indicatea malfunction. If the computer senses a malfunc-tion, it switches the ABS off and illuminates the

ABS warning light on the instrument panel. Thebrake system then operates normally, but with-out anti-lock assistance.

If the ABS warning light illuminates during theself-test or while driving, have the vehiclechecked by a NISSAN dealer.

Normal operationThe ABS operates at speeds above 3 to 6 MPH(5 to 10 km/h). The speed varies according toroad conditions.

When the ABS senses that one or more wheelsare close to locking up, the actuator rapidlyapplies and releases hydraulic pressure. Thisaction is similar to pumping the brakes veryquickly. You may feel a pulsation in the brakepedal and hear a noise from under the hood orfeel a vibration from the actuator when it isoperating. This is normal and indicates that theABS is operating properly. However, the pulsa-tion may indicate that road conditions are haz-ardous and extra care is required while driving.

5-22 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 208: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

On slippery surfaces such as wet asphalt roads,vehicle wheels may spin when the vehicle isaccelerated. This wheel spin reduces accelera-tion, or causes the vehicle to swerve, thusdecreasing vehicle stability.

When the vehicle drive wheels begin to spin, theTraction Control System (TCS) controls theengine torque using an electronic control sys-tem, and it also controls automatic control shift-ing if necessary (for automatic transmissionmodels). This reduces spinning of the drivewheels, and result in improved vehicle accelera-tion performance. It also improves the vehiclestability by swerving motion.

� When the TCS is operating, the “SLIP” indi-cator light in the meter panel blinks.

� If the “SLIP” indicator light blinks, the vehicleis under slippery conditions. Be sure to drivecarefully. See “Slip indicator light” and “Trac-tion Control System (TCS) off indicator light”in the “2. Instruments and controls” section.

� Indicator lightIf a malfunction occurs in the TCS, the “SLIP”and “TCS OFF” indicator lights come on inthe instrument panel. As long as these indi-cator lights are illuminated, the traction con-trol function (except the ABS) is canceled.The vehicle will behaves like a model withoutthe TCS.

WARNING

The traction control system is designedto prevent the wheels from spinning.However, it does not prevent vehicleslipping or spinning due to abrupt steer-ing operation at high speeds or by care-less or dangerous driving techniques.Be especially careful when driving onslippery surfaces and always drivesafely.

When accelerating or driving on slippery sur-faces, the tires may spin or slide. With theVehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system, sensorsdetect these movements and control the brakingand engine output to help improve vehicle sta-bility.

� When the VDC system is operating, the“SLIP” indicator in the instrument panelblinks.

� If the “SLIP” indicator blinks, the road condi-tions are slippery. Be sure to adjust yourspeed and driving to these conditions. Besure to drive carefully. See “Slip indicatorlight”, and “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC)OFF indicator light” in the “2. Instruments andcontrols” section.

� Indicator lightIf a malfunction occurs in the system, the“SLIP” and “VDC OFF” indicator lights illumi-nate in the instrument panel. As long as theseindicators are illuminated, the VDC systemfunction is canceled.

The VDC system uses an Active Brake LimitedSlip (ABLS) system to improve vehicle traction.The ABLS system works when one of the drivingwheels is spinning on a slippery surface. TheABLS system brakes the spinning wheel, whichdistributes the driving power to the other drivingwheel. If the vehicle is operated with the VDC

TRACTION CONTROL SYSTEM(TCS) (if so equipped)

VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL(VDC) SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Starting and driving 5-23

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 209: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

system turned off, all VDC system functions willbe turned off. The ABLS system and ABS willstill operate with the VDC system off. When theABLS system is activated, the “SLIP” indicatorlight will blink and you may hear a clunk noiseand/or feel a pulsation in the brake pedal. This isnormal and is not an indication of a malfunction.

While the VDC system is operating, you may feela pulsation in the brake pedal and hear a noise orfeel a vibration from under the hood. This isnormal and indicates that the VDC system isworking properly.

The VDC system computer has a built-in diag-nostic feature that tests the system each timeyou start the engine and move the vehicle at alow speed forward or backward. When theself-test occurs, you may hear a clunk noiseand/or feel a pulsation in the brake pedal. This isnormal and is not an indication of a malfunction.

WARNING

� The VDC system is designed to helpimprove driving stability but does notprevent accidents due to abruptsteering operation at high speeds ordue to careless or dangerous driving

techniques. Reduce vehicle speedand be especially careful when driv-ing and cornering on slippery sur-faces and always drive carefully.

� Do not modify the vehicle’s suspen-sion. If suspension parts such asshock absorbers, struts, springs, sta-bilizer bars and bushings and wheelsare not NISSAN-approved or are ex-tremely deteriorated the VDC systemmay not operate properly. This couldadversely affect vehicle handling per-formance, and the “VDC OFF” indica-tor or “SLIP” indicator or both indica-tor lights may illuminate.

� If brake related parts such as brakepads, rotors and calipers are notstandard equipment or are extremelydeteriorated, the “VDC OFF” indica-tor or “SLIP” indicator or both indica-tor lights may illuminate.

� If engine related parts such as a muf-fler are not standard equipment orare extremely deteriorated, the “VDCOFF” indicator or “SLIP” indicator or

both indicator lights may illuminate.

� When driving on extremely inclinedsurfaces such as higher banked cor-ners, the VDC system may not oper-ate properly and the “VDC OFF” indi-cator or “SLIP” indicator or bothindicator lights may illuminate. Donot drive on these types of roads.

� When driving on an unstable surfacesuch as a turntable, ferry, elevator orramp, the “VDC OFF” indicator or“SLIP” indicator or both indicatorlights may illuminate. This is not amalfunction. Restart the engine afterdriving onto a stable surface.

� If wheels or tires other than thoserecommended are used, the VDC sys-temmay not operate properly and the“VDC OFF” indicator or “SLIP” indi-cator or both indicator lights mayilluminate.

� The VDC system is not a substitutefor winter tires or tire chains on asnow-covered road.

5-24 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 210: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

FREEING A FROZEN DOOR LOCKTo prevent a door lock from freezing, applydeicer or glycerin to it through the key hole. If thelock becomes frozen, heat the key before insert-ing it into the key hole.

ANTI-FREEZEIn the winter when it is anticipated that thetemperature will drop below 32°F (0°C), checkanti-freeze to assure proper winter protection.For additional information, see “Engine CoolingSystem” in the “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.

BATTERYIf the battery is not fully charged during extremelycold weather conditions, the battery fluid mayfreeze and damage the battery. To maintainmaximum efficiency, the battery should bechecked regularly. For additional information,see “Battery” in the “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.

DRAINING OF COOLANT WATERIf the vehicle is to be left outside without anti-freeze, drain the cooling system by opening thedrain plug located under the radiator. Refillbefore operating the vehicle. See “Engine cool-ing system” in the “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section for changing engine coolant.

TIRE EQUIPMENT1. SUMMER tires are of a tread design toprovide superior performance on dry pave-ment. However, the performance of thesetires will be substantially reduced in snowyand icy conditions. If you operate your vehicleon snowy or icy roads, NISSAN recommendsthe use of MUD & SNOW or ALL SEASONtires on all four wheels. Consult a NISSANdealer for the tire type, size, speed rating andavailability information.

2. For additional traction on icy roads, studdedtires may be used. However, some provincesand states prohibit their use. Check local,state and provincial laws before installingstudded tires.

Skid and traction capabilities of stud-ded snow tires, on wet or dry surfaces,may be poorer than that of non-studdedsnow tires.

3. Tire chains may be used. For details, see“Tire chains” in the “8. Maintenance anddo-it-yourself” section of this manual.

SPECIAL WINTER EQUIPMENT

It is recommended that the following items becarried in the vehicle during winter:

� a scraper and stiff-bristled brush to removeice and snow from the windows and wiperblades.

� a sturdy, flat board to be placed under thejack to give it firm support.

� a shovel to dig the vehicle out of snow-drifts.

� extra window washer fluid to refill the reser-voir tank.

DRIVING ON SNOW OR ICE

WARNING

� Wet ice (32°F, 0°C and freezing rain),very cold snow or ice can be slick andvery hard to drive on. The vehicle willhave much less traction or “grip” un-der these conditions. Try to avoiddriving on wet ice until the road issalted or sanded.

� Whatever the condition, drive withcaution. Accelerate and slow down

COLD WEATHER DRIVING

Starting and driving 5-25

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 211: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

with care. If accelerating or down-shifting too fast, the drive wheels willlose even more traction.

� Allow more stopping distance underthese conditions. Braking should bestarted sooner than on dry pavement.

� Allow greater following distances onslippery roads.

� Watch for slippery spots (glare ice).These may appear on an otherwiseclear road in shaded areas. If a patchof ice is seen ahead, brake beforereaching it. Try not to brake while onthe ice, and avoid any sudden steer-ing maneuvers.

� Do not use cruise control on slipperyroads.

� Snow can trap dangerous exhaustgases under your vehicle. Keep snowclear of the exhaust pipe and fromaround your vehicle.

ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (if soequipped)Engine block heaters are available throughNISSAN dealers to assist in cold temperaturestarting. The engine block heater should be usedwhen the outside temperature is 20°F (−7°C) orlower.

To use the engine block heater:

1. Turn the engine off.

2. Open the hood and unwrap the engine blockheater cord.

3. Plug the engine block heater cord into agrounded 3-wire, 3-pronged extension cord.

4. Plug the extension cord into a Ground FaultInterrupt (GFI) protected, grounded 110-voltAC (VAC) outlet.

5. The engine block heater must be plugged infor at least 2 - 4 hours, depending on outsidetemperatures, to properly warm the enginecoolant. Use an appropriate timer to turn theengine block heater on.

6. Before starting the engine, unplug and prop-erly store the cord to keep it away frommoving parts.

WARNING

� Do not use your engine block heaterwith an ungrounded electrical systemor a 2-pronged adapter. You can beseriously injured by an electricalshock if you use an ungrounded con-nection.

� Disconnect and properly store theengine block heater cord beforestarting the engine. Damage to thecord could result in an electricalshock and can cause serious injury.

� Use a heavy-duty 3-wire, 3-prongedextension cord rated for at least 10 A.Plug the extension cord into aGround Fault Interrupt (GFI) pro-tected, grounded 110-VAC outlet.Failure to use the proper extensioncord or a grounded outlet can resultin a fire or electrical shock and causeserious personal injury.

5-26 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 212: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

MEMO

Starting and driving 5-27

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 213: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

MEMO

5-28 Starting and driving

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 214: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

6 In case of emergency

Flat tire .................................................................................... 6-2Tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) ................. 6-2Changing a flat tire ......................................................... 6-2

Jump starting ......................................................................... 6-7Push starting .......................................................................... 6-9

If your vehicle overheats ..................................................... 6-9Towing your vehicle ........................................................... 6-10Towing recommended by NISSAN ......................... 6-11Vehicle recovery (Freeing a stuck vehicle) ............ 6-12

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 215: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

TIRE PRESSURE MONITORINGSYSTEM (TPMS)

This vehicle is equipped with the Tire PressureMonitoring System (TPMS). It monitors tire pres-sure of all tires except the spare. When the lowtire pressure warning light is lit, one or more ofyour tires is significantly under-inflated. If thevehicle is being driven with low tire pressure, theTPMS will activate and warn you of it by the lowtire pressure warning light (in the meter panel).This system will activate only when the vehicle isdriven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). Formore details, refer to “Warning/indicator lightsand audible reminders” in the “2. Instrumentsand controls” section and “Tire pressure moni-toring system (TPMS)” in the “5. Starting anddriving” section.

WARNING

� If the light illuminates while driving,avoid sudden steering maneuvers orabrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed,pull off the road to a safe locationand stop the vehicle as soon as pos-sible. Driving with under-inflatedtires may permanently damage the

tires and increase the likelihood oftire failure. Serious vehicle damagecould occur and may lead to an acci-dent and could result in serious per-sonal injury. Check the tire pressurefor all four tires. Adjust the tire pres-sure to the recommended COLD tirepressure shown on the Tire andLoading Information label to turn thelow tire pressure warning light OFF.If you have a flat tire, replace it with aspare tire as soon as possible.

� When a spare tire is mounted or awheel is replaced, the TPMS will notfunction and the low tire pressurewarning light will flash for approxi-mately 1 minute. The light will remainon after 1 minute. Contact yourNISSAN dealer as soon as possiblefor tire replacement and/or systemresetting.

� Replacing tires with those not origi-nally specified by NISSAN could af-fect the proper operation of theTPMS.

� Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosoltire sealant into the tires, as this maycause a malfunction of the tire pres-sure sensors.

CHANGING A FLAT TIREIf you have a flat tire, follow the instructionsbelow.

Stopping the vehicle1. Safely move the vehicle off the road awayfrom traffic.

2. Turn on the hazard warning flashers.3. Park on a level surface and apply the parkingbrake. Shift the manual transmission into R(Reverse) position (automatic transmission inP (Park) position).

4. Turn off the engine.5. Raise the hood to warn other traffic, and tosignal professional road assistance person-nel that you need assistance.

6. Have all passengers get out of the vehicleand stand in a safe place, away from trafficand clear of the vehicle.

FLAT TIRE

6-2 In case of emergency

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 216: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

� Make sure the parking brake is se-curely applied and the manual trans-mission is shifted into R (Reverse), orthe automatic transmission into P(Park).

� Never change tires when the vehicleis on a slope, ice or slippery areas.This is hazardous.

� Never change tires if oncoming trafficis close to your vehicle. Wait for pro-fessional road assistance. Blocking wheels

Place suitable blocks �1 at both the front andback of the wheel diagonally opposite the flat tire

to prevent the vehicle from moving when itis jacked up.

WARNING

Be sure to block the wheel as the ve-hicle may move and result in personalinjury.

Getting the spare tire and toolsRemove jacking tools and spare tire from thestorage area located in the luggage/trunk asillustrated.

Coupe models:

1. Spare tire — Turn the retainer counterclock-wise to remove.

2. Jack — Turn it counterclockwise to remove.

3. Jacking tools

MCE0001A SCE0409Coupe models

In case of emergency 6-3

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 217: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Roadster models:

1. Spare tire — Turn the retainer counterclock-wise to remove.

2. Jack — Unfasten the belt and lift the jack upto remove.

3. Jacking tools — They are in the tool bag.

Jacking up the vehicle and removingthe damaged tire

WARNING

� Never get under the vehicle while it issupported only by the jack. If it isnecessary to work under the vehicle,support it with safety stands.

� Use only the jack provided with yourvehicle to lift the vehicle. Do not usethe jack provided with your vehicleon other vehicles. The jack is de-signed for lifting only your vehicleduring a tire change.

� Use the correct jack up points. Neveruse any other part of the vehicle forjack support.

� Never jack up the vehicle more thannecessary.

� Never use blocks on or under thejack.

� Do not start or run the engine whilevehicle is on the jack, as it may cause

the vehicle to move. This is especiallytrue for vehicles with limited slip dif-ferentials.

� Do not allow passengers to stay inthe vehicle while it is on the jack.

Carefully read the caution label attached tothe jack body and the following instruc-tions.

SCE0491Roadster models

6-4 In case of emergency

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 218: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Place the jack directly under the jack-up pointas illustrated above so that top of the jackcontacts the vehicle at the jack up point.Align the jack head between the two notchesin the front or the rear as shown. Also fit thegroove of the jack head between the notchesas shown.

The jack should be used on level firmground.

2. Loosen each wheel nut one or two turns byturning counterclockwise with the wheel nutwrench. Do not remove the wheel nutsuntil the tire is off the ground.

3. Carefully raise the vehicle until the tire clearsthe ground. To lift the vehicle, securely holdthe jack lever and rod with both hands asshown above. Remove the wheel nuts, andthen remove the tire.

SCE0410AJack-up point

CE1092-A

In case of emergency 6-5

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 219: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Installing the spare tire

The spare tire is designed for emergencyuse. See specific instructions under theheading “Wheels and tires” in the “8. Main-tenance and do-it-yourself” section.

1. Clean any mud or dirt from the surfacebetween the wheel and hub.

2. Carefully put the wheel on and tighten thewheel nuts finger tight. When replacing afront tire, make sure the hole in the spare tirewheel is aligned with the pin on the brakerotor.

3. With the wheel nut wrench, tighten wheel

nuts alternately and evenly in the sequenceillustrated (�1 - �5 ) until they are tight.

4. Lower the vehicle slowly until the tire touchesthe ground. Then, with the wheel nut wrench,tighten the wheel nuts securely in the se-quence as illustrated. Lower the vehicle com-pletely.

WARNING

� Incorrect wheel nuts or improperlytightened wheel nuts can cause thewheel to become loose or come off.This could cause an accident.

� Do not use oil or grease on the wheelstuds or nuts. This could cause thenuts to become loose.

� Retighten the wheel nuts when thevehicle has been driven for 600 miles(1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire,etc.).

As soon as possible tighten the wheel nutsto the specified torque with a torquewrench.

Wheel nut tightening torque:

80 ft-lb (108 N⋅m)

The wheel nuts must be kept tightened tospecification at all times. It is recom-mended that wheel nuts be tightened tospecification at each lubrication interval.

Adjust tire pressure to the COLD pressure.

COLD pressure:

After vehicle has been parked for threehours or more or driven less than 1 mile(1.6 km).

COLD tire pressures are shown on the Tireand Loading Information label affixed tothe driver’s side center pillar.

Stowing the damaged tire and tools

Securely store the spare tire and jacking equip-ment in the vehicle.

WARNING

� Always make sure that the spare tireand jacking equipment are properlysecured after use. Such items canbecome dangerous projectiles in an

SCE0039

6-6 In case of emergency

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 220: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

accident or sudden stop.

� The spare tire is designed for emer-gency use. See specific instructionsunder the heading “Wheels and tires”in the “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section of this manual.

To start your engine with a booster battery, theinstructions and precautions below must befollowed.

WARNING

� If done incorrectly, jump starting canlead to a battery explosion, resultingin severe injury or death. It could alsodamage your vehicle.

� Explosive hydrogen gas is alwayspresent in the vicinity of the battery.Keep all sparks and flames awayfrom the battery.

� Do not allow battery fluid to comeinto contact with eyes, skin, clothingor painted surfaces. Battery fluid is acorrosive sulfuric acid solution whichcan cause severe burns. If the fluidshould come into contact with any-thing, immediately flush the con-tacted area with water.

� Keep battery out of the reach of chil-dren.

� The booster battery must be rated at

12 volts. Use of an improperly ratedbattery can damage your vehicle.

� Whenever working on or near a bat-tery, always wear suitable eye protec-tors (for example, goggles or indus-trial safety spectacles) and removerings, metal bands, or any other jew-elry. Do not lean over the batterywhen jump starting.

� Do not attempt to jump start a frozenbattery. It could explode and causeserious injury.

JUMP STARTING

In case of emergency 6-7

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 221: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

Always follow the instructions below.Failure to do so could result in damageto the charging system and cause per-sonal injury.

1. If the booster battery is in another vehicle,position the two vehicles to bring their bat-teries into close proximity to each other.

Do not allow the two vehicles to touch.

2. Apply parking brake. Move the selector lever

to the P (Park) position (automatic transmis-sion models) or move the shift lever to the N(Neutral) position (manual transmission mod-els). Switch off all unnecessary electricalsystems (light, heater, air conditioner, etc.).

3. Remove vent caps on the battery (if soequipped). Cover the battery with an oldcloth to reduce explosion hazard.

4. Connect jumper cables in the sequence asillustrated. (�1 - �4 )

CAUTION

� Always connect positive (+) to posi-tive (+) and negative (−) to bodyground (for example, strut mountingbolt, etc. — not to the battery).

� Make sure that the jumper cables donot touch moving parts in the enginecompartment and that the cableclamps do not contact any othermetal.

5. Start the engine of the other vehicle and let itrun for a few minutes.

6. Keep the engine speed of the other vehicle atabout 2,000 rpm, and start your engine in thenormal manner.

CAUTION

Do not keep the starter motor engagedfor more than 10 seconds. If the enginedoes not start right away, turn the keyoff and wait 3 to 4 seconds before tryingagain.

SCE0664

6-8 In case of emergency

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 222: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

7. After starting your engine, carefully discon-nect the negative cable and then the positivecable.

8. Replace the vent caps (if so equipped). Besure to dispose of the cloth used to cover thevent holes as it may be contaminated withcorrosive acid.

Do not attempt to start the engine by pushing.

CAUTION

� Automatic transmission models can-not be push started. Attempting to doso may cause transmission damage.

� Three-way catalyst equipped modelsshould not be started by pushingsince the three-way catalyst may bedamaged.

� Never try to start the vehicle by tow-ing it; when the engine starts, theforward surge could cause the ve-hicle to collide with the tow vehicle.

WARNING

� Do not continue to drive if your ve-hicle overheats. Doing so couldcause engine damage or a vehiclefire.

� To avoid the danger of being scalded,never remove the radiator cap whilethe engine is still hot. When the ra-diator cap is removed, pressurizedhot water will spurt out, possiblycausing serious injury.

� Do not open the hood if steam iscoming out.

If your vehicle is overheating (indicated by anextremely high temperature gauge reading), or ifyou feel a lack of engine power, detect abnormalnoise, etc., take the following steps:

1. Move the vehicle safely off the road, apply theparking brake and move the shift lever to theN (Neutral) position (automatic transmissionto the P (Park) position).

Do not stop the engine.

2. Turn off the air conditioner. Open all the

PUSH STARTING IF YOUR VEHICLE OVERHEATS

In case of emergency 6-9

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 223: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

windows, and move the temperature controlto maximum hot and the fan control to highspeed.

3. If engine overheating is caused by climbing along hill on a hot day, run the engine at a fastidle (approximately 1,500 rpm) until the tem-perature gauge indication returns to normal.

4. Get out of the vehicle. Look and listen forsteam or coolant escaping from the radiatorbefore opening the hood. (If steam or coolantis escaping, turn off the engine.) Do not openthe hood further until no steam or coolant canbe seen.

5. Open the engine hood.

WARNING

If steam or water is coming from theengine, stand clear to prevent gettingburned.

6. Visually check if the cooling fan is running.The radiator hoses and radiator should notleak water.

If coolant is leaking or the cooling fan doesnot run, stop the engine.

WARNING

� Be careful not to allow your hands,hair, jewelry or clothing to come intocontact with, or get caught in, enginebelts or the engine cooling fan.

� The engine cooling fan can start atany time when the coolant tempera-ture is high.

7. After the engine cools down, check the cool-ant level in the reservoir tank with the enginerunning. Add coolant to the reservoir tank ifnecessary. Have your vehicle repaired at aNISSAN dealer.

When towing your vehicle, all State (Provincial inCanada) and local regulations for towing mustbe followed. Incorrect towing equipment coulddamage your vehicle. Towing instructions areavailable from a NISSAN dealer. Local serviceoperators are generally familiar with the appli-cable laws and procedures for towing. To assureproper towing and to prevent accidental damageto your vehicle, NISSAN recommends having aservice operator tow your vehicle. It is advisableto have the service operator carefully read thefollowing precautions.

WARNING

� Never ride in a vehicle that is beingtowed.

� Never get under your vehicle after ithas been lifted by a tow truck.

CAUTION

� When towing, make sure that thetransmission, axles, steering systemand powertrain are in working condi-

TOWING YOUR VEHICLE

6-10 In case of emergency

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 224: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

tion. If any unit is damaged, dolliesmust be used.

� Always attach safety chains beforetowing.

For information about towing your vehicle behinda recreational vehicle (RV), refer to “Flat towing”in the “9. Technical and consumer information”section of this manual.

TOWING RECOMMENDED BYNISSANNISSAN recommends that your vehicle betowed with the driving (rear) wheels off theground or place the vehicle on a flat bed truck asillustrated.

CAUTION

� Never tow automatic transmissionmodels with the rear wheels on the

SCE0342 SCE0489

In case of emergency 6-11

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 225: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

ground or four wheels on the ground(forward or backward) as this maycause serious and expensive damageto the transmission.If it is necessary to tow the vehiclewith the front wheels raised, alwaysuse towing dollies under the rearwheels.

� When towing rear wheel drive mod-els with the front wheels on theground or on towing dollies:

Turn the ignition key to the OFF po-sition, and secure the steering wheelin a straight ahead position with arope or similar device. Never securethe steering wheel by turning theignition key to the LOCK position.This may damage the steering lockmechanism.

VEHICLE RECOVERY (Freeing astuck vehicle)

Use the recovery hook by installing it in the frontof the vehicle. (The rear has no towing points.)

1. Remove the front license plate (if soequipped).

2. Remove the recovery hook cover�1 from thebumper.

3. Securely install the recovery hook�2 storedwith jacking tools.

Make sure that the hook is properly secured inthe stored place after use.

WARNING

� Stand clear of a stuck vehicle.

� Do not spin your tires at high speed.This could cause them to explodeand result in serious injury. Parts ofyour vehicle could also overheat andbe damaged.

CAUTION

� Tow chains or cables must be at-tached only to the main structuralmembers of the vehicle or the recov-ery hook. Otherwise, the vehicle bodywill be damaged.

� Do not use the vehicle tie downhooks to free a vehicle stuck in sand,snow, mud, etc. Never tow a vehicleusing the vehicle tie down hooks.

� Always pull the cable straight outfrom the front of the vehicle. Neverpull on the vehicle at an angle.

SCE0605

6-12 In case of emergency

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 226: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� Pulling devices should be routed sothey do not touch any part of thesuspension, steering, brake or cool-ing systems.

� Pull devices such as ropes or canvasstraps are not recommended for usein vehicle towing or recovery.

If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc.,use the following procedure:

1. Turn off the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC)system or Traction Control System (TCS) (ifso equipped).

2. Make sure the area in front and behind thevehicle is clear of obstructions.

3. Turn the steering wheel right and left to clearan area around the front tires.

4. Slowly rock the vehicle forward and back-ward.

� Shift back and forth between R (reverse) andD (drive) (automatic transmission models) or1st (low) and R (reverse) (manual transmis-sion models).

� Apply the accelerator as little as possible tomaintain the rocking motion.

� Release the accelerator pedal before shiftingbetween R and D (automatic transmissionmodels) or 1st and R (manual transmissionmodels).

� Do not spin the tires above 35 MPH (55km/h).

5. If the vehicle cannot be freed after a few tries,contact a professional towing service to re-move the vehicle.

In case of emergency 6-13

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 227: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

MEMO

6-14 In case of emergency

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 228: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

7 Appearance and care

Cleaning exterior ................................................................... 7-2Washing ............................................................................ 7-2Waxing ............................................................................... 7-3Removing spots .............................................................. 7-3Underbody ........................................................................ 7-3Glass .................................................................................. 7-3Aluminum alloy wheels .................................................. 7-4Chrome parts ................................................................... 7-4Tire dressing .................................................................... 7-4

Cleaning interior .................................................................... 7-5Floor mats ......................................................................... 7-5Seat belts ......................................................................... 7-6

Corrosion protection ............................................................ 7-6Most common factors contributing to vehiclecorrosion ........................................................................... 7-6Environmental factors influence the rate ofcorrosion ........................................................................... 7-6To protect your vehicle from corrosion ..................... 7-6

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 229: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

In order to maintain the appearance of yourvehicle, it is important to take proper care of it.

In the following cases, please wash your vehicleas soon as possible to protect the paint surface.

� After a rainfall to prevent possible damagefrom acid rain

� After driving on coastal roads

� When contaminants such as soot, bird drop-pings, tree sap, metal particles or bugs get onthe paint surface

� When dust or mud builds up on the surface

Whenever possible, store or park your vehicleinside a garage or in a covered area.

When it is necessary to park outside, park in ashady area or protect the vehicle with a bodycover.

Be careful not to scratch the paint surfacewhen putting on or removing the bodycover.

WASHINGWash dirt off the vehicle with a wet sponge andplenty of water. Clean the vehicle thoroughlyusing a mild soap, a special vehicle soap or ageneral purpose dish-washing liquid mixed withclean, lukewarm (never hot) water.

CAUTION

� Do not use car washes that use acidin the detergent. Some car washes,especially brushless ones, use someacid for cleaning. The acid may reactwith some plastic vehicle compo-nents, causing them to crack. Thiscould affect their appearance, andalso could cause them not to functionproperly. Always check with your carwash to confirm that acid is not used.

� Do not use strong household soap,strong chemical detergents, gasolineor solvents.

� Do not wash the vehicle in directsunlight or while the vehicle body ishot, as the surface may becomewater-spotted.

� Avoid using tight-napped or roughcloths, such as washing mitts. Caremust be taken when removingcaked-on dirt or other foreign sub-stances so the paint surface is notscratched or damaged.

� For Roadster models, observe thefollowing:• Do not use an automatic car washor a high pressure car wash. Thesoft top may be damaged.

• Avoid applying direct water pres-sure, such as high pressured waterfrom household hoses, on the lin-ing of the soft top and vehiclebody. Avoid applying continuouswater on the parts around the softtop and the windows. These maycause water to leak into the insideof your vehicle.

Rinse the vehicle again with plenty of cleanwater.

Inside flanges, seams and folds on the doors,hatches and hood are particularly vulnerable tothe effects of road salt. Therefore, these areasmust be regularly cleaned. Make sure that thedrain holes in the lower edge of the door areopen. Spray water under the body and in thewheel wells to loosen the dirt and wash awayroad salt.

Avoid leaving water spots on the paint surfaceby using a damp chamois to dry the vehicle.

CLEANING EXTERIOR

7-2 Appearance and care

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 230: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Soft top care and cleaning (Roadstermodels)

Proper care and handling should be observed tomaintain a good appearance of the soft top.Improper care may cause the top cloth’s surfaceto stiffen, stain, or mat. Follow the instructionsshown in this section.

It is not necessary to wash the soft top everytime you wash the vehicle body, but clean thetop regularly before it becomes quite dirty. Leav-ing the soft top dirty or soiled for a long periodwill cause deterioration to the quality of the topmaterial.

Remove dust or dirt on the soft top with a softbrush or sponge, then rinse it with plenty ofclean water. When the top is quite dirty, washusing a mild detergent, such as a generalcleaner especially made for a cloth top or ageneral purpose dish-washing liquid, mixed withclean, lukewarm (never hot) water. Rinse the topagain with plenty of clean water to remove alltraces of soap.

CAUTION

� Do not use strong household soap,strong chemical detergents, gasoline

or solvents.

� If glass cleaner gets on the soft top,immediately wash it off with cleanwater.

� Do not apply direct water pressure,such as high pressured water fromhousehold hoses, on the lining of thesoft top and vehicle body, as this maycause water to leak into the inside ofyour vehicle.

After cleaning, always be sure the top and itsstorage are completely dry before opening thetop. Opening the top while it is wet or damp maycause interior water damage, water stains ormildew on the top.

WAXING

Regular waxing protects the paint surface andhelps retain new vehicle appearance. Polishingis recommended to remove built-up wax residueand to avoid a weathered appearance beforereapplying wax.

A NISSAN dealer can assist you in choosing theproper product.

� Wax your vehicle only after a thorough wash-

ing. Follow the instructions supplied with thewax.

� Do not use a wax containing any abrasives,cutting compounds or cleaners that maydamage the vehicle finish.

Machine compounding or aggressive polishingon a base coat/clear coat paint finish may dullthe finish or leave swirl marks.

REMOVING SPOTS

Remove tar and oil spots, industrial dust, insects,and tree sap as quickly as possible from thesurface of the paint to avoid lasting damage orstaining. Special cleaning products are availableat a NISSAN dealer or any automotive accessorystore.

UNDERBODYIn areas where road salt is used in winter, theunderbody must be cleaned regularly. This willprevent dirt and salt from building up and caus-ing underbody and suspension corrosion. Be-fore the winter period and again in the spring, theunderseal must be checked and, if necessary,re-treated.

GLASSUse glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust filmfrom the glass surfaces. It is normal for glass to

Appearance and care 7-3

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 231: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

become coated with a film after the vehicle isparked in the hot sun. Glass cleaner and a softcloth will easily remove this film.

CAUTION

� When cleaning the inside of the win-dows, do not use sharp-edged tools,abrasive cleaners or chlorine-baseddisinfectant cleaners. They coulddamage the electrical conductors orrear window defroster elements.

� If glass cleaner gets on the soft top,immediately wash it off with cleanwater. (Roadster models)

ALUMINUM ALLOY WHEELS

Wash regularly with a sponge dampened in amild soap solution, especially during wintermonths in areas where road salt is used. Saltcould discolor the wheels if not removed.

CAUTION

Follow the directions below to avoid

staining or discoloring the wheels:

� Do not use a cleaner that uses strongacid or alkali contents to clean thewheels.

� Do not apply wheel cleaners to thewheels when they are hot. The wheeltemperature should be the same asambient temperature.

� Rinse the wheel to completely re-move the cleaner within 15 minutesafter the cleaner is applied.

CHROME PARTS

Clean all chrome parts regularly with a non-abrasive chrome polish to maintain the finish.

TIRE DRESSING

NISSAN does not recommend the use of tiredressings. Tire manufacturers apply a coating tothe tires to help reduce discoloration of therubber. If a tire dressing is applied to the tires, itmay react with the coating and form a com-pound. This compound may come off the tirewhile driving and stain the vehicle paint.

If you choose to use a tire dressing, take thefollowing precautions:

� Use a water-based tire dressing. The coatingon the tire dissolves more easily with anoil-based tire dressing.

� Apply a light coat of tire dressing to helpprevent it from entering the tire tread/grooves(where it would be difficult to remove).

� Wipe off excess tire dressing using a drytowel. Make sure the tire dressing is com-pletely removed from the tire tread/grooves.

� Allow the tire dressing to dry as recom-mended by tire dressing manufacturer.

7-4 Appearance and care

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 232: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Occasionally remove loose dust from the interiortrim, plastic parts and seats using a vacuumcleaner or soft bristled brush. Wipe the vinyl andleather surfaces with a clean, soft cloth damp-ened in mild soap solution, then wipe clean witha dry soft cloth.

Regular care and cleaning is required in order tomaintain the appearance of the leather.

Before using any fabric protector, read themanufacturer’s recommendations. Some fabricprotectors contain chemicals that may stain orbleach the seat material.

Use a cloth dampened only with water, to cleanthe meter and gauge lens.

CAUTION

� Never use benzine, thinner or anysimilar material.

� Small dirt particles can be abrasiveand damaging to leather surfacesand should be removed promptly. Donot use saddle soap, car waxes, pol-ishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents,detergents or ammonia-based clean-ers as they may damage the leather

natural finish.

� Never use fabric protectors unlessrecommended by the manufacturer.

� Do not use glass or plastic cleaner onmeter or gauge lens covers. It maydamage the lens cover.

FLOOR MATSThe use of genuine NISSAN floor mats canextend the life of your vehicle carpet and make iteasier to clean the interior. No matter whatmats are used, be sure they are fitted foryour vehicle and are properly positioned inthe footwell to prevent interference withpedal operation. Mats should be maintainedwith regular cleaning and replaced if they be-come excessively worn.

Floor mat positioning aid(driver’s side only)This model includes a front floor mat bracket toact as a floor mat positioning aid. NISSAN floormats have been specially designed for yourvehicle model. The driver’s side floor mat has agrommet hole incorporated in it. Simply positionthe mat by placing the floor mat bracket throughthe floor mat grommet hole while centering themat in the floorpan contour.

Periodically check to make certain that the matsare properly positioned.

SAI0012

CLEANING INTERIOR

Appearance and care 7-5

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 233: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

SEAT BELTSThe seat belts can be cleaned by wiping themwith a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution.Allow the belts to dry completely before usingthem. See “Seat belt maintenance” in the “1.Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplementalrestraint system” section.

WARNING

Do not allow wet seat belts to roll up inthe retractor. NEVER use bleach, dye orchemical solvents to clean the seatbelts, since these may severely weakenthe seat belt webbing.

MOST COMMON FACTORSCONTRIBUTING TO VEHICLECORROSION� The accumulation of moisture-retaining dirtand debris in body panel sections, cavities,and other areas.

� Damage to paint and other protective coat-ings caused by gravel and stone chips orminor traffic accidents.

ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORSINFLUENCE THE RATE OFCORROSION

MoistureAccumulation of sand, dirt and water on thevehicle body underside can accelerate corro-sion. Wet floor coverings will not dry completelyinside the vehicle, and should be removed fordrying to avoid floor panel corrosion.

Relative humidityCorrosion will be accelerated in areas of highrelative humidity, especially those areas wherethe temperatures stay above freezing and whereatmospheric pollution exists and road salt isused.

TemperatureA temperature increase will accelerate the rateof corrosion to those parts which are not wellventilated.

Air pollutionIndustrial pollution, the presence of salt in the airin coastal areas, or heavy road salt use willaccelerate the corrosion process. Road salt willalso accelerate the disintegration of paint sur-faces.

TO PROTECT YOUR VEHICLEFROM CORROSION� Wash and wax your vehicle often to keep thevehicle clean.

� Always check for minor damage to the paintand repair it as soon as possible.

� Keep drain holes at the bottom of the doorsopen to avoid water accumulation.

� Check the underbody for accumulation ofsand, dirt or salt. If present, wash with wateras soon as possible.

CORROSION PROTECTION

7-6 Appearance and care

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 234: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CAUTION

� Never remove dirt, sand or other de-bris from the passenger compart-ment by washing it out with a hose.Remove dirt with a vacuum cleaner orbroom.

� Never allow water or other liquids tocome in contact with electronic com-ponents inside the vehicle as thismay damage them.

Chemicals used for road surface de-icing areextremely corrosive. They accelerate corrosionand deterioration of underbody componentssuch as the exhaust system, fuel and brake lines,brake cables, floor pan and fenders.

In winter, the underbody must be cleanedperiodically.

For additional protection against rust and corro-sion, which may be required in some areas,consult a NISSAN dealer.

Appearance and care 7-7

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 235: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

MEMO

7-8 Appearance and care

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 236: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Maintenance requirements ................................................. 8-2General maintenance ........................................................... 8-2Explanation of general maintenance items ............... 8-2

Maintenance precautions ................................................... 8-5Engine compartment check locations ............................. 8-7Engine cooling system ........................................................ 8-8Checking engine coolant level .................................... 8-8Changing engine coolant ............................................. 8-9

Engine oil ................................................................................ 8-9Checking engine oil level .............................................. 8-9Changing engine oil and filter ................................... 8-10

Automatic transmission fluid ........................................... 8-12Power steering fluid .......................................................... 8-12Brake and clutch fluid ....................................................... 8-13Brake fluid ....................................................................... 8-13Clutch fluid ..................................................................... 8-14

Window washer fluid ........................................................ 8-14Battery ................................................................................... 8-15Jump starting ................................................................. 8-16

Drive belts ............................................................................ 8-17Spark plugs ......................................................................... 8-17

Replacing spark plugs ................................................ 8-17Air cleaners .......................................................................... 8-18Windshield wiper blades ................................................. 8-19Cleaning ......................................................................... 8-19Replacing ....................................................................... 8-20

Brakes ................................................................................... 8-21Self-adjusting brakes .................................................. 8-21Brake pad wear indicators ......................................... 8-21

Fuses ..................................................................................... 8-21Engine compartment ................................................... 8-22Passenger compartment ............................................ 8-23

Keyfob battery replacement.............................................. 8-24Lights ..................................................................................... 8-26Headlights ...................................................................... 8-27Exterior and interior lights .......................................... 8-28

Wheels and tires ................................................................ 8-30Tire pressure ................................................................. 8-30Tire labeling..................................................................... 8-34Types of tires ................................................................. 8-36Tire chains ...................................................................... 8-37Changing wheels and tires ........................................ 8-37

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 237: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Your new NISSAN has been designed to haveminimum maintenance requirements with longservice intervals to save you both time andmoney. However, some day-to-day and regularmaintenance is essential to maintain yourNISSAN’s good mechanical condition, as wellas its emission and engine performance.

It is the owner’s responsibility to make sure thatscheduled maintenance, as well as generalmaintenance, is performed.

As the vehicle owner, you are the only one whocan ensure that your vehicle receives the propermaintenance care. You are a vital link in themaintenance chain.

Scheduled maintenance:

For your convenience, both required and op-tional scheduled maintenance items are de-scribed and listed in your “NISSAN Service andMaintenance Guide”. You must refer to thatguide to ensure that necessary maintenance isperformed on your NISSAN at regular intervals.

General maintenance:

General maintenance includes those itemswhich should be checked during normal day-to-day operation. They are essential for propervehicle operation. It is your responsibility toperform these procedures regularly as pre-scribed.

Performing general maintenance checks re-quires minimal mechanical skill and only a fewgeneral automotive tools.

These checks or inspections can be done byyourself, a qualified technician or, if you prefer, aNISSAN dealer.

Where to go for service:

If maintenance service is required or your vehicleappears to malfunction, have the systemschecked and tuned by a NISSAN dealer.

NISSAN technicians are well-trained specialistsand are kept up to date with the latest serviceinformation through technical bulletins, servicetips, and in-dealership training programs. Theyare completely qualified to work on NISSANvehicles before they work on your vehicle,rather than after they have worked on it.

You can be confident that a NISSAN dealer’sservice department performs the best job tomeet the maintenance requirements of your ve-hicle — in a reliable and economic way.

During the normal day-to-day operation of thevehicle, general maintenance should be per-formed regularly as prescribed in this section. Ifyou detect any unusual sounds, vibrations orsmells, be sure to check for the cause or have aNISSAN dealer do it promptly. In addition, youshould notify a NISSAN dealer if you think thatrepairs are required.

When performing any checks or maintenancework, closely observe the “Maintenance precau-tions” later in this section.

EXPLANATION OF GENERALMAINTENANCE ITEMSAdditional information on the followingitems with “*” is found later in this section.

Outside the vehicleThe maintenance items listed here should beperformed from time to time, unless otherwisespecified.

Doors and engine hood: Check that all doorsand the engine hood operate smoothly as well asthe trunk lid or back hatch. Also make sure thatall latches lock securely. Lubricate if necessary.Make sure that the secondary latch keeps thehood from opening when the primary latch isreleased.

When driving in areas using road salt or other

MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS GENERAL MAINTENANCE

8-2 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 238: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

corrosive materials, check lubrication frequently.

Lights*: Clean the headlights on a regular basis.Make sure that the headlights, stop lights, taillights, turn signal lights, and other lights are alloperating properly and installed securely. Alsocheck headlight aim.

Road wheel nuts (lug nuts)*:When checkingthe tires, make sure no nuts are missing, andcheck for any loose nuts. Tighten if necessary.

Tire rotation*: Tires cannot be rotated in thisvehicle.

Tires*: Check the pressure with a gauge oftenand always prior to long distance trips. Adjustthe pressure in all tires, including the spare, tothe pressure specified. Check carefully for dam-age, cuts or excessive wear.

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)transmitter components: Replace the TPMStransmitter grommet seal, valve core and capwhen the tires are replaced due to wear or age.

Wheel alignment and balance: If the vehiclepulls to either side while driving on a straight andlevel road, or if you detect uneven or abnormaltire wear, there may be a need for wheel align-ment.

If the steering wheel or seat vibrates at normal

highway speeds, wheel balancing may beneeded.

For additional information regarding tires, refer to“Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “TireSafety Information” (Canada) in the WarrantyInformation Booklet.

Windshield: Clean the windshield on a regularbasis. Check the windshield at least every sixmonths for cracks or other damage. Have adamaged windshield repaired by a qualified re-pair facility.

Windshield wiper blades*: Check for cracksor wear if they do not wipe properly.

Inside the vehicleThe maintenance items listed here should bechecked on a regular basis, such as whenperforming periodic maintenance, cleaning thevehicle, etc.

Automatic transmission P (Park) positionmechanism:On a fairly steep hill check that thevehicle is held securely with the selector lever inthe P (Park) position without applying anybrakes.

Accelerator pedal: Check the pedal forsmooth operation and make sure the pedal doesnot catch or require uneven effort. Keep the floormat away from the pedal.

Brake pedal: Check the pedal for smoothoperation. If the brake pedal suddenly goesdown further than normal, the pedal feels spongyor the vehicle seems to take longer to stop, seea NISSAN dealer immediately. Keep the floormat away from the pedal.

Brakes: Check that the brakes do not pull thevehicle to one side when applied. Check thebrake booster function. Be sure to keep floor mataway from the pedal.

Parking brake: Check the parking brake op-eration regularly. The vehicle should be securelyheld on a fairly steep hill with only the parkingbrake applied. If the parking brake needs to beadjusted, see a NISSAN dealer.

Seats: Check seat position controls such asseat adjusters, seatback recliner, etc. to ensurethey operate smoothly and that all latches locksecurely in every position. Check that the headrestraints move up and down smoothly and thatthe locks (if equipped) hold securely in alllatched positions.

Seat belts: Check that all parts of the seat beltsystem (for example, buckles, anchors, adjustersand retractors) operate properly and smoothly,and are installed securely. Check the belt web-bing for cuts, fraying, wear or damage.

Steering wheel: Check for changes in the

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-3

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 239: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

steering conditions, such as excessive free play,hard steering or strange noises.

Warning lights and chimes:Make sure that allwarning lights and chimes are operating prop-erly.

Windshield wiper and washer*: Check thatthe wipers and washer operate properly and thatthe wipers do not streak.

Windshield defroster: Check that the aircomes out of the defroster outlets properly andin good quantity when operating the heater or airconditioner.

Under the hood and the vehicle

The maintenance items listed here should bechecked periodically (for example, each time youcheck the engine oil or refuel).

Battery*: Check the fluid level in each cell. Itshould be between the MAX and MIN lines.Vehicles operated in high temperatures or undersevere conditions require frequent checks of thebattery fluid level.

Brake and clutch fluid levels*:Make sure thatthe brake and clutch fluid levels are between theMAX and MIN lines on the reservoir.

Engine coolant level*: Check the coolant levelwhen the engine is cold.

Engine drive belts*: Make sure that no belt isfrayed, worn, cracked or oily.

Engine oil level*: Check the level on thedipstick after parking the vehicle on a level spot,turning off the engine and waiting 10 minutes.

Exhaust system: Make sure there are no loosesupports, cracks or holes. If the sound of theexhaust seems unusual or there is a smell ofexhaust fumes, immediately locate the troubleand correct it. (See “Precautions when startingand driving” in the “5. Starting and driving”section for exhaust gas (carbon monoxide).)

Fluid leaks: Check under the vehicle for fuel,oil, water or other fluid leaks after the vehicle hasbeen parked for a while. Water dripping from theair conditioner after use is normal. If you shouldnotice any leaks or if gasoline fumes are evident,check for the cause and have it corrected imme-diately.

Power steering fluid level* and lines: Checkthe level in the reservoir tank with the engine off.Check the lines for proper attachment, leaks,cracks, etc.

Radiator and hoses: Check the front of theradiator and clean off any dirt, insects, leaves,etc., that may have accumulated. Make sure thehoses have no cracks, deformation, deteriorationor loose connections.

Underbody: The underbody is frequently ex-posed to corrosive substances such as thoseused on icy roads or to control dust. It is veryimportant to remove these substances, other-wise rust will form on the floor pan, frame, fuellines and around the exhaust system. At the endof winter, the underbody should be thoroughlyflushed with plain water, being careful to cleanthose areas where mud and dirt may accumu-late. For additional information, see “Cleaningexterior” in the “7. Appearance and care” sec-tion.

Window washer fluid*: Check that there isadequate fluid in the tank.

8-4 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 240: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

When performing any inspection or maintenancework on your vehicle, always take care to preventserious accidental injury to yourself or damage tothe vehicle. The following are general precau-tions which should be closely observed.

WARNING

� Park the vehicle on a level surface,apply the parking brake securely andblock the wheels to prevent the ve-hicle from moving. For manual trans-mission models, move the shift leverto N (Neutral) position. For automatictransmission models, move the se-lector lever to P (Park).

� Be sure the ignition key is in the OFFor LOCK position when performingany parts replacement or repairs.

� If you must work with the enginerunning, keep your hands, clothing,hair and tools away from movingfans, belts and any other movingparts.

� It is advisable to secure or removeany loose clothing and remove any

jewelry, such as rings, watches, etc.before working on your vehicle.

� Always wear eye protection when-ever you work on your vehicle.

� If you must run the engine in anenclosed space such as a garage, besure there is proper ventilation forexhaust gases to escape.

� Never get under the vehicle while it issupported only by a jack. If it is nec-essary to work under the vehicle,support it with safety stands.

� Keep smoking materials, flame andsparks away from the fuel tank andbattery.

� On gasoline engine models with themultiport fuel injection (MFI) system,the fuel filter or fuel lines should beserviced by a NISSAN dealer becausethe fuel lines are under high pressureeven when the engine is off.

CAUTION

� Do not work under the hood whilethe engine is hot. Turn the engine offand wait until it cools down.

� Avoid contact with used engine oiland coolant. Improperly disposed en-gine oil, engine coolant and/or othervehicle fluids can damage the envi-ronment. Always conform to localregulations for disposal of vehiclefluid.

� Never connect or disconnect the bat-tery or any transistorized componentwhile the ignition switch is in the ONposition.

� Never leave the engine or automatictransmission related component har-nesses disconnected while the igni-tion switch is in the ON position.

This “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” sectiongives instructions regarding only those itemswhich are relatively easy for an owner to perform.

A genuine NISSAN Service Manual is also avail-

MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-5

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 241: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

able. See “Owner’s Manual/Service Manual or-der information” in the “9. Technical and con-sumer information” section.

You should be aware that incomplete or im-proper servicing may result in operating difficul-ties or excessive emissions, and could affectyour warranty coverage. If in doubt about anyservicing, have it done by a NISSAN dealer.

8-6 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 242: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Fuse/fusible link holder

2. Battery

3. Engine oil filler cap

4. Brake fluid reservoir

5. Clutch fluid reservoir (M/T models)

6. Window washer fluid reservoir

7. Power steering fluid reservoir

8. Air cleaner

9. Radiator filler cap

10. Engine drive belts

11. Engine coolant reservoir

12. Engine oil dipstick

Do not tamper with the strut tower baradjustment �A . The strut tower bar hasbeen adjusted to the most suitable posi-tion at the factory.

CAUTION

Tampering with the strut tower bar ad-justment may cause a noise while driv-ing or damage to the hood or engine.

SDI2050

ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECKLOCATIONS

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-7

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 243: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The engine cooling system is filled at the factorywith a high-quality, year-round, anti-freeze cool-ant solution. The anti-freeze solution containsrust and corrosion inhibitors, therefore additionalcooling system additives are not necessary.

WARNING

� Never remove the radiator or coolantreservoir cap when the engine is hot.Wait until the engine and radiatorcool down. Serious burns could becaused by high pressure fluid escap-ing from the radiator. See precau-tions in “If your vehicle overheats”found in the “6. In case of emer-gency” section of this manual.

� The radiator is equipped with a pres-sure type radiator cap. To preventengine damage, use only a genuineNISSAN radiator cap.

Outside temperaturedown to Anti-

freeze

Deminer-alizedwater/distilledwater°C °F

−35 −30 50% 50%

CAUTION

When adding or replacing coolant, besure to use only a Genuine NISSANLong Life Antifreeze/Coolant (green) orequivalent with the proper mixture ratioof 50% anti-freeze and 50% demineral-ized water/distilled water. The use ofother types of coolant solutions maydamage your engine cooling system.

CHECKING ENGINE COOLANTLEVEL

Check the coolant level in the reservoir tankwhen the engine is cold. If the coolant level isbelow MIN �1 , add coolant up to the MAX �2level. If the reservoir tank is empty, check thecoolant level in the radiatorwhen the engine iscold. If there is insufficient coolant in the radia-tor, fill the radiator with coolant up to the filleropening and also add it to the reservoir tank upto the MAX �2 level.Tighten the cap securely after adding enginecoolant.

SDI2051

ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM

8-8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 244: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

If the engine cooling system frequentlyrequires coolant, have it checked by aNISSAN dealer.

CHANGING ENGINE COOLANT

Contact a NISSAN dealer if replacement isrequired.

� Major cooling system repairs should be per-formed by a NISSAN dealer. The serviceprocedures can be found in the appropriateNISSAN Service Manual.

� Improper servicing can result in reducedheater performance and engine overheating.

WARNING

� To avoid being scalded, never changethe coolant when the engine is hot.

� Never remove the radiator cap whenthe engine is hot. Serious burnscould be caused by high pressurefluid escaping from the radiator.

� Avoid direct skin contact with usedcoolant. If skin contact is made, washthoroughly with soap or hand cleaneras soon as possible.

� Keep coolant out of reach of childrenand pets.

Engine coolant must be disposed of properly.Check your local regulations.

CHECKING ENGINE OIL LEVEL1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and applythe parking brake.

2. Start the engine and let it idle until it reachesthe operating temperature.

3. Turn off the engine. Wait more than 10minutes for the oil to drain back into theoil pan.

4. Remove the dipstick and wipe it clean. Rein-sert it all the way.

SDI2045

ENGINE OIL

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-9

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 245: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

5. Remove the dipstick again and check the oillevel. It should be between the H and L marks�1 . If the oil level is below the L mark �2 ,remove the oil filler cap and pour recom-mended oil through the opening. Do notoverfill �3 .

6. Recheck oil level with the dipstick.

It is normal to add some oil between oilmaintenance intervals or during thebreak-in period, depending on the severityof operating conditions.

CAUTION

Oil level should be checked regularly.Operating the engine with an insuffi-cient amount of oil can damage theengine, and such damage is not coveredby warranty.

CHANGING ENGINE OIL ANDFILTERChange the engine oil and filter according to themaintenance log shown in the “NISSAN Serviceand Maintenance Guide”.

Vehicle set-up

1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and applythe parking brake.

2. Start the engine and let it idle until it reachesthe operating temperature.

3. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10minutes.

4. Raise and support the vehicle using a suit-able floor jack and safety jack stands.

� Place the safety jack stands under the vehiclejack-up points.

� A suitable adapter should be attached to thejack stand saddle.

5. Remove the plastic engine undercover.

a. Remove the small plastic clip at the centerpoint of the undercover.

b. Then remove the other bolts that hold theundercover in place.

CAUTION

Make sure the correct lifting and sup-port points are used to avoid vehicledamage.

Engine oil and filter

1. Place a large drain pan under the drain plug�1 .

2. Remove the oil filler cap.3. Remove the drain plug with a wrench andcompletely drain the oil.

WARNING

� Prolonged and repeated contact withused engine oil may cause skincancer.

SDI2052

8-10 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 246: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

� Try to avoid direct skin contact withused oil. If skin contact is made,wash thoroughly with soap or handcleaner as soon as possible.

� Keep used engine oil out of reach ofchildren.

CAUTION

Be careful not to burn yourself, as theengine oil is hot.

� Waste oil must be disposed of properly.� Check your local regulations.

Perform steps 4 to 7 when the engine oil filterchange is needed.

4. Loosen the oil filter with an oil filter wrench�2 . Remove the oil filter by turning it by hand.

5. Wipe the engine oil filter mounting surfacewith a clean rag.

CAUTION

Be sure to remove any old gasket mate-rial remaining on the mounting surfaceof the engine. Failure to do so couldlead to engine damage.

6. Coat the gasket on the new filter with cleanengine oil.

7. Screw in the oil filter clockwise until a slightresistance is felt, then tighten additionallymore than 2/3 turn.

Oil filter tightening torque:11 to 15 ft-lb(14.7 to 20.5 N⋅m)

8. Clean and re-install the drain plug and a newwasher. Securely tighten the drain plug with awrench.

Drain plug tightening torque:22 to 29 ft-lb(29 to 39 N⋅m)

Do not use excessive force.9. Refill engine with recommended oil and in-stall the cap securely.

CAUTION

The dipstick must be inserted in place toprevent oil spillage from the dipstickhole while filling the engine with oil.

See “Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants” in the “9. Technical and consumerinformation” section for drain and refill capac-ity. The drain and refill capacity depends onthe oil temperature and drain time. Use thesespecifications for reference only. Always usethe dipstick to determine the proper amountof oil in the engine.

10. Start the engine and check for leakagearound the drain plug and the oil filter.Correct as required.

11. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10minutes. Check the oil level with the dip-stick. Add engine oil if necessary.

After the operation1. Install the engine undercover into position asoutlined in the following steps.

a. Pull the center of the small plastic clip out.

b. Hold the engine undercover into position.

c. Insert the clip through the undercover into the

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-11

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 247: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

hole in the frame, then push the center of theclip in to lock the clip in place.

d. Install the other bolts that hold the under-cover in place. Be careful not to strip thebolts or over-tighten them.

2. Lower the vehicle carefully to the ground.

3. Dispose of waste oil and filter properly.

When checking or replacement is required, werecommend a NISSAN dealer for servicing.

CAUTION

� Use only Genuine NISSAN Matic JATF. Do not mix with other fluids.

� Using automatic transmission fluidother than Genuine NISSAN Matic JATF will cause deterioration in drive-ability and automatic transmissiondurability, and may damage the auto-matic transmission, which is not cov-ered by the NISSAN new vehicle lim-ited warranty. Check the fluid level in the reservoir tank.

The fluid level should be checked using the HOTrange at fluid temperatures of 122 - 176°F (50 -80°C) or using the COLD range at fluid tem-peratures of 32 - 86°F (0 - 30°C).

If the fluid is below the MIN line, add GenuineNISSAN PSF fluid. Remove the cap and fillthrough the opening.

SDI1443

AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSIONFLUID

POWER STEERING FLUID

8-12 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 248: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CAUTION

� Do not overfill.

� Recommended fluid is GenuineNISSAN PSF or equivalent.

For more information regarding suitable equiva-lents, see “Capacities and recommendedfuel/lubricants” in the “9. Technical and con-sumer information” section.

For additional brake and clutch fluid information,refer to “Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants” in the “9. Technical and consumerinformation” section of this manual.

WARNING

� Use only new fluid from a sealedcontainer. Old, inferior or contami-nated fluid may damage the brakesystem. The use of improper fluidscan damage the brake system andaffect the vehicle’s stopping ability.

� Clean the filler cap before removing.

� Brake fluid is poisonous and shouldbe stored carefully in marked con-tainers out of the reach of children.

CAUTION

Do not spill the fluid on any paintedsurfaces. This will damage the paint. Iffluid is spilled, immediately wash thesurface with water.

BRAKE FLUIDCheck the fluid level in the reservoir. If the fluid isbelow the MIN line�2 or the brake warning lightcomes on, add Genuine NISSAN Super HeavyDuty Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT 3 fluid up tothe MAX line �1 . If fluid must be added fre-quently, the system should be thoroughlychecked by a NISSAN dealer.

SDI1923

BRAKE AND CLUTCH FLUID

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-13

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 249: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CLUTCH FLUIDCheck the fluid level in the reservoir. If the fluidlevel is below the MIN line �2 , add GenuineNISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid orequivalent DOT 3 fluid up to the MAX line �1 .If fluid is added frequently, the system should bethoroughly checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Add fluid when the low washer fluid warning lightcomes on.

Add a washer solvent to the washer fluid forbetter cleaning. In the winter season, add awindshield washer anti-freeze. Follow the manu-facturer’s instructions for the mixture ratio.

Recommended fluid is Genuine NISSAN Wind-shield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Anti-freeze or equivalent.

WARNING

Anti-freeze is poisonous and should bestored carefully in marked containersout of the reach of children.

CAUTION

� Do not substitute engine anti-freezecoolant for window washer solution.This may result in damage to thepaint.

� Do not fill the window washer reser-voir tank with washer fluid concen-trates at full strength. Some methylalcohol based washer fluid concen-trates may permanently stain thegrille if spilled while filling the win-dow washer reservoir tank.

� Pre-mix washer fluid concentrateswith water to the manufacturer’s rec-ommended levels before pouring thefluid into the window washer reser-voir tank. Do not use the window

SDI1906 SDI2053

WINDOW WASHER FLUID

8-14 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 250: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

washer reservoir tank to mix thewasher fluid concentrate and water.

� Keep the battery surface clean and dry. Cleanthe battery with a solution of baking soda andwater.

� Make certain the terminal connections areclean and securely tightened.

� If the vehicle is not to be used for 30 days orlonger, disconnect the (−) negative batteryterminal to prevent discharging it.

CAUTION

When the battery cable is removed fromthe battery terminal, do not close eitherof the front doors. The automatic win-dow adjusting function will not work,and the side roof panel/top side railmay be damaged by doing so.

To disconnect the negative (−) battery ter-minal, perform the procedure in the follow-ing order. Otherwise, the window and theside roof panel/top side rail may contactand be damaged.

1. Close the windows.

2. Open the hood.

3. Close and lock all the doors using thekey or keyfob.

4. Disconnect the negative (−) battery ter-minal.

5. Securely close the hood.

To connect the negative (−) battery termi-nal, perform the procedure in the followingorder. Otherwise, the window and the sideroof panel/top side rail may contact and bedamaged.

1. Unlock (using the key) and open thedriver side door. Do not close the door.

2. Open the hood.

3. Connect the negative (−) battery termi-nal. Then close the hood.

4. Fully open the driver side door window.

5. Close the driver side door and the win-dow.

WARNING

� Do not expose the battery to flamesor electrical sparks. Hydrogen gas,generated by battery fluid, is explo-sive. Do not allow battery fluid to

BATTERY

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-15

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 251: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

contact your skin, eyes, fabrics, orpainted surfaces. After touching abattery or battery cap, do not touchor rub your eyes. Thoroughly washyour hands. If the acid contacts youreyes, skin or clothing, immediatelyflush with water for at least 15 min-utes and seek medical attention.

� Do not operate the vehicle if the fluidin the battery is low. Low battery fluidcan cause a higher load on the bat-tery which can generate heat, reducebattery life, and in some cases leadto an explosion.

� When working on or near a battery,always wear suitable eye protectionand remove all jewelry.

� Battery posts, terminals and relatedaccessories contain lead and leadcompounds. Wash hands after han-dling.

� Keep the battery out of the reach ofchildren.

Check the fluid level in each cell. It should bebetween the UPPER LEVEL �1 and LOWERLEVEL �2 lines.If it is necessary to add fluid, add only distilledwater to bring the level to the indicator in eachfiller opening. Do not overfill.

Vehicles operated in high temperatures or undersevere conditions require frequent checks of thebattery fluid level.

1. Remove the cell plugs �A .2. Add distilled water up to the UPPER LEVELline �1 .

3. Tighten cell plugs.

JUMP STARTINGIf jump starting is necessary, see “Jump starting”in the “6. In case of emergency” section. If theengine does not start by jump starting, thebattery may have to be replaced. Contact aNISSAN dealer.

DI0137MA SDI1480

8-16 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 252: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Power steering fluid pump

2. Alternator

3. Crankshaft pulley

4. Air conditioner compressor

5. Drive belt auto-tensioner

WARNING

Be sure the ignition key is in the OFF orLOCK position before servicing drivebelts. The engine could rotate

unexpectedly.

1. Visually inspect each belt for signs of unusualwear, cuts, fraying, oil adhesion or looseness.If the belt is in poor condition or loose, haveit replaced or adjusted by a NISSAN dealer.

2. Have the belts checked regularly for condi-tion.

REPLACING SPARK PLUGSIf replacement is required, see a NISSAN dealerfor servicing.

WARNING

Be sure the engine and ignition switchare off and that the parking brake isengaged securely.

CAUTION

Be sure to use the correct socket toremove the spark plugs. An incorrectsocket can damage the spark plugs.

SDI2061

DRIVE BELTS SPARK PLUGS

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-17

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 253: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Iridium-tipped spark plugsIt is not necessary to replace the iridium-tippedspark plugs as frequently as the conventionaltype spark plugs since they will last much longer.Follow the maintenance log shown in the“NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide”, butdo not service iridium-tipped spark plugs bycleaning or regapping.

Always replace spark plugs with recom-mended or equivalent ones.

To remove the filter from the air cleaner, pull offthe retainers �1 and pull the unit upward �2 .The filter element should not be cleaned andreused. Replace it according to the maintenancelog shown in the “NISSAN Service and Mainte-nance Guide”. When replacing the filter, wipe

the inside of the air cleaner housing and thecover with a damp cloth.

WARNING

� Operating the engine with the aircleaner removed can cause you orothers to be burned. The air cleanernot only cleans the air, it stops theflame if the engine backfires. If it isnot there, and the engine backfires,you could be burned. Do not drivewith the air cleaner removed, and becareful when working on the enginewith the air cleaner removed.

� Never pour fuel into the throttle bodyor attempt to start the engine withthe air cleaner removed. Doing socould result in serious injury.

SDI2020

SDI2054

AIR CLEANERS

8-18 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 254: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

CAUTION

� After wiper blade replacement, returnthe wiper arm to its original position.

Otherwise it may be damaged whenthe engine hood is opened.

� Make sure the wiper blades contactthe glass; otherwise the arms may bedamaged from wind pressure.

� Worn windshield wiper blades candamage the windshield and impairdriver vision.

CLEANING

If your windshield is not clear after using thewindshield washer or if a wiper blade chatterswhen running, wax or other material may be onthe blade or windshield.

Clean the outside of the windshield with awasher solution or a mild detergent. Your wind-shield is clean if beads do not form when rinsingwith clear water.

Clean the blade by wiping it with a cloth soakedin a washer solution or a mild detergent. Then

rinse the blade with clear water. If your wind-shield is still not clear after cleaning the bladesand using the wiper, replace the blades.

WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-19

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 255: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

REPLACINGReplace the wiper blades if they are worn.

1. Pull the wiper arm.

2. Push the release tab�A , then move the wiperblade down the wiper arm to remove �1 .

3. Insert the new wiper blade onto the wiper armuntil a click sounds.

If necessary, clean the windshield washernozzle �A with a needle or small pin �B .*1: Only for passenger’s side wiper arm*2: Adjustable washer nozzles

SDI1649

SDI1730A

8-20 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 256: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

If the brakes do not operate properly, have thebrakes checked by a NISSAN dealer.

SELF-ADJUSTING BRAKES

Your vehicle is equipped with self-adjustingbrakes.

The disc-type brakes self-adjust every time thebrake pedal is applied.

WARNING

See a NISSAN dealer for a brake systemcheck if the brake pedal height does notreturn to normal.

BRAKE PAD WEAR INDICATORS

The disc brake pads on your vehicle have au-dible wear indicators. When a brake pad re-quires replacement, it will make a high pitchedscraping or screeching sound when the vehicleis in motion whether or not the brake pedal isdepressed. Have the brakes checked as soon aspossible if the wear indicator sound is heard.

Under some driving or climate conditions, occa-sional brake squeak, squeal or other noise maybe heard. Occasional brake noise during light tomoderate stops is normal and does not affect

the function or performance of the brake system.

Proper brake inspection intervals shouldbe followed. For additional information, see theappropriate maintenance log shown in theNISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide.

Some vehicles are equipped with engine com-partment and passenger compartment fuseboxes that use only type �A fuses. Other ve-hicles are equipped with type �A fuses in theengine compartment fuse box and type�B fusesin the passenger compartment fuse box.

Type�A fuses are provided as spare fuses. Theyare stored in the passenger compartment fusebox.

Type �A fuses can be installed in the enginecompartment and passenger compartment fuseboxes.

SDI1751

BRAKES FUSES

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-21

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 257: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

If a type �A fuse is used to replace a type �Bfuse, the type �A fuse will not be level with thefuse pocket as shown in the illustration. This willnot affect the performance of the fuse. Makesure the fuse is installed in the fuse box securely.

Type�B fuses cannot be installed in the under-hood fuse boxes. Only use type�A fuses in theunderhood fuse boxes.

ENGINE COMPARTMENT

CAUTION

Never use a fuse of a higher or loweramperage rating than that specified onthe fuse box cover. This could damagethe electrical system or cause a fire.

If any electrical equipment does not operate,check for an open fuse.

1. Be sure the ignition switch and headlightswitch are OFF.

2. Open the engine hood and remove the coveron the battery and the fuse/fusible link holder.

3. Remove the fuse/fusible link holder cover bypushing the tabs�1 and lifting the cover�2 .

4. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller. Thefuse puller is located in the passenger com-partment fuse box.

5. If the fuse is open �A , replace it with a newfuse �B . Spare fuses are stored in the pas-senger compartment fuse box.

6. If a new fuse also opens, have the electricalsystem checked and repaired by a NISSANdealer.

SDI1752 SDI1479B SDI1753

8-22 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 258: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Fusible linksIf any electrical equipment does not operate andfuses are in good condition, check the fusiblelinks. If any of these fusible links are melted,replace only with genuine NISSAN parts.

PASSENGER COMPARTMENT

CAUTION

Never use a fuse of a higher or loweramperage rating than that specified onthe fuse box cover. This could damagethe electrical system or cause a fire.

If any electrical equipment does not operate,check for an open fuse.

1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlightswitch are OFF.

2. Open the fuse box lid �1 .3. Pinch the fuse perpendicularly with the fusepuller �2 and pull it out.

SDI1962

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-23

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 259: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

4. If the fuse is open �A , replace it with a newfuse �B . Spare fuses �3 are stored in thefuse box.

5. If a new fuse also opens, have the electricalsystem checked and repaired by a NISSANdealer.

CAUTION

Be careful not to allow children to swal-low the battery and removed parts.

Replace the battery as follows:

1. Open the lid using a suitable tool.

2. Replace the battery with a new one.

Recommended battery:CR2025 or equivalent

SDI1754

SDI1608

KEYFOB BATTERYREPLACEMENT

8-24 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 260: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Make sure that the ⊕ side faces thebottom case.

� Do not touch the internal circuit and electricterminals as doing so could cause a malfunc-tion.

3. Close the lid securely.

4. Push the keyfob button two or three times tocheck its operation.

See a NISSAN dealer if you need any assistancefor replacement.

If the battery is removed for any reasonother than replacement, perform step 4above.

� Be careful not to touch the circuit boardand the battery terminal.

� An improperly disposed battery canharm the environment. Always confirmlocal regulations for battery disposal.

� The keyfob is water-resistant; however,if it gets wet, immediately wipe it com-pletely dry.

� When changing batteries, do not letdust or oil get on the keyfob.

FCC Notice:

Changes or modifications not expressly

approved by the party responsible for com-pliance could void the user’s authority tooperate the equipment.

This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules and RSS-210 of IndustryCanada.

Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) This device may not causeharmful interference, and (2) this devicemust accept any interference received, in-cluding interference that may cause undes-ired operation of the device.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-25

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 261: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

�1 Front view1. Headlight (low-beam, high-beam)

2. Spot light

3. Front park light

4. Front turn signal light

5. Front side marker light

�2 Rear view (Coupe),�3 Rear view (Roadster)6. Luggage compartment light (Coupe) or Trunklight (Roadster)

7. High-mounted stop light

8. Rear combination light(Side marker, Stop/Tail)

9. License plate lights

10. Rear combination light(Back-up, Turn signal)

SDI2058

LIGHTS

8-26 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 262: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

HEADLIGHTS

ReplacingIf replacement is required, see a NISSAN dealer.

Xenon headlight bulb:

WARNING

HIGH VOLTAGE

When xenon headlights are on, theyproduce a high voltage. To prevent anelectric shock, never attempt to modifyor disassemble. Always have your xe-non headlights replaced at a NISSANdealer. For additional information, see“Headlight and turn signal switch” inthe “2. Instruments and controls” sec-tion.

CAUTION

Use the same number and wattage asoriginally installed:Bulb no. (Wattage)D2S (35W) - Xenon low/high-beam

Fog may temporarily form inside the lens of theexterior lights in the rain or in a car wash. Atemperature difference between the inside andthe outside of the lens causes the fog. This is nota malfunction. If large drops of water collectinside the lens, contact a NISSAN dealer.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-27

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 263: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

EXTERIOR AND INTERIOR LIGHTS

Item Wattage (W) Bulb No.

Front turn signal light* 28/8 3457NA

Front park light* 5 T10

Front side marker light* (LED) —

Rear combination light (Upper)

Stop/Tail* (LED) —

Side marker* (LED) —

Rear combination light (Lower)

Back-up* 21 T20

Turn signal* 21 T20

License plate light (x 2) 5 T10

High-mounted stop light* (LED) —

Spot light 8 —

Luggage compartment light (Coupe) 5 —

Trunk light (Roadster)* 3.4 —

Vanity mirror light 1.8 —

Cup holder light* 1.1 —

Rear floor box light* 1.4 —

*: See a NISSAN dealer for replacement.NOTE: Always check with the Parts Department at a NISSAN dealer for the latest information about parts.

Replacement proceduresAll other lights are either type A, B, C or D. Whenreplacing a bulb, first remove the lens and/orcover.

MDI0006

8-28 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 264: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Interior light (Roadster)

Be careful not to snap the nails�A on the plasticcover when removing it.

SDI1450A

SDI1572

SDI1779

SDI1451

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-29

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 265: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

TIRE PRESSURE

Tire Pressure Monitoring System(TPMS)This vehicle is equipped with the Tire PressureMonitoring System (TPMS). It monitors tire pres-sure of all tires except the spare. When the lowtire pressure warning light is lit, one or more ofyour tires is significantly under-inflated.

The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle isdriven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). Also,this system may not detect a sudden drop in tirepressure (for example a flat tire while driving).

For more details, refer to “Low tire pressurewarning light” in the “2. Instruments and con-trols” section, “Tire pressure monitoring system(TPMS)” in the “5. Starting and driving” section,and “Flat tire” in the “6. In case of emergency”section.

Tire inflation pressure

Check the tire pressures (including thespare) often and always prior to longdistance trips. The recommended tirepressure specifications are shown on theTire and Loading Information label underthe “COLD TIRE PRESSURE” heading.The Tire and Loading Information label isaffixed to the driver side center pillar. Tirepressures should be checked regularlybecause:

� Most tires naturally lose air over time.

� Tires can lose air suddenly whendriven over potholes or other objectsor if the vehicle strikes a curb whileparking.

The tire pressures should be checkedwhen the tires are cold. The tires areconsidered COLD after the vehicle hasbeen parked for 3 or more hours, ordriven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) at mod-erate speeds.

SDI1401A

WHEELS AND TIRES

8-30 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 266: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Incorrect tire pressure, including un-der inflation, may adversely affecttire life and vehicle handling.

WARNING

� Improperly inflated tires can failsuddenly and cause an acci-dent.

� The Gross Vehicle Weight Rat-ing (GVWR) is located on theF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certifica-tion label. The vehicle weightcapacity is indicated on the Tireand Loading Information label.Do not load your vehicle be-yond this capacity. Overloadingyour vehicle may result in re-duced tire life, unsafe operatingconditions due to prematuretire failure, or unfavorable han-dling characteristics and couldalso lead to a serious accident.Loading beyond the specified

capacity may also result in fail-ure of other vehicle compo-nents.

� Before taking a long trip, orwhenever you heavily load yourvehicle, use a tire pressuregauge to ensure that the tirepressures are at the specifiedlevel.

� Do not drive your vehicle over85 MPH (137 km/h) unless it isequipped with high speed ratedtires. Driving faster than 85MPH (137 km/h) may result intire failure, loss of control andpossible injury.

� For additional information re-garding tires, refer to “Impor-tant Tire Safety Information”(US) or “Tire Safety Informa-tion” (Canada) in the WarrantyInformation Booklet.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-31

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 267: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Tire and Loading Information label

�1 Seating capacity: The maximumnumber of occupants that can beseated in the vehicle.

�2 Vehicle load limit: See loading infor-mation in the “Technical and con-sumer information” section.

�3 Original size: The size of the tires

originally installed on the vehicle atthe factory.

�4 Cold tire pressure: Inflate the tires tothis pressure when the tires are cold.Tires are considered COLD after thevehicle has been parked for 3 ormore hours, or driven less than 1mile (1.6 km) at moderate speeds.The recommended cold tire inflationis set by the manufacturer to providethe best balance of tire wear, vehiclehandling, driveability, tire noise, etc.,up to the vehicle’s GVWR.

�5 Tire size — refer to “Tire labeling”later in this section.

�6 Spare tire size or compact spare tiresize (if so equipped).

SDI1948

8-32 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 268: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Checking the tire pressure

1. Remove the valve stem cap from thetire.

2. Press the pressure gauge squarelyonto the valve stem. Do not press toohard or force the valve stem sideways,or air will escape. If the hissing soundof air escaping from the tire is heardwhile checking the pressure, reposi-tion the gauge to eliminate this leak-age.

3. Remove the gauge.

4. Read the tire pressure on the gaugestem and compare it to the specifica-tion shown on the Tire and LoadingInformation label.

5. Add air to the tire as needed. If toomuch air is added, press the core ofthe valve stem briefly with the tip of thegauge stem to release pressure. Re-check the pressure and add or releaseair as needed.

6. Install the valve stem cap.

7. Check the pressure of all other tires,including the spare.

Coupemodel Size

Cold TireInflationPressure

FrontOriginalTire

225/45R18245/40R18

240 kPa(35 psi)

RearOriginalTire

245/45R18265/35R19

240 kPa(35 psi)

SpareTire T145/80D17 420 kPa

(60 psi)

Roadstermodel Size

Cold TireInflationPressure

FrontOriginalTire

225/45R18 240 kPa(35 psi)

RearOriginalTire

245/45R18 240 kPa(35 psi)

SpareTire T145/80D17 420 kPa

(60 psi)

SDI1949

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-33

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 269: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

TIRE LABELING

Federal law requires tire manufacturersto place standardized information on thesidewall of all tires. This information iden-tifies and describes the fundamentalcharacteristics of the tire and also pro-vides the tire identification number (TIN)for safety standard certification. The TINcan be used to identify the tire in case ofa recall.

�1 Tire size (example: P215/65R1595H)

1. P: The “P” indicates the tire is de-signed for passenger vehicles. (Not alltires have this information.)

2. Three-digit number (215): This num-ber gives the width in millimeters of thetire from sidewall edge to sidewalledge.

3. Two-digit number (65): This number,known as the aspect ratio, gives the

tire’s ratio of height to width.

4. R: The “R” stands for radial.

5. Two-digit number (15): This number isthe wheel or rim diameter in inches.

6. Two- or three-digit number (95): Thisnumber is the tire’s load index. It is ameasurement of how much weighteach tire can support. You may notfind this information on all tires be-cause it is not required by law.

7. Tire Speed Rating. You should notdrive the vehicle faster than the tirespeed rating.

SDI1575Example

SDI1951Example

8-34 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 270: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

�2 TIN (Tire Identification Number) for anew tire (example: DOT XX XX XXXXXXX)

1. DOT: Abbreviation for the “Depart-ment of Transportation”. Thesymbol can be placed above,below or to the left or right of theTire Identification Number.

2. Two-digit code: Manufacturer’s identi-fication mark

3. Two-digit code: Tire size

4. Three-digit code: Tire type code (Op-tional)

5. Three-digit code: Date of Manufacture

6. Four numbers represent the week andyear the tire was built. For example, thenumbers 3103 means the 31st weekof 2003. If these numbers are missing,then look on the other sidewall of thetire.

�3 Tire ply composition and materialThe number of layers or plies ofrubber-coated fabric in the tire. Tiremanufacturers also must indicate thematerials in the tire, which includesteel, nylon, polyester, and others.

�4 Maximum permissible inflation pres-sureThis number is the greatest amountof air pressure that should be put inthe tire. Do not exceed the maximumpermissible inflation pressure.

�5 Maximum load ratingThis number indicates the maximum

load in kilograms and pounds thatcan be carried by the tire. Whenreplacing the tires on the vehicle,always use a tire that has the sameload rating as the factory installedtire.

�6 Term of “tubeless” or “tube type”Indicates whether the tire requires aninner tube (“tube type”) or not(“tubeless”).

�7 The word “radial”The word “radial” is shown if the tirehas radial structure.

�8 Manufacturer or brand nameManufacturer or brand name isshown.

Other tire-related terminology:

In addition to the many terms that aredefined throughout this section, IntendedOutboard Sidewall is (1) the sidewall thatcontains a whitewall, bears white letter-ing or bears manufacturer, brand, and/ormodel name molding that is higher ordeeper than the same molding on the

SDI1607Example

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-35

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 271: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

other sidewall of the tire, or (2) theoutward facing sidewall of an asymmetri-cal tire that has a particular side that mustalways face outward when mounted on avehicle.

TYPES OF TIRES

WARNING

� When changing or replacing tires, besure all four tires are of the sametype (i.e., Summer, All Season orSnow) and construction. A NISSANdealer may be able to help you withinformation about tire type, size,speed rating and availability.

� Replacement tires may have a lowerspeed rating than the factoryequipped tires, and may not matchthe potential maximum vehiclespeed. Never exceed the maximumspeed rating of the tire.

� Replacing tires with those not origi-nally specified by NISSAN could af-fect the proper operation of the tire

pressure monitoring system (TPMS).

� For additional information regardingtires, refer to “Important Tire SafetyInformation” (US) or “Tire Safety In-formation” (Canada) in the WarrantyInformation Booklet.

All season tires

NISSAN specifies all season tires on somemodels to provide good performance for use allyear round, including snowy and icy road condi-tions. All season tires are identified by ALLSEASON and/or M&S on the tire sidewall. Snowtires have better snow traction than all seasontires and may be more appropriate in someareas.

Summer tires

NISSAN specifies summer tires on some modelsto provide superior performance on dry roads.Summer tire performance in snow and ice will besubstantially reduced. Summer tires do not havethe tire traction rating M&S on the tire sidewall.

If you operate your vehicle in snowy or icyconditions, NISSAN recommends the use ofsnow or all season tires on all four wheels.

Snow tiresIf snow tires are needed, it is necessary to selecttires equivalent in size and load rating to theoriginal equipment tires. If you do not, it canadversely affect the safety and handling of yourvehicle.

Generally, snow tires will have lower speedratings than factory equipped tires and may notmatch the potential maximum vehicle speed.Never exceed the maximum speed rating of thetire.

If you operate your vehicle in snowy or icyconditions, NISSAN recommends the use ofsnow or all season tires on all four wheels.

For additional traction on icy roads, studded tiresmay be used. However, some provinces andstates prohibit their use. Check local, state andprovincial laws before installing studded tires.Skid and traction capabilities of studded snowtires, on wet or dry surfaces, may be poorer thanthat of non-studded snow tires.

8-36 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 272: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

TIRE CHAINS

CAUTION

Tire chains/cables should not be in-stalled on 265/35R19 size tires. Installa-tion of the tire chains/cables on265/35R19 size tires will cause damageto the vehicle. If you plan to use tirechains/cables, you should install245/45R18 size tires on your vehicle.

Use of tire chains may be prohibited accordingto location. Check the local laws before installingtire chains. When installing tire chains, makesure they are of proper size for the tires on yourvehicle and are installed according to the chainmanufacturer’s suggestions. Use only SAEclass “S” chains. Class “S” chains are used onvehicles with restricted tire to vehicle clearance.Vehicles that can use Class “S” chains aredesigned to meet the SAE standard minimumclearances between the tire and the closestvehicle suspension or body component requiredto accommodate the use of a winter tractiondevice (tire chains or cables). The minimumclearances are determined using the factoryequipped tire size. Other types may damageyour vehicle. Use chain tensioners when recom-

mended by the tire chain manufacturer to ensurea tight fit. Loose end links of the tire chain mustbe secured or removed to prevent the possibilityof whipping action damage to the fenders orundercarriage. If possible, avoid fully loadingyour vehicle when using tire chains. In addition,drive at a reduced speed. Otherwise, your ve-hicle may be damaged and/or vehicle handlingand performance may be adversely affected.

� Never install the tire chains on a T-typespare tire.

� Do not use the tire chains on dry roads.

� Tire chains must be installed only on therear wheels and not on the front wheels.

CHANGING WHEELS AND TIRES

Tire rotation

Tires cannot be rotated in this vehicle, asfront tires are different size from rear tiresand the direction of wheel rotation is fixedin each tire.

A pin is on the front brake rotor to preventthe rear wheels from being installed inplace of the front wheels. The spare tirecan be installed in place of the front andrear wheels. When installing the sparetire in the front wheel, the hole in thespare tire wheel must be aligned with thepin on the brake rotor.

WARNING

� Retighten the wheel nuts when thevehicle has been driven for 600 miles(1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire,etc.).

� For additional information regardingtires, refer to “Important Tire Safety

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-37

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 273: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Information” (US) or “Tire Safety In-formation” (Canada) in the WarrantyInformation Booklet.

1. Wear indicator2. Wear indicator location mark

Tire wear and damage

WARNING

� Tires should be periodically in-spected for wear, cracking,bulging or objects caught in thetread. If excessive wear, cracks,bulging or deep cuts are found,

the tire(s) should be replaced.

� The original tires have built-intread wear indicators. When thewear indicators are visible, thetire(s) should be replaced.

� Tires degrade with age and use.Have tires, including the spare,over 6 years old checked by aqualified technician becausesome tire damage may not beobvious. Replace the tires asnecessary to prevent tire failureand possible personal injury.

� Improper service of the sparetire may result in serious per-sonal injury. If it is necessary torepair the spare tire, contact aNISSAN dealer.

� For additional information re-garding tires, refer to “Impor-tant Tire Safety Information”(US) or “Tire Safety Informa-

SDI1663

8-38 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 274: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

tion” (Canada) in the WarrantyInformation Booklet.

Replacing wheels and tires

When replacing a tire, use the same size, speedrating and load carrying capacity as originallyequipped. See “Specifications” in the “9. Tech-nical and consumer information” section for rec-ommended types and sizes of tires and wheels.

WARNING

� The use of tires other than thoserecommended or the mixed use oftires of different brands, construction(bias, bias-belted or radial), or treadpatterns can adversely affect the ride,braking, handling, ground clearance,body-to-tire clearance, tire chainclearance, speedometer calibration,headlight aim and bumper height.Some of these effects may lead toaccidents and could result in seriouspersonal injury.

� If the wheels are changed for any

reason, always replace with wheelswhich have the same off-set dimen-sion. Wheels of a different off-setcould cause premature tire wear,possibly degraded vehicle handlingcharacteristics and/or interferencewith the brake discs/drums. Such in-terference can lead to decreasedbraking efficiency and/or early brakepad/shoe wear.

� When a spare tire is mounted or awheel is replaced, the TPMS will notfunction and the low tire pressurewarning light will flash for approxi-mately 1 minute. The light will remainon after 1 minute. Contact yourNISSAN dealer as soon as possiblefor tire replacement and/or systemresetting.

� Replacing tires with those not origi-nally specified by NISSAN could af-fect the proper operation of theTPMS.

� Do not install a deformed wheel ortire even if it has been repaired. Such

wheels or tires could have structuraldamage and could fail without warn-ing.

� The use of retread tire is not recom-mended.

� For additional information regardingtires, refer to “Important Tire SafetyInformation” (US) or “Tire Safety In-formation” (Canada) in the WarrantyInformation Booklet.

Wheel balanceUnbalanced wheels may affect vehicle handlingand tire life. Even with regular use, wheels canget out of balance. Therefore, they should bebalanced as required.

Wheel balance service should be performedwith the wheels off the vehicle. Spin balancingthe front wheels on the vehicle could lead totransmission damage.

For additional information regarding tires, refer to“Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “TireSafety Information” (Canada) in the WarrantyInformation booklet.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-39

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 275: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Care of wheels

� Wash the wheels when washing the vehicleto maintain their appearance.

� Clean the inner side of the wheels when thewheel is changed or the underside of thevehicle is washed.

� Do not use abrasive cleaners when washingthe wheels.

� Inspect wheel rims regularly for dents orcorrosion. Such damage may cause loss ofpressure or poor seal at the tire bead.

� NISSAN recommends that the road wheelsbe waxed to protect against road salt in areaswhere it is used during winter.

Spare tire (T-type spare tire)Observe the following precautions if the T-typespare tire must be used, otherwise your vehiclecould be damaged or involved in an accident.

CAUTION

� The T-type spare tire should be usedfor emergency use only. It should bereplaced by the standard tire at thefirst opportunity.

� Drive carefully while the T-type sparetire is installed.Avoid sharp turns and abrupt brakingwhile driving.

� Periodically check the T-type sparetire inflation pressure, and alwayskeep it at 60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 bar).

� Do not drive your vehicle at speedsfaster than 50 MPH (80 km/h).

� Do not use tire chains on a T-typespare tire. Tire chains will not fitproperly on the T-type spare tire andmay cause damage to the vehicle.

� Tire tread of the T-type spare tire willwear at a faster rate than the stan-dard tire. Replace the T-type sparetire as soon as the tread wear indica-tors appear.

� Because the T-type spare tire issmaller than the original tire, groundclearance is reduced. To avoid dam-age to the vehicle, do not drive overobstacles. Also, do not drive the ve-hicle through an automatic car wash

since it may get caught.

� Do not use the T-type spare tire onother vehicles.

� Do not use more than one T-typespare tire at the same time.

� Do not tow a trailer while the T-typespare tire is installed.

8-40 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 276: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

9 Technical and consumer information

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants .............. 9-2Fuel recommendation .................................................... 9-3Engine oil and oil filter recommendation .................. 9-5Air conditioner system refrigerant and lubricantrecommendations ........................................................... 9-6

Specifications ........................................................................ 9-7Engine ................................................................................. 9-7Wheels and tires .............................................................. 9-8Dimensions and weights ............................................... 9-8

When traveling or registering your vehicle in anothercountry ..................................................................................... 9-9Vehicle identification ............................................................ 9-9Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate ................. 9-9Vehicle identification number (chassis number) ..... 9-9Engine serial number ................................................... 9-10F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label ................ 9-10Emission control information label ........................... 9-10Tire and loading information label ............................ 9-11Air conditioner specification label ............................ 9-11

Installing front license plate ............................................. 9-12

Vehicle loading information ............................................. 9-13Terms ............................................................................... 9-13Vehicle load capacity.................................................... 9-14Loading tips .................................................................... 9-16Measurement of weights ............................................. 9-16

Towing a trailer ................................................................... 9-17Maximum load limits .................................................... 9-17Towing safety ................................................................ 9-18

Flat towing............................................................................. 9-21Automatic transmission ................................................ 9-22Manual transmission ..................................................... 9-22

Uniform tire quality grading ............................................. 9-22Emission control system warranty ................................. 9-23Reporting safety defects (US only) ............................... 9-23Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M) test(US only) .............................................................................. 9-24Event data recorders ......................................................... 9-25Owner’s Manual/Service Manual order information ... 9-26In the event of a collision ........................................... 9-26

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 277: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

The following are approximate capacities. The actual refill capacities may be a little different. When refilling, follow the procedureinstructed in the “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section to determine the proper refill capacity.

Capacity (Approximate)RecommendedspecificationsUS

measureImp

measure Liter

Fuel 20 gal 16-5/8 gal 76 Unleaded premium gasoline with an octane rating of at least 91 AKI (RON 96)*1

Engine oil (Drain and refill)*2

With oil filter change 5-1/8 qt 4-3/8 qt 4.9 � Engine oil with API Certification Mark*3� Viscosity SAE 5W-30Without oil filter change 4-7/8 qt 4 qt 4.6

Cooling system

With reservoir 9-1/2 qt 7-7/8 qt 9.0 50% Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant or equivalent50% Demineralized or distilled waterReservoir 7/8 qt 3/4 qt 0.8

Automatic transmission fluid — — — Genuine NISSAN Matic J ATF*4

Manual transmission gear oil — — — Genuine NISSAN Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) HQ Multi 75W-85 or API GL-4, ViscositySAE 75W-85 or 75W-90

Differential gear oil — — — Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super GL-5 80W-90 or API GL-5, Viscosity SAE80W-90*5

Power steering fluid (PSF) Refill to the proper fluid level according to the instructions inthe “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.

Genuine NISSAN PSF or equivalent*6

Brake and clutch fluid Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid*7 or equivalent DOT 3

Multi-purpose grease — — — NLGI No. 2 (Lithium soap base)

Air conditioning system refrigerant — — — HFC-134a (R-134a)*8

Air conditioning system lubricants — — — NISSAN A/C System Oil Type S or exact equivalent

Windshield washer fluid — — — Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Anti-freeze or equivalent

*1: For additional information, see “Fuel recommendation” later in this section.*2: For additional information, see “Engine oil” in the “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section for changing engine oil.*3: For additional information, see “Engine oil and oil filter recommendation” later in this section.*4: Using automatic transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN Matic J ATF will cause deterioration in driveability and automatic transmissiondurability, and may damage the automatic transmission, which is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty.

*5: For hot areas, viscosity SAE 90 is suitable for ambient temperatures above 32°F (0°C).*6: Canada NISSAN Automatic Transmission Fluid or DEXRONTM VI type ATF may also be used.*7: Available in mainland US through a NISSAN dealer.*8: For additional information, see “Vehicle identification” in this section for air conditioner specification label.

CAPACITIES ANDRECOMMENDED FUEL/LUBRICANTS

9-2 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 278: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

FUEL RECOMMENDATION

Use unleaded premium gasoline with an octanerating of at least 91 AKI (Anti-Knock Index)number (Research octane number 96).

If premium gasoline is not available, unleadedregular gasoline with an octane rating of 87 AKInumber (Research octane number 91) may betemporarily used, but only under the followingprecautions:

� Have the fuel tank filled only partially withunleaded regular gasoline, and fill up withunleaded premium gasoline as soon as pos-sible.

� Avoid full throttle driving and abrupt accelera-tion.

However, for maximum vehicle perfor-mance, the use of unleaded premium gaso-line is recommended.

CAUTION

� Using a fuel other than that specifiedcould adversely affect the emissioncontrol system, and may also affectthe warranty coverage.

� Under no circumstances should aleaded gasoline be used, becausethis will damage the three-way cata-lyst.

� Do not use E-85 fuel in your vehicle.Your vehicle is not designed to runon E-85 fuel. Using E-85 fuel candamage the fuel system componentsand is not covered by the NISSANvehicle limited warranty.

Gasoline specifications

NISSAN recommends using gasoline that meetsthe World-Wide Fuel Charter (WWFC) specifi-cations where it is available. Many of the auto-mobile manufacturers developed this specifica-tion to improve emission control system andvehicle performance. Ask your service stationmanager if the gasoline meets the WWFCspecifications.

Reformulated gasoline

Some fuel suppliers are now producing reformu-lated gasolines. These gasolines are speciallydesigned to reduce vehicle emissions. NISSANsupports efforts towards cleaner air and sug-

gests that you use reformulated gasoline whenavailable.

Gasoline containing oxygenatesSome fuel suppliers sell gasoline containingoxygenates such as ethanol, MTBE and metha-nol with or without advertising their presence.NISSAN does not recommend the use of fuels ofwhich the oxygenate content and the fuel com-patibility for your NISSAN cannot be readilydetermined. If in doubt, ask your service stationmanager.

If you use oxygenate-blend gasoline, please takethe following precautions as the usage of suchfuels may cause vehicle performance problemsand/or fuel system damage.

� The fuel should be unleaded and havean octane rating no lower than thatrecommended for unleaded gasoline.

� If an oxygenate-blend, excepting amethanol blend, is used, it should con-tain no more than 10% oxygenate.(MTBE may, however, be added up to15%.)

� If a methanol blend is used, it shouldcontain no more than 5% methanol (me-thyl alcohol, wood alcohol). It shouldalso contain a suitable amount of ap-propriate cosolvents and corrosion in-

Technical and consumer information 9-3

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 279: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

hibitors. If not properly formulated withappropriate cosolvents and corrosioninhibitors, such methanol blends maycause fuel system damage and/or ve-hicle performance problems. At thistime, sufficient data is not available toensure that all methanol blends aresuitable for use in NISSAN vehicles.

If any undesirable driveability problems such asengine stalling and hard hot starting are experi-enced after using oxygenate-blend fuels, imme-diately change to a non-oxygenate fuel or a fuelwith a low blend of MTBE.

Take care not to spill gasoline during refu-eling. Gasoline containing oxygenates cancause paint damage.

E-85 fuelE-85 fuel is a mixture of approximately 85% fuelethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline. E-85 canonly be used in a Flexible Fuel Vehicle (FFV). Donot use E-85 fuel in your vehicle. U.S. govern-ment regulations require fuel ethanol dispensingpumps to be identified by a small, square, or-ange and black label with the common abbre-viation or the appropriate percentage for thatregion.

Aftermarket fuel additives

NISSAN does not recommend the use of anyaftermarket fuel additives (for example, fuel in-jector cleaner, octane booster, intake valve de-posit removers, etc.) which are sold commer-cially. Many of these additives intended for gum,varnish or deposit removal may contain activesolvents or similar ingredients that can be harm-ful to the fuel system and engine.

Octane rating tips

Using unleaded gasoline with an octanerating lower than recommended can causepersistent, heavy spark knock. (Sparkknock is a metallic rapping noise.) If se-vere, this can lead to engine damage. If youdetect a persistent heavy spark knock evenwhen using gasoline of the above statedoctane rating, or if you hear steady sparkknock while holding a steady speed onlevel roads, have your dealer correct thecondition. Failure to correct the conditionis misuse of the vehicle, for which NISSANis not responsible.

Incorrect ignition timing will result in knocking,after-run or overheating. This in turn may causeexcessive fuel consumption or damage to theengine. If any of the above symptoms are en-countered, have your vehicle checked at a

NISSAN dealer or other competent service fa-cility.

However, now and then you may noticelight spark knock for a short time whileaccelerating or driving up hills. This is nocause for concern, because you get thegreatest fuel benefit when there is lightspark knock for a short time under heavyengine load.

9-4 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 280: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

�1 API certification mark�2 API service symbol

ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTERRECOMMENDATION

Selecting the correct oil

It is essential to choose the correct grade,quality and viscosity engine oil to ensure satis-factory engine life and performance. See “Ca-pacities and recommended fuel/lubricants” ear-lier in this section. NISSAN recommends the useof an energy conserving oil in order to improvefuel economy.

Select only engine oils that meet the AmericanPetroleum Institute (API) certification or Interna-tional Lubricant Standardization and ApprovalCommittee (ILSAC) certification and SAE vis-cosity standard. These oils have the API certifi-cation mark on the front of the container. Oilswhich do not have the specified quality labelshould not be used as they could cause enginedamage.

Oil additivesNISSAN does not recommend the use of oiladditives. The use of an oil additive is notnecessary when the proper oil type is used andmaintenance intervals are followed.

Oil which may contain foreign matter or hasbeen previously used should not be used.

Oil viscosity

The engine oil viscosity or thickness changeswith temperature. Because of this, it is importantthat the engine oil viscosity be selected basedon the temperatures at which the vehicle will beoperated before the next oil change. Choosingan oil viscosity other than that recommendedcould cause serious engine damage.

Selecting the correct oil filterYour new NISSAN vehicle is equipped with ahigh-quality genuine NISSAN oil filter. Whenreplacing, use a genuine NISSAN oil filter or itsequivalent for the reason described in “Changeintervals”.

Change intervalsThe oil and oil filter change intervals for yourengine are based on the use of the specifiedquality oils and filters. Oil and filter other than thespecified quality, or oil and filter change intervalslonger than recommended could reduce enginelife. Damage to engines caused by impropermaintenance or use of incorrect oil and filterquality and/or viscosity is not covered by thenew NISSAN vehicle limited warranties.

Your engine was filled with a high quality engine

STI0505

Technical and consumer information 9-5

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 281: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

oil when it was built. You do not have to changethe oil before the first recommended changeinterval. Oil and filter change intervals dependupon how you use your vehicle.

Operation under the following conditions mayrequire more frequent oil and filter changes:

� repeated short distance driving at cold out-side temperatures

� driving in dusty conditions

� extensive idling

� towing a trailer

� stop and go commuting

Refer to the “NISSAN Service and MaintenanceGuide” for the maintenance schedule.

AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEMREFRIGERANT AND LUBRICANTRECOMMENDATIONS

The air conditioner system in your NISSANvehicle must be charged with the refriger-ant HFC-134a (R-134a) and the lubricant,NISSAN A/C System Oil Type S or theexact equivalents.

CAUTION

The use of any other refrigerant or lubri-cant will cause severe damage to the airconditioning system and will require thereplacement of all air conditioner sys-tem components.

The refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) in yourNISSAN vehicle will not harm the earth’s ozonelayer. Although this refrigerant does not affectthe earth’s atmosphere, certain governmentalregulations require the recovery and recycling ofany refrigerant during automotive air conditionersystem service. A NISSAN dealer has the trainedtechnicians and equipment needed to recoverand recycle your air conditioner system refriger-ant.

Contact a NISSAN dealer when servicing yourair conditioner system.

9-6 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 282: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

ENGINE

Model VQ35HR

Type Gasoline, 4-cycle

Cylinder arrangement 6-cylinder, V-slanted at 60°

Bore x Stroke in (mm) 3.760 x 3.205 (95.5 x 81.4)

Displacement cu in (cm3) 213.45 (3,498)

Firing order 1-2-3-4-5-6*1

Idle speed rpmSee the emission control label on theunderside of the hood.

Ignition timing (B.T.D.C.) degree/rpm

CO percentage at idle speed [No air] %

Spark plug Standard FXE22HR-11

Spark plug gap (Normal) in (mm) 0.043 (1.1)

Camshaft operation Timing chain

The spark ignition system of this vehicle meets all requirements of the CanadianInterference-Causing Equipment Regulations.

STI0425*1: Cylinder number

SPECIFICATIONS

Technical and consumer information 9-7

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 283: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WHEELS AND TIRES

Road wheel

Model Type Position Size Offsetin (mm)

Coupe Aluminum

Front 18 x 8JJ 1.18 (30)Rear 18 x 8-1/2JJ 1.30 (33)Front 18 x 9JJ* 1.18 (30)Rear 19 x 10JJ* 1.18 (30)

Roadster AluminumFront 18 x 8JJ 1.18 (30)Rear 18 x 8-1/2JJ 1.30 (33)

TireModel Type Position Size Pressure (COLD)

CoupeConventional

Front 225/45R18 91W 240 kPa (35 psi)Rear 245/45R18 96W 240 kPa (35 psi)Front 245/40R18 93W* 240 kPa (35 psi)Rear 265/35R19 94W* 240 kPa (35 psi)

Spare — T145/80D17 107M 420 kPa (60 psi)

Road-ster

ConventionalFront 225/45R18 91W 240 kPa (35 psi)Rear 245/45R18 96W 240 kPa (35 psi)

Spare — T145/80D17 107M 420 kPa (60 psi)

*: For option

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS

Vehicle body Coupe Roadster

Overall length in (mm) 169.8 (4,314) 169.8 (4,314)

Overall width in (mm) 71.5 (1,815) 71.5 (1,815)

Overall height in (mm) 52.1 (1,323) 52.5 (1,333)

Front tread in (mm) 60.5 (1,536) 60.5 (1,536)

Rear tread in (mm)60.6 (1,540)*160.9 (1,546)*2

60.6 (1,540)

Wheelbase in (mm) 104.3 (2,650) 104.3 (2,650)

Gross vehicle weight rating(GVWR)

lb (kg)

See the F.M.V.S.S. or C.M.V.S.S. cer-tification label on the driver’s sidelock pillar.

Gross axle weight rating(GAWR)

Front lb (kg)

Rear lb (kg)

*1: For model with 245/45R 18 tires*2: For model with 265/35R 19 tires

9-8 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 284: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

When planning to travel in another country,you should first find out if the fuel available issuitable for your vehicle’s engine.

Using fuel with too low an octane rating maycause engine damage. All gasoline vehiclesmust be operated with unleaded engine gaso-line. Therefore, avoid taking your vehicle to areaswhere appropriate fuel is not available.

When transferring the registration of yourvehicle to another country, state, provinceor district, it may be necessary to modify thevehicle to meet local laws and regulations.

The laws and regulations for motor vehicle emis-sion control and safety standards vary accordingto the country, state, province or district; there-fore, vehicle specifications may differ.

When any vehicle is to be taken into an-other country, state, province or districtand registered, its modifications, transpor-tation, and registration are the responsibil-ity of the user. NISSAN is not responsiblefor any inconvenience that may result.

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER(VIN) PLATEThe vehicle identification number plate is at-tached as shown. This number is the identifica-tion for your vehicle and is used in the vehicleregistration.

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER(chassis number)The number is stamped as shown.

STI0320 STI0513

WHEN TRAVELING ORREGISTERING YOUR VEHICLE INANOTHER COUNTRY

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION

Technical and consumer information 9-9

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 285: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

ENGINE SERIAL NUMBERThe number is stamped on the engine as shown.

F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.CERTIFICATION LABELThe Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards(F.M.V.S.S.) or Canadian Motor Vehicle SafetyStandards (C.M.V.S.S.) certification label is af-fixed as shown. This label contains valuablevehicle information, such as: Gross VehicleWeight Ratings (GVWR), Gross Axle WeightRating (GAWR), month and year of manufacture,Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), etc. Reviewit carefully.

EMISSION CONTROLINFORMATION LABELThe emission control information label is at-tached as shown.

STI0516 STI0322 STI0514

9-10 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 286: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATIONLABELThe cold tire inflation pressure is shown on theTire and Loading Information label affixed to thedriver side center pillar.

AIR CONDITIONER SPECIFICATIONLABELThe air conditioner specification label is affixedinside of the hood as shown.

STI0366 STI0515

Technical and consumer information 9-11

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 287: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Use the following steps to mount the licenseplate:

Before mounting the license plate, confirm thatthe following parts are enclosed in the vinyl bag.

� License plate bracket

� J-nut x 2

� Screw x 2

� Screw grommet x 2

1. Temporarily place the license plate bracketwhile aligning points �A of the front bumperfascia with holes �B in the license platebracket.

2. Remove the license plate bracket.

3. Carefully drill two shallow pilot holes �Ausing a 0.39 in (10 mm) drill bit at the markedlocations. (Be sure that the drill only goesthrough the fascia, or damage to the nutmay occur.)

4. Insert grommets into the hole on the fascia.

5. Insert a flat-blade screwdriver into the grom-met hole to add 90° turn onto the part �C .

6. Insert a J-nut into the license plate bracketbefore placing the license plate bracket onthe fascia.

7. Install the license plate bracket with screws.STI0446

INSTALLING FRONT LICENSEPLATE

9-12 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 288: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

8. Install the license plate with bolts that are nolonger than 0.55 in (14 mm). WARNING

� It is extremely dangerous toride in a cargo area inside avehicle. In a collision, peopleriding in these areas are morelikely to be seriously injured orkilled.

� Do not allow people to ride inany area of your vehicle that isnot equipped with seats andseat belts.

� Be sure everyone in your ve-hicle is in a seat and using aseat belt properly.

TERMS

It is important to familiarize yourself withthe following terms before loading yourvehicle:

� Curb Weight (actual weight of yourvehicle) - vehicle weight including:standard and optional equipment, flu-

ids, emergency tools, and spare tireassembly. This weight does not in-clude passengers and cargo.

� GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) - curbweight plus the combined weight ofpassengers and cargo.

� GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rat-ing) - maximum total combined weightof the unloaded vehicle, passengers,luggage, hitch, trailer tongue load andany other optional equipment. This in-formation is located on theF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. label.

� GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) -maximum weight (load) limit specifiedfor the front or rear axle. This informa-tion is located on theF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. label.

� GCWR (Gross Combined WeightRating) - maximum total weight ratingof the vehicle, passengers, cargo andtrailer.

� Vehicle Capacity Weight, Load limit,

VEHICLE LOADINGINFORMATION

Technical and consumer information 9-13

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 289: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Total load capacity - maximum totalweight limit specified of the load (pas-sengers and cargo) for the vehicle.This is the maximum combined weightof occupants and cargo that can beloaded into the vehicle. If the vehicle isused to tow a trailer, the trailer tongueweight must be included as part of thecargo load. This information is locatedon the Tire and Loading Informationlabel.

� Cargo capacity - permissible weight ofcargo, the subtracted weight of occu-pants from the load limit.

VEHICLE LOAD CAPACITY

Do not exceed the load limit of yourvehicle shown as “The combined weightof occupants and cargo” on the Tire andLoading Information label. Do not exceedthe number of occupants shown as“Seating Capacity” on the Tire and Load-ing Information label.

To get “the combined weight of occu-pants and cargo”, add the weight of alloccupants, then add the total luggageweight. Examples are shown in the fol-lowing illustration.

9-14 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 290: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Steps for determining correct loadlimit

1. Locate the statement “The combinedweight of occupants and cargo shouldnever exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs” on

your vehicle’s placard.

2. Determine the combined weight of thedriver and passengers that will beriding in your vehicle.

3. Subtract the combined weight of thedriver and passengers from XXX kg orXXX lbs.

4. The resulting figure equals the avail-able amount of cargo and luggageload capacity. For example, if the XXXamount equals 1400 lbs. and there willbe five 150 lb. passengers in yourvehicle, the amount of available cargoand luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.(1400 − 750 (5 × 150) = 650 lbs) or(640 − 340 (5 × 70) = 300 kg)

5. Determine the combined weight ofluggage and cargo being loaded onthe vehicle. That weight may not safelyexceed the available cargo and lug-gage load capacity calculated in Step4.

6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer,load from your trailer will be trans-ferred to your vehicle. Consult thismanual to determine how this reducesthe available cargo and luggage loadcapacity of your vehicle.

STI0447

Technical and consumer information 9-15

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 291: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirmthat you do not exceed the Gross VehicleWeight Rating (GVWR) or the GrossAxle Weight Rating (GAWR) for yourvehicle. See “Measurement of Weights”later in this section.

Also check tires for proper inflation pres-sures. See the Tire and Loading Informa-tion label.

LOADING TIPS

� The GVW must not exceed GVWR orGAWR as specified on theF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification la-bel.

� Do not load the front and rear axle tothe GAWR. Doing so will exceed theGVWR.

WARNING

� Properly secure all cargo withropes or straps to help preventit from sliding or shifting. Do

not place cargo higher than theseatbacks. In a sudden stop orcollision, unsecured cargocould cause personal injury.

� Do not load your vehicle anyheavier than the GVWR or themaximum front and rearGAWRs. If you do, parts of yourvehicle can break, tire damagecould occur, or it can changethe way your vehicle handles.This could result in loss of con-trol and cause personal injury.

� Overloading not only couldshorten the life of your vehicleand the tire, but can also causeunsafe vehicle handling andlong braking distances. Thismay cause a premature tire fail-ure, which could result in a se-rious accident and personal in-jury. Failures caused by overloading are not covered by the

vehicle’s warranty.

MEASUREMENT OF WEIGHTS

Secure loose items to prevent weightshifts that could affect the balance ofyour vehicle. When the vehicle is loaded,drive to a scale and weigh the front andthe rear wheels separately to determineaxle loads. Individual axle loads shouldnot exceed either of the gross axle weightratings (GAWR). The total of the axleloads should not exceed the gross ve-hicle weight rating (GVWR). These rat-ings are given on the vehicle certificationlabel. If weight ratings are exceeded,move or remove items to bring all weightsbelow the ratings.

9-16 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 292: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Roadster model:

Do not tow a trailer with your vehicle.

Coupe model:

Your new vehicle was designed to be usedprimarily to carry passengers and cargo. Re-member that towing a trailer places additionalloads on your vehicle’s engine, drive train, steer-ing, braking and other systems.

A NISSAN Towing Guide (U.S. only) is availableon the website at www.nissanusa.com. Thisguide includes information on trailer towing ca-pability and the special equipment required forproper towing.

WARNING

Overloading or improper loading of atrailer and its cargo can adversely affectvehicle handling, braking and perfor-mance and may lead to accidents.

CAUTION

� Do not tow a trailer or haul a heavyload for the first 500 miles (800 km).

Your engine, axle or other partscould be damaged.

� For the first 500 miles (800 km) thatyou tow a trailer, do not drive over 50mph (80 km/h) and do not makestarts at full throttle. This helps theengine and other parts of your ve-hicle wear in at the heavier loads.

MAXIMUM LOAD LIMITS

Maximum trailer loadsNever allow the total trailer load to exceed 1,000lb (454 kg). The total trailer load equals trailerweight plus its cargo weight. Towing loadsgreater than 1,000 lb (454 kg) or using impropertowing equipment could adversely affect vehiclehandling, braking and performance.

The ability of a vehicle to tow a trailer is not onlyrelated to the maximum trailer loads, but also theplaces you plan to tow. Tow weights appropriatefor level highway driving may have to be reducedon very steep grades or in low traction situations(for example, on slippery boat ramps).

CAUTION

Vehicle damage resulting from im-proper towing procedures are not cov-ered by NISSAN warranties.

TOWING A TRAILER

Technical and consumer information 9-17

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 293: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Tongue loadKeep the tongue load between 9 and 11% of thetotal trailer load within the maximum tongue loadlimits shown in the following TowingLoad/Specification chart. If the tongue load be-comes excessive, rearrange cargo to allow forproper tongue load.

Maximum gross vehicle weight/maximum gross axle weightThe gross vehicle weight of the towing vehiclemust not exceed. GVWR shown on theF.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. Thegross vehicle weight equals the combinedweight of the unloaded vehicle, passengers,luggage, hitch, trailer tongue load and any otheroptional equipment. In addition, front or reargross axle weight must not exceed GAWRshown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certifica-tion label.

TOWING LOAD/SPECIFICATION CHARTUnit: lb (kg)

MAXIMUMTOWING LOAD

1,000 (454)

MAXIMUMTONGUE LOAD

100 (45.4)

TOWING SAFETY

Trailer hitch

Choose a proper hitch for a vehicle and trailer.Make sure the trailer hitch is securely attached tothe vehicle, to help avoid personal injury orproperty damage due to sway caused by cross-winds, rough road surfaces or passing trucks.

Hitch ball

Choose a hitch ball of the proper size and weightrating for your trailer:

� The required hitch ball size is stamped onmost trailer couplers. Most hitch balls alsohave the size printed on top of the ball.

� Choose the proper class hitch ball based onthe trailer weight.

� The diameter of the threaded shank of thehitch ball must be matched to the ball mounthole diameter. The hitch ball shank should be

TI1011M TI1012M

9-18 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 294: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

no more than 1/16″ smaller than the hole inthe ball mount.

� The threaded shank of the hitch ball must belong enough to be properly secured to theball mount. There should be at least 2 threadsshowing beyond the lock washer and nut.

Class I hitch

Class I trailer hitch equipment (receiver, ballmount and hitch ball) can be used to tow trailersof a maximum weight of 2,000 lb (909 kg).

You may add Class I trailer hitch equipment tothe vehicle that has a 2,000 lb (909 kg) maxi-mum weight rating, but your vehicle is onlycapable of towing the maximum trailer weightsshown in the Towing Load/Specification Chartearlier in this section.

CAUTION

� Do not use axle-mounted hitches.

� The hitch should not be attached toor affect the operation of the impact-absorbing bumper.

� Do not modify the vehicle exhaustsystem, brake system, etc. to install a

trailer hitch.

� To reduce the possibility of addi-tional damage if a vehicle is struckfrom the rear, where practical, re-move the hitch and/or receiver whennot in use.

� After the hitch is removed, seal thebolt holes to prevent exhaust fumes,water or dust from entering the pas-senger compartment.

� Regularly check that all trailer hitchmounting bolts are securely mounted.

Tire pressures

� When towing a trailer, inflate the ve-hicle tires to the recommended coldtire pressure indicated on the Tire andLoading Information label.

� Trailer tire condition, size, load ratingand proper inflation pressure shouldbe in accordance with the trailer andtire manufacturers’ specifications.

Safety chains

Always use a suitable chain between a vehicleand the trailer. The safety chain should becrossed and should be attached to the hitch, notto the vehicle bumper or axle. Be sure to leaveenough slack in the chain to permit turningcorners.

Trailer lights

CAUTION

When splicing into the vehicle electricalsystem, a commercially availablepower-type module/converter must beused to provide power for all trailerlighting. This unit uses the vehicle bat-tery as a direct power source for alltrailer lights while using the vehicle taillight, stoplight and turn signal circuitsas a signal source. The module/converter must draw no more than 15milliamps from the stop and tail lampcircuits. Using a module/converter thatexceeds these power requirements maydamage the vehicle’s electrical system.See a reputable trailer dealer to obtain

Technical and consumer information 9-19

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 295: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

the proper equipment and to have itinstalled.

Trailer lights should comply with federal and/orlocal regulations. When wiring the vehicle fortowing, connect the stop and tail light pickupinto the vehicle electrical circuit at a point be-tween the sensor and stop light or light switch.

Trailer brakesIf your trailer is equipped with a braking system,make sure it conforms to federal and/or localregulations and that it is properly installed.

WARNING

Never connect a trailer brake systemdirectly to the vehicle brake system.

Pre-towing tips� Be certain a vehicle maintains a level positionwhen a loaded and/or unloaded trailer ishitched. Do not drive the vehicle if it has anunusual nose-up or nose-down condition;check for improper tongue load, overload,worn suspension or other possible causes ofthese conditions.

� Always secure items in the trailer to preventload shifts while driving.

� Load the trailer so approximately 60% of thetrailer load is in the front half and 40% is inthe back half.

� Check your hitch, trailer tire pressure, vehicletire pressure, trailer light operation, and trailerwheel lug nuts every time you attach a trailerto the vehicle.

� Be certain your rear view mirrors conform toall federal, state and/or local regulations. Ifnot, install any mirrors required for towingbefore driving the vehicle.

Trailer towing tipsIn order to gain skill and an understanding of thevehicle’s behavior, you should practice turning,stopping and backing up in an area which is freefrom traffic. Steering stability, and braking per-formance will be somewhat different than undernormal driving conditions.

� Always secure items in the trailer to preventload shift while driving.

� Avoid abrupt starts, acceleration or stops.

� Avoid sharp turns or lane changes.

� Always drive a vehicle at a moderate speed.Some states or provinces have specific

speed limits for vehicles that are towingtrailers. Obey the local speed limits.

� When backing up, hold the bottom of thesteering wheel with one hand. Move yourhand in the direction in which you want thetrailer to go. Make small corrections and backup slowly. If possible, have someone guideyou when you are backing up.

� Always block the wheels on both vehicle andtrailer when parking. Parking on a slope is notrecommended; however, if you must do so,and if a vehicle is equipped with automatictransmission, first apply the parking brakeand block the wheels, and then move thetransmission selector lever into the P (Park)position. If you move the selector lever to theP (Park) position before blocking the wheelsand applying the parking brake, the transmis-sion may get damaged.

� When going down a hill, shift into a lowergear and use the engine braking effect.When going up a long grade, downshift thetransmission to a lower gear and reducespeed to reduce chances of engine overload-ing and/or overheating.

� If the engine coolant rises to an extremelyhigh temperature when the air conditioningsystem is on, turn off the air conditioner.Coolant heat can be additionally vented by

9-20 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 296: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

opening the windows, switching the fan con-trol to high and setting the temperature con-trol to the HOT position.

� Trailer towing consumes more fuel than nor-mal circumstances.

� Avoid towing a trailer for the first 500 miles(800 km).

� Have a vehicle serviced more often than atintervals specified in the recommended main-tenance schedule.

� When making a turn, your trailer wheels willbe closer to the inside of the turn than yourvehicle wheels. To compensate for this, makea larger than normal turning radius during theturn.

� Crosswinds and rough roads will adverselyaffect vehicle/trailer handling, possibly caus-ing vehicle sway. When being passed bylarger vehicles, be prepared for possiblechanges in crosswinds that could affect ve-hicle handling. If swaying does occur, firmlygrip the steering wheel, steer straight ahead,and immediately (but gradually) reduce ve-hicle speed. This combination will help stabi-lize the vehicle. Never increase speed.

� Be careful when passing other vehicles.Passing while towing a trailer requires con-siderably more distance than normal passing.

Remember the length of the trailer must alsopass the other vehicle before you can safelychange lanes.

� To maintain engine braking efficiency andelectrical charging performance, do not use6th gear (manual transmission) or 5th posi-tion (automatic transmission).

� Avoid holding the brake pedal down too longor too frequently. This could cause the brakesto overheat, resulting in reduced braking ef-ficiency.

� Increase your following distance to allow forgreater stopping distances while towing atrailer. Anticipate stops and brake gradually.

� Do not use cruise control while towing atrailer.

� Check your hitch, trailer wiring harness con-nections, and trailer wheel lug nuts after 50miles (80 km) of travel and at every break.

� When stopped in traffic for long periods oftime in hot weather, put the vehicle in the P(Park) position.

When towing a trailer, change transmis-sion oil more frequently. For additionalinformation, see the “8. Maintenance anddo-it-yourself” section.

Towing your vehicle with all four wheels on theground is sometimes called flat towing. Thismethod is sometimes used when towing a ve-hicle behind a recreational vehicle, such as amotor home.

CAUTION

� Failure to follow these guidelinescan result in severe transmissiondamage.

� Whenever flat towing your vehicle,always tow forward, never backward.

� DO NOT tow any automatic transmis-sion vehicle with all four wheels onthe ground (flat towing). Doing soWILL DAMAGE internal transmissionparts due to lack of transmission lu-brication.

� For emergency towing procedures,refer to “Towing recommended byNISSAN” in the “6. In case of emer-gency” section of this manual.

FLAT TOWING

Technical and consumer information 9-21

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 297: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSIONTo tow a vehicle equipped with an automatictransmission, an appropriate vehicle dollyMUSTbe placed under the towed vehicle’s drivewheels. Always follow the dolly manufacturer’srecommendations when using their product.

MANUAL TRANSMISSION� Always tow with the manual transmission inNeutral.

� After towing 500 miles, start and idle theengine with the transmission in Neutral fortwo minutes. Failure to idle the engine afterevery 500 miles of towing may cause damageto internal transmission parts.

DOT (Department Of Transportation) QualityGrades: All passenger car tires must conform tofederal safety requirements in addition to thesegrades.

Quality grades can be found where applicableon the tire sidewall between tread shoulder andmaximum section width. For example:

Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A

Treadwear

The treadwear grade is a comparative ratingbased on the wear rate of the tire when testedunder controlled conditions on a specified gov-ernment test course. For example, a tire graded150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) timesas well on the government course as a tiregraded 100. The relative performance of tiresdepends upon the actual conditions of their use,however, and may depart significantly from thenorm due to variations in driving habits, servicepractices and differences in road characteristicsand climate.

Traction AA, A, B and CThe traction grades, from highest to lowest, areAA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent thetire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as mea-sured under controlled conditions on specifiedgovernment test surfaces of asphalt and con-

crete. A tire marked C may have poor tractionperformance.

WARNING

The traction grade assigned to this tireis based on straight-ahead braking trac-tion tests, and does not include accel-eration, cornering, hydroplaning, orpeak traction characteristics.

Temperature A, B and CThe temperature grades are A (the highest), B,and C, representing the tire’s resistance to thegeneration of heat and its ability to dissipate heatwhen tested under controlled conditions on aspecified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sus-tained high temperature can cause the materialof the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, andexcessive temperature can lead to sudden tirefailure. The grade C corresponds to a level ofperformance which all passenger car tires mustmeet under the Federal Motor Safety StandardNo. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levelsof performance on the laboratory test wheel thanthe minimum required by law.

UNIFORM TIRE QUALITYGRADING

9-22 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 298: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

WARNING

The temperature grade for this tire isestablished for a tire that is properlyinflated and not overloaded. Excessivespeed, under-inflation, or excessiveloading, either separately or in combi-nation, can cause heat build-up andpossible tire failure.

Your NISSAN vehicle is covered by the followingemission warranties.

For US:

� Emission Defects Warranty

� Emissions Performance Warranty(See Warranty Information Booklet for de-tails.)

For Canada:

� Emission Control System Warranty

Details of these warranties may be found withother vehicle warranties in your Warranty Infor-mation Booklet that comes with your NISSANvehicle. If you did not receive a Warranty Infor-mation Booklet, or it has become lost, you mayobtain a replacement by writing to:

� Nissan North America, Inc.Consumer Affairs DepartmentP.O. Box 685003Franklin, TN 37068-5003

� Nissan Canada Inc.5290 Orbitor DriveMississauga, Ontario, L4W 4Z5

If you believe that your vehicle has adefect which could cause a crash orcould cause injury or death, you shouldimmediately inform the National High-way Traffic Safety Administration(NHTSA) in addition to notifyingNISSAN.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, itmay open an investigation, and if itfinds that a safety defect exists in agroup of vehicles, it may order a recalland remedy campaign. However,NHTSA cannot become involved in in-dividual problems between you, yourdealer, or NISSAN.

To contact NHTSA, you may call theVehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov;or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 400Seventh Street, SW., Washington, DC20590. You can also obtain other in-formation about motor vehicle safetyfrom http://www.safercar.gov.

You may notify NISSAN by contactingour Consumer Affairs Department, toll-

EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMWARRANTY

REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS(US only)

Technical and consumer information 9-23

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 299: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

free, at 1-800-NISSAN-1 (1-800-647-7261).

Due to legal requirements in some states/areas, your vehicle may be required to be in whatis called the “ready condition” for an Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) test of the emission controlsystem.

The vehicle is set to the “ready condition” whenit is driven through certain driving patterns.Usually, the “ready condition” can be obtainedby ordinary usage of the vehicle.

If a powertrain system component is repaired orthe battery is disconnected, the vehicle may bereset to a not “ready condition”. Before takingthe I/M test, check the vehicle’s inspection/maintenance test readiness condition. Turn theignition switch ON without starting the engine. Ifthe Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) comes onsteady for 20 seconds and then blinks for 10seconds, the I/M test condition is “not ready”. Ifthe MIL does not blink after 20 seconds, the I/Mtest condition is “ready”.

If the MIL indicates the vehicle is in a “not ready”condition, drive the vehicle through the followingpattern to set the vehicle to the ready condition.If you cannot or do not want to perform thedriving pattern, a NISSAN dealer can conduct itfor you.

WARNING

Always drive the vehicle in a safe andprudent manner according to trafficconditions and obey all traffic laws.

1. Start the engine. Allow the engine to idle untilthe engine coolant temperature gauge needlepoints between the C and H (normal operat-ing temperature).

2. Accelerate the vehicle to 55 MPH (88 km/h),then quickly release the accelerator pedalcompletely and keep it released for at least10 seconds.

3. Quickly depress the accelerator pedal for amoment, then drive the vehicle at a speed of53 to 60 MPH (86 to 96 km/h) for at least 9minutes.

4. Stop the vehicle. Leave the engine running.

5. Accelerate the vehicle to 35 MPH (55 km/h)and maintain the speed for 20 seconds.

6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 at least 10 times.

7. Accelerate the vehicle to 55 MPH (88 km/h)and maintain the speed for at least 3 minutes.

8. Stop the vehicle. Place the automatic trans-

READINESS FOR INSPECTION/MAINTENANCE (I/M) TEST (USonly)

9-24 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 300: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

mission gear selector lever in the P (Park) orN (Neutral) position or the manual transmis-sion shift lever in the N position.

9. Turn the engine off.

10. Repeat steps 1 through 8 at least one moretime.

If step 1 through 7 is interrupted, repeat thepreceding step. Any safe driving mode is ac-ceptable between steps. Do not stop the engineuntil step 7 is completed.

This vehicle is equipped with an Event DataRecorder (EDR). The main purpose of anEDR is to record, in certain crash or nearcrash-like situations, such as an air bagdeployment or hitting a road obstacle, datathat will assist in understanding how avehicle’s systems performed. The EDR isdesigned to record data related to vehicledynamics and safety systems for a shortperiod of time, typically 30 seconds or less.The EDR in this vehicle is designed torecord such data as:

� How various systems in your vehiclewere operating;

� Whether or not the driver and passengersafety belts were buckled/fastened;

� How far (if at all) the driver was depress-ing the accelerator and/or brake pedal;and,

� How fast the vehicle was traveling.

� Sounds are not recorded.

These data can help provide a better un-derstanding of the circumstances in whichcrashes and injuries occur.

NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your ve-hicle only if a nontrivial crash situationoccurs; no data are recorded by the EDR

under normal driving conditions and nopersonal data (e.g. name, gender, age andcrash location) are recorded. However,other parties, such as law enforcement,could combine the EDR data with the typeof personally identifying data routinely ac-quired during a crash investigation.

To read data recorded by an EDR, specialequipment is required and access to thevehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition tothe vehicle manufacturer and NISSANdealer, other parties, such as law enforce-ment, that have the special equipment, canread the information if they have access tothe vehicle or the EDR. The EDR data maybe retrieved during routine vehicle servic-ing or for special research. It might also beaccessed with the consent of the vehicleowner or lessee, in response to a requestby law enforcement, or as otherwise re-quired or permitted by law.

EVENT DATA RECORDERS

Technical and consumer information 9-25

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 301: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

A genuine NISSAN Service Manual is the bestsource of service and repair information for yourvehicle. Filled with wiring diagrams, illustrationsand step-by-step diagnostic and adjustmentprocedures, this manual is the same one used bythe factory trained technicians working atNISSAN dealerships. Also available are genuineNISSAN Owner’s Manuals, and genuineNISSAN Service and Owner’s Manuals for olderNISSAN models.

For USA:

For current pricing and availability of genuineNISSAN Service Manuals for the 2000 modelyear and later, contact:

Tweddle Litho Company1-800-450-9491www.nissan-techinfo.com

For current pricing and availability of genuineNISSAN Service Manuals for the 1999 modelyear and prior, see a NISSAN dealer, or contact:

Resolve Corporation20770 Westwood DriveStrongsville, OH 441491-800-247-5321

For current pricing and availability of genuineNISSAN Owner’s Manuals for this model yearand prior, see a NISSAN dealer, or contact:

Resolve Corporation20770 Westwood DriveStrongsville, OH 441491-800-247-5321

For Canada:

To purchase a copy of a genuine NISSANService Manual or Owner’s Manual, please con-tact a NISSAN dealer. For the phone numberand location of a NISSAN dealer in your area callthe NISSAN Information Center at 1-800-387-0122 and a bilingual NISSAN representative willassist you.

Also available are Genuine NISSAN Service andOwner’s Manuals for older NISSAN models.

IN THE EVENT OF A COLLISIONUnfortunately, accidents do occur. In this unlikelyevent, there is some important information youshould know. Many insurance companies rou-tinely authorize the use of non-genuine collisionparts in order to cut costs, among other reasons.

Insist on the use of Genuine NISSANCollision Parts!

If you want your vehicle to be restored usingparts made to NISSAN’s original exacting speci-fications — if you want to help it to last and holdits resale value, the solution is simple. Tell yourinsurance agent and your repair shop toonly use Genuine NISSAN Collision Parts.NISSAN does not warrant non-NISSAN parts,nor does NISSAN’s warranty apply to damagecaused by a non-genuine part.

Using Genuine NISSAN Parts can help protectyour personal safety, preserve your warrantyprotection and maintain the resale value of yourvehicle. And if your vehicle was leased, usingGenuine NISSAN Parts may prevent or limitunnecessary excess wear and tear expenses atthe end of your lease.

NISSAN designs its hoods with crumple zonesto minimize the risk that the hood will penetratethe windshield of your vehicle in an accident.Non-genuine (imitation) parts may not providesuch built-in safeguards. Also, non-genuineparts often show premature wear, rust and cor-rosion.

Why should you take a chance?In over 40 states, the law says you must beadvised if non-genuine parts are used to repair

OWNER’S MANUAL/SERVICEMANUAL ORDER INFORMATION

9-26 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 302: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

your vehicle. And some states have enactedlaws that restrict insurance companies fromauthorizing the use of non-genuine collisionparts during the new vehicle warranty. Theselaws help protect you, so you can take action toprotect yourself.

It’s your right!If you should need further information visit us at:www.nissanusa.com (for U.S. customers) orwww.nissan.ca (for Canadian customers).

Technical and consumer information 9-27

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 303: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

MEMO

9-28 Technical and consumer information

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 304: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

10 Index

A

ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)........................... 5-21Advanced air bag system........................................ 1-35Air bag systemAdvanced Air Bag System............................... 1-35Front passenger air bag and status light ..... 1-36

Air bag warning labels ............................................. 1-42Air bag warning light .................................... 1-43, 2-14Air cleaner .................................................................. 8-18Air conditionerAir conditioner operation..................................... 4-9Air conditioner service ............................. 4-9, 4-12Air conditioner specification label .................. 9-11Air conditioning system refrigerant andlubricant recommendations..................... 4-12, 9-6Heater and air conditioner (automatic)............ 4-9

Alarm, How to stop alarm (see vehicle securitysystem)......................................................................... 2-19Alcohol, drugs and driving......................................... 5-6Anchor point location, Top tether strap .............. 1-24Antenna........................................................................ 4-30Anti-lock Braking System (ABS)........................... 5-21Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warninglight ............................................................................... 2-11Appearance careExterior appearance care .................................... 7-2Interior appearance care ..................................... 7-5

Audible reminders ..................................................... 2-17

Audio operation precautions .................................. 4-14Audio system.............................................................. 4-12Steering wheel audio controls ........................ 4-29

AutochangerCompact Disc (CD)........................................... 4-26

AutomaticAnti-glare inside mirror...................................... 3-26Automatic adjusting function (frontwindows)............................................................... 2-40Automatic passenger seatback tiltfunction......................................................... 1-5, 3-17Automatic transmission fluid (ATF) ................ 8-12Driving with automatic transmission ..... 5-7, 5-10

Avoiding collision and rollover.................................. 5-5

B

Battery.......................................................................... 8-15Battery saver system ......................................... 2-25Keyfob.................................................................... 8-24

Before starting the engine......................................... 5-9Belts (See drive belts) ............................................. 8-17Booster seats ............................................................. 1-25Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System withNISSAN Voice Recognition .................................. 4-31BrakeAnti-lock Braking System (ABS) .................... 5-21Brake and clutch fluid ....................................... 8-13Brake fluid............................................................. 8-13

Brake system ....................................................... 5-21Parking brake operation.................................... 5-15Warning light ....................................................... 2-12

Break-in schedule ..................................................... 5-18Brightness control, Instrument panel ................... 2-26Bulb check/instrument panel.................................. 2-11Bulb replacement ...................................................... 8-26

C

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants...... 9-2Car phone or CB radio............................................ 4-31Cargo (See vehicle loading information)............. 2-33Cargo net .................................................................... 2-33Catalytic converter, Three way catalyst ................. 5-3CD care and cleaning.............................................. 4-29Child restraints........................................................... 1-17Booster seats ...................................................... 1-25Installation on front passenger seat ............. 1-20Precautions on child restraints........................ 1-17Top tether strap .................................................. 1-24Top tether strap anchor point location ......... 1-24

Child safety ................................................................. 1-12Chimes, Audible reminders..................................... 2-17Circuit breaker, Fusible link .................................... 8-23Cleaning exterior and interior .......................... 7-2, 7-5Clock ............................................................................ 2-30Clutch fluid.................................................................. 8-13Coat hook .................................................................. 2-38

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 305: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Cold weather driving ................................................ 5-25Command (See Bluetooth Hands-FreePhone System)........................................................... 4-37Compact Disc (CD) changer (See audiosystem)......................................................................... 4-26Compact Disc (CD) player (See audiosystem)......................................................................... 4-21Compact spare tire................................................... 8-40Console box................................................................ 2-35Control panel buttons (models with navigationsystem) ........................................................................... 4-2ControlsControl panel buttons (display withnavigation system) ................................................ 4-2Heater and air conditioner controls(automatic) .............................................................. 4-9Steering wheel audio controls ........................ 4-29

CoolantCapacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ................................................................. 9-2Changing engine coolant .................................... 8-9Checking engine coolant level........................... 8-8

Corrosion protection ................................................... 7-6Cruise control............................................................. 5-16Cup holders ................................................................ 2-33

D

Daytime running light system ................................. 2-25Defroster switch, Rear window and outsidemirror defroster switch............................................. 2-23Dimensions and weights............................................ 9-8Display controls (See control panel buttons),With navigation system .............................................. 4-2

Door open warning light.......................................... 2-12Drive belts ................................................................... 8-17DrivingCold weather driving ......................................... 5-25Driving with automatic transmission ..... 5-7, 5-10Driving with manual transmission .......... 5-7, 5-13Precautions when starting and driving ............ 5-2

E

Economy, Fuel............................................................ 5-18Elapsed time............................................................... 2-10Emission control information label ........................ 9-10Emission control system warranty......................... 9-23EngineBefore starting the engine .................................. 5-9Break-in schedule............................................... 5-18Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ................................................................. 9-2Changing engine coolant .................................... 8-9Changing engine oil and filter ......................... 8-10Checking engine coolant level........................... 8-8Checking engine oil level .................................... 8-9Coolant temperature gauge ............................... 2-5Engine block heater ........................................... 5-26Engine compartment check locations.............. 8-7Engine cooling system......................................... 8-8Engine oil................................................................. 8-9Engine oil and oil filter recommendation......... 9-5Engine oil viscosity ............................................... 9-5Engine serial number ......................................... 9-10Engine specifications ........................................... 9-7If your vehicle overheats...................................... 6-9Oil pressure gauge............................................... 2-7

Starting the engine ............................................... 5-9Event data recorders................................................ 9-25Exhaust gas (Carbon monoxide).............................. 5-2

F

F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label ............. 9-10Filter, Changing engine oil and filter .................... 8-10Flashers (See hazard warning flasher switch)... 2-27Flat tire............................................................................ 6-2Flat towing .................................................................. 9-21Floor mat cleaning ....................................................... 7-5FluidAutomatic transmission fluid (ATF) ................ 8-12Brake and clutch fluid ....................................... 8-13Brake fluid............................................................. 8-13Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ................................................................. 9-2Engine coolant ....................................................... 8-8Engine oil................................................................. 8-9Power steering fluid ........................................... 8-12Window washer fluid......................................... 8-14

FM-AM radio with Compact Disc (CD)player ............................................................................ 4-19FM-AM-SAT radio with Compact Disc (CD)changer ........................................................................ 4-23Front manual seat adjustment ................................. 1-3Front power seat adjustment .................................. 1-3Front passenger air bag and status light............ 1-36Front power seat adjustment.................................... 1-4Front seat active head restraints ......................... 1-10FuelAverage fuel consumption .................................. 2-9

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

10-2

Page 306: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ................................................................. 9-2Distance to empty................................................. 2-9Fuel economy ...................................................... 5-18Fuel octane rating ................................................. 9-3Fuel recommendation........................................... 9-3Fuel-filler cap ....................................................... 3-23Fuel-filler door...................................................... 3-23Gauge ...................................................................... 2-6

Fuses ............................................................................ 8-21Fusible links ................................................................ 8-23

G

Garage door opener, HomeLink UniversalTransceiver.................................................................. 2-43Gas cap....................................................................... 3-23Gauge............................................................................. 2-3Engine coolant temperature gauge .................. 2-5Engine oil pressure gauge.................................. 2-7Fuel gauge .............................................................. 2-6Odometer ................................................................ 2-4Speedometer.......................................................... 2-4Tachometer ............................................................. 2-5Trip computer......................................................... 2-8Volt meter................................................................ 2-8

General maintenance.................................................. 8-2Golf bag stowing....................................................... 2-37

H

Hatch, Rear hatch........................................................ 3-9Hazard warning flasher switch............................... 2-27

Head restraints ............................................................. 1-9HeadlightsBulb replacement ............................................... 8-27Headlight switch ................................................. 2-24Xenon headlights ................................................ 2-24

Heated seats .............................................................. 2-28HeaterEngine block heater ........................................... 5-26Heater and air conditioner (automatic)............ 4-9

HomeLink Universal Transceiver ......................... 2-43Hood release ................................................................ 3-8Hook, Coat hook ....................................................... 2-38Horn.............................................................................. 2-27

I

Ignition switch............................................................... 5-6Automatic transmission models ............. 5-7, 5-10Key positions .......................................................... 5-8Manual transmission models .................. 5-7, 5-13

Immobilizer system.................................................... 2-19Indicator lights............................................................ 2-15InsideAutomatic anti-glare mirror............................... 3-26Mirror...................................................................... 3-26

Inspection/maintenance (I/M) test ........................ 9-24Instrument brightness control ................................ 2-26Instrument panel........................................................... 2-2Instrument pocket...................................................... 2-32Interior light replacement......................................... 8-28Interior lights ............................................................... 2-41Interior trunk lid release ........................................... 3-11

J

Jump starting................................................................. 6-7

K

Keyfob battery replacement.................................... 8-24Keyless entry (See remote keyless entrysystem) ........................................................................... 3-5Keys................................................................................. 3-2

L

LabelsAir bag warning labels ...................................... 1-42Air conditioner specification label .................. 9-11Emission control information label ................. 9-10Engine serial number ......................................... 9-10F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label ...... 9-10Tire and Loading Information label ..... 8-32, 9-11Vehicle identification number (VIN) .................. 9-9

License plate, Installing front license plate......... 9-12LightAir bag warning light ......................................... 1-43Bulb replacement ............................................... 8-26Headlight switch ................................................. 2-24Headlights bulb replacement........................... 8-27Indicator lights ..................................................... 2-15Interior lights ........................................................ 2-41Luggage compartment light ............................. 2-42Map lights ............................................................. 2-41Replacement ........................................................ 8-26Room light ............................................................ 2-41

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

10-3

Page 307: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Trunk light ............................................................. 2-42Vanity mirror light................................................ 2-42Warning/indicator lights and audiblereminders .............................................................. 2-11Xenon headlights ................................................ 2-24

Lights, Exterior and interior light replacement ... 8-28Loading information (See vehicle loadinginformation) ................................................................. 9-13LockDoor locks............................................................... 3-3Power door lock .................................................... 3-3Rear floor box ...................................................... 2-35Rear hatch lock...................................................... 3-9Top latch lever..................................................... 3-16Trunk lid................................................................. 3-10

Low tire pressure warning light ............................. 2-13Low tire pressure warning system (See tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS))..................... 5-3Luggage compartment light.................................... 2-42

M

MaintenanceBattery ................................................................... 8-15General maintenance ........................................... 8-2Inside the vehicle................................................... 8-3Maintenance information (display) .................... 4-3Maintenance precautions .................................... 8-5Maintenance requirements.................................. 8-2Outside the vehicle............................................... 8-2Seat belt maintenance ...................................... 1-17Under the hood and vehicle............................... 8-4

Malfunction indicator light (MIL)............................ 2-15Map lights.................................................................... 2-41

Meter, Trip computer .................................................. 2-8Meters and gauges ..................................................... 2-3Meters and gauges, Instrument brightnesscontrol .......................................................................... 2-26MirrorAutomatic anti-glare inside mirror .................. 3-26Inside mirror ......................................................... 3-26Outside mirrors ................................................... 3-27

N

NetCargo net.............................................................. 2-33Ventilated net seats .............................................. 1-6

New vehicle break-in................................................ 5-18NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System................... 2-19NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System, Enginestart.................................................................................. 5-8

O

Odometer....................................................................... 2-4OilCapacities and recommended fuel/lubricants ................................................................. 9-2Changing engine oil and filter ......................... 8-10Checking engine oil level .................................... 8-9Engine oil................................................................. 8-9Engine oil pressure gauge.................................. 2-7Engine oil viscosity ............................................... 9-5

Opening the soft top................................................ 3-13Outside air temperature display............................... 2-9Outside mirrors .......................................................... 3-27Overheat, If your vehicle overheats......................... 6-9

Owner’s Manual/Service Manual orderinformation................................................................... 9-26

P

ParkingBrake break-in ..................................................... 5-21Parking brake operation.................................... 5-15Parking on hills .................................................... 5-19

Phone, Car phone or CB radio ............................. 4-31PowerFront seat adjustment .......................................... 1-4Power door lock .................................................... 3-3Power outlet......................................................... 2-31Power steering fluid ........................................... 8-12Power steering system...................................... 5-20Power windows................................................... 2-39

PrecautionsAudio operation................................................... 4-14Braking precautions ........................................... 5-21Child restraints .................................................... 1-17Cruise control ...................................................... 5-16Maintenance ........................................................... 8-5Seat belt usage................................................... 1-10Supplemental restraint system........................ 1-28When starting and driving .................................. 5-2

Push starting ................................................................. 6-9

R

Radio ............................................................................ 4-12Car phone or CB radio..................................... 4-31

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

10-4

Page 308: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

FM-AM radio with Compact Disc (CD)changer ................................................................. 4-23FM-AM radio with Compact Disc (CD)player ..................................................................... 4-19Steering wheel audio controls ........................ 4-29

Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M)test (US only) ............................................................. 9-24Rear floor box............................................................. 2-35Rear hatch ..................................................................... 3-9Rear hatch opener....................................................... 3-9Rear parcel box ......................................................... 2-37Rear power point....................................................... 2-31Rear window and outside mirror defrosterswitch ........................................................................... 2-23Rear window wiper and washer switch .............. 2-22Recorders, Event data ............................................. 9-25Registering your vehicle in another country.......... 9-9Remote keyless entry system ................................... 3-5Reporting safety defects (US only) ...................... 9-23Rollover........................................................................... 5-5Roof, Soft top............................................................. 3-13Room light................................................................... 2-41

S

SafetyChild seat belts ................................................... 1-12Reporting safety defects (US only)................ 9-23Towing safety....................................................... 9-18

Seat adjustment, Front power seatadjustment ..................................................................... 1-4Seat belt(s)Child safety .......................................................... 1-12Infants .................................................................... 1-13

Injured persons.................................................... 1-14Larger children .................................................... 1-13Precautions on seat belt usage ...................... 1-10Pregnant women................................................. 1-13Seat belt cleaning ................................................. 7-6Seat belt extenders ............................................ 1-16Seat belt maintenance ...................................... 1-17Seat belt warning light ...................................... 2-14Seat belts ............................................................. 1-10Seat belts with pretensioners ........................ 1-41Shoulder belt arm............................................... 1-16Small children ...................................................... 1-13Three-point type with retractor ....................... 1-14

Seat lever, Tilting passenger’s seat ........................ 1-7Seat(s)Heated seats........................................................ 2-28Seats ........................................................................ 1-2Ventilated net seats .............................................. 1-6

Seatback tilt cancel switch ....................................... 1-8Secondary rear hatch release................................ 3-10Secondary trunk lid release.................................... 3-12Security system (NISSAN Vehicle ImmobilizerSystem), Engine start ............................................... 2-19Security system, Vehicle security system ........... 2-18Selector lever, Shift lock release .......................... 5-13Servicing air conditioner................................. 4-9, 4-12Shift lock release, Transmission ............................ 5-13ShiftingAutomatic transmission............................ 5-7, 5-10Manual transmission ................................. 5-7, 5-13

Shoulder belt arm...................................................... 1-16Soft top, Care and cleaning ..................................... 7-3Soft top, If the top does not open or close....... 3-19Soft top, Soft top indicator light................ 2-17, 3-17

Soft top, Soft top operation ................................... 3-13Spare tire ....................................................................... 9-8Spark plugs................................................................. 8-17Speed, Speed indicator ............................................. 2-9Speedometer ................................................................ 2-4StartingBefore starting the engine .................................. 5-9Jump starting .......................................................... 6-7Precautions when starting and driving ............ 5-2Push starting .......................................................... 6-9Starting the engine ............................................... 5-9

Status light, Front passenger air bag .................. 1-36SteeringPower steering fluid ........................................... 8-12Power steering system...................................... 5-20Steering wheel switch for audio controls..... 4-29Tilting steering wheel......................................... 3-25

Stopwatch................................................................... 2-10Storage ........................................................................ 2-32Stowing golf bags..................................................... 2-37Sun visors ................................................................... 3-25Sunglasses holder .................................................... 2-32Supplemental air bag warning labels................... 1-42Supplemental air bag warning light .......... 1-43, 2-14Supplemental restraint system............................... 1-28Precautions on supplemental restraintsystem.................................................................... 1-28

SwitchAudio control steering wheel switch ............. 4-29Hazard warning flasher switch ........................ 2-27Headlight switch ................................................. 2-24Ignition switch ........................................................ 5-6Ignition switch automatic transmissionmodels.......................................................... 5-7, 5-10

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

10-5

Page 309: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Ignition switch manual transmissionmodels.......................................................... 5-7, 5-13Power door lock switch....................................... 3-4Rear window and outside mirror defrosterswitch..................................................................... 2-23Traction control system (TCS) off switch .... 2-29Turn signal switch .............................................. 2-26Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off switch... 2-29

T

Tachometer.................................................................... 2-5Temperature display.................................................... 2-9Temperature gauge, Engine coolanttemperature gauge ...................................................... 2-5Theft (NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System),Engine start................................................................. 2-19Three-way catalyst....................................................... 5-3Tilting passenger’s seat ............................................. 1-7Tilting steering wheel ............................................... 3-25Tire pressure, Low tire pressure warninglight ............................................................................... 2-13TiresFlat tire ..................................................................... 6-2Low tire pressure warning system.................... 5-3Spare tire .............................................................. 8-40Tire and Loading information label................. 8-32Tire and Loading Information label................. 9-11Tire chains ............................................................ 8-37Tire dressing........................................................... 7-4Tire pressure........................................................ 8-30Tire pressure monitoring system(TPMS)............................................................ 5-3, 6-2Tire rotation .......................................................... 8-37

Types of tires ....................................................... 8-36Uniform tire quality grading.............................. 9-22Wheel/tire size ....................................................... 9-8Wheels and tires ................................................ 8-30

Top tether strap child restraints ............................ 1-24Top, Soft top .............................................................. 3-13TowingFlat towing............................................................ 9-21Tow truck towing ................................................ 6-10Towing a trailer.................................................... 9-17Towing load/specification chart ...................... 9-17Towing safety....................................................... 9-18

TPMS, Tire pressure monitoring system................ 5-3TPMS, Tire pressure warning system..................... 6-2Traction control system (TCS)............................... 5-23Traction control system (TCS) off switch........... 2-29Trailer towing.............................................................. 9-17Transceiver, HomeLink UniversalTransceiver.................................................................. 2-43TransmissionAutomatic transmission fluid (ATF) ................ 8-12Driving with automatic transmission ..... 5-7, 5-10Driving with manual transmission .......... 5-7, 5-13Transmission selector lever lock release...... 5-13

Transmitter (See remote keyless entry system)... 3-5Traveling or registering your vehicle in anothercountry ............................................................................ 9-9Trip computer ............................................................... 2-8Trip odometer............................................................. 2-10TrunkInterior trunk lid release .................................... 3-11Light ....................................................................... 2-42Secondary trunk lid release ............................. 3-12Trunk lid................................................................. 3-10

Turn signal switch ..................................................... 2-26

U

Underbody cleaning .................................................... 7-3Uniform tire quality grading .................................... 9-22Up-shift indicator (M/T models) ............................ 5-14Up-shift indicator setting (rpm) (M/T models) ... 2-10

V

Vanity mirror light ...................................................... 2-42VehicleDimensions and weights ..................................... 9-8Identification number (VIN) ................................. 9-9Loading information............................................ 9-13Recovery (freeing a stuck vehicle) ................. 6-12Security system................................................... 2-18Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off switch... 2-29Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) system ........ 5-23

Ventilated net seats..................................................... 1-6Ventilators ...................................................................... 4-8Voice command (See Bluetooth Hands-FreePhone System)........................................................... 4-37Volt meter ...................................................................... 2-8

W

Warning labels, Air bag warning labels .............. 1-42Warning lightAir bag warning light.............................. 1-43, 2-14Anti-lock braking system (ABS) warninglight......................................................................... 2-11

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

10-6

Page 310: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

Brake warning light ............................................ 2-12Door open warning light ................................... 2-12Low tire pressure warning light ...................... 2-13Seat belt warning light ...................................... 2-14

Warning lights............................................................ 2-11Warning, Hazard warning flasher switch ............ 2-27Warning, Tire pressure monitoring system(TPMS) .................................................................. 5-3, 6-2Warning, Warning/indicator lights and audiblereminders..................................................................... 2-11Warranty, Emission control system warranty ..... 9-23Washer switchRear window wiper and washer switch........ 2-22Windshield wiper and washer switch ........... 2-21

Washing ......................................................................... 7-2Waxing............................................................................ 7-3Weights (See dimensions and weights) ............... 9-8Wheel/tire size.............................................................. 9-8Wheels and tires ....................................................... 8-30Cleaning aluminum alloy wheels ....................... 7-4

Window washer fluid ............................................... 8-14Window(s)Automatic adjusting function ........................... 2-40Cleaning................................................................... 7-3Power windows................................................... 2-39

Windshield wiper and washer switch.................. 2-21WiperRear window wiper and washer switch........ 2-22Windshield wiper and washer switch ........... 2-21Wiper blades ....................................................... 8-19

X

Xenon headlights....................................................... 2-24

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

10-7

Page 311: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

MEMO

10-8

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 312: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

FUEL RECOMMENDATION:

Use unleaded premium gasoline with an octanerating of at least 91 AKI (Anti-Knock Index)number (Research octane number 96).

If premium gasoline is not available, unleadedregular gasoline with an octane rating of 87 AKInumber (Research octane number 91) may betemporarily used, but only under the followingprecautions:

� Have the fuel tank filled only partially withunleaded regular gasoline, and fill up withunleaded premium gasoline as soon as pos-sible.

� Avoid full throttle driving and abrupt accelera-tion.

However, for maximum vehicle perfor-mance, the use of unleaded premium gaso-line is recommended.

CAUTION

� Using a fuel other than that specifiedcould adversely affect the emissioncontrol system, and may also affectthe warranty coverage.

� Under no circumstances should a

leaded gasoline be used, becausethis will damage the three-way cata-lyst.

� Do not use E-85 fuel in your vehicle.Your vehicle is not designed to runon E-85 fuel. Using E-85 fuel candamage the fuel system componentsand is not covered by the NISSANvehicle limited warranty.

For additional information, see “Capacities andrecommended fuel/lubricants” in the “9. Techni-cal and consumer information” section.

ENGINE OIL RECOMMENDATION:� Engine oil with API Certification Mark

� Viscosity SAE 5W-30

See “Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants” in the “9. Technical and consumerinformation” section for engine oil and oil filterrecommendation.

COLD TIRE INFLATIONPRESSURES:The label is typically located on the driver sidecenter pillar or on the driver’s door. For addi-tional information, see “Wheels and tires” in the“8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section.

NEW VEHICLE BREAK-INPROCEDURESRECOMMENDATION:During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km) of ve-hicle use, follow the recommendations outlinedin the “Break-in schedule” information found inthe “5. Starting and driving” section of thisOwner’s Manual. Follow these recommenda-tions for the future reliability and economy ofyour new vehicle.

GAS STATION INFORMATION

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �

Page 313: 2008 350Z Owner's Manual

1. Engine oil (P.8-9)

2. Brake fluid (P.8-13)

3. Meters and gauges (P.2-3)

4. Fuel-filler door release (P.3-23)

5. Hood release (P.3-8)

6. Seat belt (P.1-10)

7. Door lock/key (P.3-2)

8. Rear hatch release (Coupe) (P.3-9) or Trunklid release (Roadster) (P.3-10)

9. Engine coolant (P.8-8)

10. Window washer fluid (P.8-14)

11. Power steering fluid (P.8-12)

12. Battery (P.8-15)

13. Audio system (P.4-12)/Heater and air conditioner (P.4-9)

14. Soft top (Roadster models) (P.3-13)

15. Fuel (P.3-23, P.9-3)

16. Spare tire (P.6-3, P.8-38)

STI0364

QUICK REFERENCE

� 07.7.25/Z33-D/V5.0 �